summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/26844-h
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to '26844-h')
-rw-r--r--26844-h/26844-h.htm7904
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/005.jpgbin0 -> 29381 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/006.jpgbin0 -> 26905 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/007.jpgbin0 -> 29368 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/013.jpgbin0 -> 7648 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/023.jpgbin0 -> 29523 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/027.jpgbin0 -> 18243 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/031.jpgbin0 -> 40281 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/042.jpgbin0 -> 53399 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/059.jpgbin0 -> 34212 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/063.jpgbin0 -> 27185 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/064.jpgbin0 -> 22128 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/074.jpgbin0 -> 55563 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/079a.jpgbin0 -> 24077 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/079b.jpgbin0 -> 21365 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/080a.jpgbin0 -> 27286 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/080b.jpgbin0 -> 4895 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/080c.jpgbin0 -> 27658 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/082.jpgbin0 -> 47161 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/085.jpgbin0 -> 45740 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/089.jpgbin0 -> 21512 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/093.jpgbin0 -> 47048 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/100.jpgbin0 -> 15940 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/101.jpgbin0 -> 32605 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/103.jpgbin0 -> 45317 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/106.jpgbin0 -> 34388 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/108.jpgbin0 -> 27561 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/109.jpgbin0 -> 47691 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/121.jpgbin0 -> 38386 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/133.jpgbin0 -> 43361 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/135.jpgbin0 -> 14968 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/139.jpgbin0 -> 33574 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/141.jpgbin0 -> 43782 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/142.jpgbin0 -> 35858 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/145.jpgbin0 -> 39440 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/146.jpgbin0 -> 55653 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/151.jpgbin0 -> 42281 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/154.jpgbin0 -> 29901 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/156.jpgbin0 -> 47157 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/165.jpgbin0 -> 33917 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/168.jpgbin0 -> 39273 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/169a.jpgbin0 -> 20084 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/169b.jpgbin0 -> 20386 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/182.jpgbin0 -> 42182 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/183.jpgbin0 -> 30605 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/184.jpgbin0 -> 22893 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/185.jpgbin0 -> 29582 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/193a.jpgbin0 -> 19611 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/193b.jpgbin0 -> 20125 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/196.jpgbin0 -> 37480 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/199a.jpgbin0 -> 54020 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/199b.jpgbin0 -> 48182 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/201.jpgbin0 -> 45723 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/207.jpgbin0 -> 29610 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/208.jpgbin0 -> 21007 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/210.jpgbin0 -> 27644 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/210a.jpgbin0 -> 29393 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/215.jpgbin0 -> 32242 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/216.jpgbin0 -> 33311 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/220.jpgbin0 -> 44436 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/frontis.jpgbin0 -> 56430 bytes
-rw-r--r--26844-h/images/title.jpgbin0 -> 32626 bytes
62 files changed, 7904 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/26844-h/26844-h.htm b/26844-h/26844-h.htm
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6840a2c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/26844-h.htm
@@ -0,0 +1,7904 @@
+<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
+ "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
+
+<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml">
+ <head>
+ <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=iso-8859-1" />
+ <title>
+ The Project Gutenberg eBook of BORNEO AND THE INDIAN ARCHIPELAGO by Frank S. Marryat.
+ </title>
+ <style type="text/css">
+/*<![CDATA[ XML blockout */
+<!--
+ p { margin-top: .75em;
+ text-align: justify;
+ margin-bottom: .75em;
+ }
+ h3,h4,h5,h6 {
+ text-align: center; /* all headings centered */
+ clear: both;
+ }
+
+ h1 {
+ text-align: center;
+ clear: both;
+ font-size: 200%;
+ line-height: 1.5;
+ margin-top: 1em;
+ margin-bottom: 1.25em;
+ }
+
+ h2 {
+ text-align: center;
+ clear: both;
+ font-size: 140%;
+ line-height: 2.0;
+ margin-top: 1em;
+ margin-bottom: 1em;
+ }
+
+ hr { width: 65%;
+ margin-top: 3em;
+ margin-bottom: 3em;
+ margin-left: auto;
+ margin-right: auto;
+ clear: both;
+ }
+
+ hr.hr1 { width: 10%;
+ margin-top: 0em;
+ margin-bottom: 3em;
+ margin-left: auto;
+ margin-right: auto;
+ clear: both;
+ }
+
+ table {margin-left: auto; margin-right: auto;}
+
+ body{margin-left: 10%;
+ margin-right: 10%;
+ }
+
+ .pagenum { /* uncomment the next line for invisible page numbers */
+ /* visibility: hidden; */
+ position: absolute;
+ left: 92%;
+ right: 2%;
+ font-size: 80%;
+ text-align: right;
+ } /* page numbers */
+
+ .blockquot{ margin-left: 5%; margin-right: 10%; font-size: 90%;
+ margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 2em;
+ }
+
+ .bl {border-left: solid 1px;}
+
+ .tdtitle {text-align: center; vertical-align: top;
+ padding-top: 3em;
+ padding-bottom: 2em;
+ }
+
+ .illo {vertical-align: top;
+ font-variant: small-caps;
+ text-indent: -1.2em;
+ padding-left: 1.2em;
+ text-align: left;
+ padding-top: 0.4em;
+ padding-bottom: 0.4em;
+ }
+
+ .illo2 {vertical-align: top;
+ font-variant: small-caps;
+ text-indent: -1.2em;
+ padding-left: 2.2em;
+ text-align: left;
+ padding-top: 0.4em;
+ padding-bottom: 0.4em;
+ }
+
+ .pg {text-align: right;
+ padding-top: 0.4em;
+ padding-bottom: 0.4em;
+ vertical-align: top;
+ }
+
+ .padr {padding-right: 1em;}
+
+ .center {text-align: center;}
+ .smcap {font-variant: small-caps;}
+
+ big { font-size:140%; }
+ small { font-size: 80%; }
+ .tiny { font-size: 60%; }
+
+ div.cap { margin-left: auto; margin-right: auto;
+ margin-top: -1.3em;
+ width: 390px; text-align: center; }
+
+ div.cap-horiz { margin-left: auto; margin-right: auto;
+ margin-top: -1.3em;
+ width: 600px; text-align: center; }
+
+ p.capright { float: right; font-size: 50%; text-align: right; }
+
+ p.capleft { float: left; font-size: 50%; text-align: left; }
+
+ p.caption { margin-top: 0.75em;
+ text-align: center;
+ margin-bottom: 0.75em;
+ font-size: 80%;
+ font-weight: bold;
+ }
+
+ .sup {
+ font-size:80%;
+ position:relative;
+ bottom: 0.3em;
+ }
+
+ p.publisher { margin-top: 0.75em;
+ text-align: center;
+ margin-bottom: 0em;
+ font-size: 50%;
+ }
+
+ .left65 { margin-left: 65% }
+
+
+ .tnote {border: dashed 1px; margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%; padding-bottom: .5em; padding-top: .5em;
+ padding-left: .5em; padding-right: .5em;}
+
+ .figcenter {margin: auto; text-align: center; margin-top: 1.5em; margin-bottom: 1.5em; }
+
+ .figleft {float: left; clear: left; margin-left: 0; margin-bottom: 1em; margin-top:
+ 1em; margin-right: 1em; padding: 0; text-align: center;}
+
+ .figright {float: right; clear: right; margin-left: 1em; margin-bottom: 1em;
+ margin-top: 1em; margin-right: 0; padding: 0; text-align: center;}
+
+ .footnotes {border: dashed 1px; margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%;}
+ .footnote {margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%; font-size: 0.9em;}
+ .footnote .label {position: absolute; right: 78%; text-align: right;}
+ .fnanchor {vertical-align: super; font-size: .8em; text-decoration: none;}
+
+ .poem {margin-left:10%; margin-right:10%; text-align: left;}
+ .poem br {display: none;}
+ .poem .stanza {margin: 1em 0em 1em 0em;}
+ .poem span.i0 {display: block; margin-left: 0em; padding-left: 3em; text-indent: -3em;}
+ .poem span.i2 {display: block; margin-left: 2em; padding-left: 3em; text-indent: -3em;}
+ .poem span.i4 {display: block; margin-left: 4em; padding-left: 3em; text-indent: -3em;}
+ // -->
+ /* XML end ]]>*/
+ </style>
+ </head>
+<body>
+
+
+<pre>
+
+Project Gutenberg's Borneo and the Indian Archipelago, by Frank S. Marryat
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: Borneo and the Indian Archipelago
+ with drawings of costume and scenery
+
+Author: Frank S. Marryat
+
+Release Date: October 8, 2008 [EBook #26844]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK BORNEO AND THE INDIAN ARCHIPELAGO ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by Ronald Lee
+
+
+
+
+
+</pre>
+
+
+
+
+<h1>BORNEO<br />
+<span class="tiny">AND</span><br />
+<small>THE INDIAN ARCHIPELAGO.</small></h1>
+
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+<p class="center">London:<br />
+<span class="smcap">Spottiswoode and Shaw</span>,<br />
+New-street Square.</p>
+
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="frontis" id="frontis"></a>
+<img src="images/frontis.jpg" width="393" height="600" alt="Chinese Joss House" />
+<div class="cap">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">CHINESE JOSS HOUSE.</p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<hr />
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="title" id="title"></a>
+<img src="images/title.jpg" width="393" height="600" alt="Chinese Junk" />
+<div class="cap">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+<h1>BORNEO<br />
+<span style="font-size: 35%">AND</span><br />
+<small>THE INDIAN ARCHIPELAGO.</small></h1>
+
+<p class="center"><b><span class="tiny">WITH</span><br /><br />
+DRAWINGS OF COSTUME AND SCENERY.</b></p>
+
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+<p class="center"><b><span class="tiny">BY</span><br /><br />
+<big>FRANK S. MARRYAT,</big><br />
+<span class="tiny">LATE MIDSHIPMAN OF H. M. S. SAMARANG,<br />
+SURVEYING VESSEL.</span></b></p>
+
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+<p class="center">LONDON:<br />
+LONGMAN, BROWN, GREEN, AND LONGMANS,<br />
+<small>PATERNOSTER-ROW.<br />
+1848.</small></p>
+
+
+<hr />
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_v" id="Page_v">[v]</a></span></p>
+<h2>INTRODUCTION.</h2>
+<hr class="hr1" />
+
+<p>I wish the readers of these pages to understand that it has been with no
+desire to appear before the public as an author that I have published
+this Narrative of the Proceedings of Her Majesty's ship Samarang during
+her last Surveying Cruise.</p>
+
+<p>During the time that I was in the ship, I made a large collection of
+drawings, representing, I hope faithfully, the costumes of the natives
+and the scenery of a country so new to Europeans. They were considered,
+on my return, as worthy to be presented to the public, as being more
+voluminous and more characteristic than drawings made in haste usually
+are.</p>
+
+<p>I may here observe, that it has been a great error on the part of the
+Admiralty, considering the great expense incurred in fitting out vessels
+for survey, that a little additional outlay is not made in supplying
+every vessel with a professional draughtsman, as was invariably the case
+in the first vessels sent out on discovery. The duties of officers in
+surveying vessels are much too fatiguing and severe to allow them the
+time to make anything but hasty sketches, and they require that practice
+with the pencil without which natural talent is of little avail; the
+consequence is, that the engravings, which have appeared in too many of
+the Narratives of Journeys and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_vi" id="Page_vi">[vi]</a></span> Expeditions, give not only an imperfect,
+but even an erroneous, idea of what they would describe.</p>
+
+<p>A hasty pencil sketch, from an unpractised hand, is made over to an
+artist to reduce to proportion; from him it passes over to the hand of
+an engraver, and an interesting plate is produced by their joint
+labours. But, in this making up, the character and features of the
+individual are lost, or the scenery is composed of foliage not
+indigenous to the country, but introduced by the artist to make a good
+picture.</p>
+
+<p>In describing people and countries hitherto unknown, no description
+given by the pen will equal one correct drawing. How far I may have
+succeeded must be decided by those who have, with me, visited the same
+places and mixed with the people delineated. How I found time to
+complete the drawings is explained by my not doing any duty on board at
+one time, and at another by my having been discharged into the
+hospital-ship at Hong Kong.</p>
+
+<p>It was my intention to have published these drawings without
+letter-press, but in this I have been overruled. I have therefore been
+compelled to have recourse to my own private journal, which certainly
+was never intended for publication. As I proceeded, I found that, as I
+was not on board during the whole of the time, it would be better, and
+make the work more perfect, if I published the whole of the cruise,
+which I could easily do by referring to the journals of my messmates.</p>
+
+<p>I would gladly mention their names, and publicly acknowledge their
+assistance; but, all things considered, I think it as well to withhold
+them, and I take this opportunity of thanking them for their kindness.</p>
+
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+<p class="left65">FRANK S. MARRYAT.</p>
+
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+<hr />
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_vii" id="Page_vii">[vii-viii]</a></span></p>
+
+<h2>LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS.</h2>
+<hr class="hr1" />
+
+<table summary="List of Illustrations" width="80%" cellpadding="0" cellspacing="0" border="0">
+ <colgroup>
+ <col width="35%" />
+ </colgroup>
+ <colgroup>
+ <col width="15%" />
+ </colgroup>
+ <colgroup>
+ <col width="35%" />
+ </colgroup>
+ <colgroup>
+ <col width="15%" />
+ </colgroup>
+
+
+<tr>
+<td class="tdtitle" colspan="4">LITHOGRAPHIC PLATES.</td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Chinese Joss House</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#frontis"><small><i>Frontispiece</i></small></a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">West Point, Hong Kong</td><td class="pg"><small><i>To&nbsp;face page</i></small>&nbsp;<a href="#westpoint">142</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Bornese Vessel</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#title"><small><i>Title-page</i></small></a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">View on the Island of Poo-too</td><td class="pg"><a href="#pootoo">151</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Loondoo Dyak</td><td class="pg padr"><small><i>To&nbsp;face page</i></small>&nbsp;<a href="#loondoo">5</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Chinese Joss House at Ningpo</td><td class="pg"><a href="#ningpojoss">156</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">River Sarawak and Town of Kuchin</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#sarawack">6</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Quelpartians</td><td class="pg"><a href="#quelpartians">182</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Keeney-Ballo</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#keeney">59</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Mandarin of Quelpart (Corea)</td><td class="pg"><a href="#mandarin">183</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Serebis Dyak</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#serebis">79</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Japanese</td><td class="pg"><a href="#japanese">185</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Saghai Dyak</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#saghai">80</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Natives of Luzon (Philippines)</td><td class="pg"><a href="#luzon">199</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">War Dance of the Dyaks</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#wardance">85</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">View in Samboangan</td><td class="pg"><a href="#samboangan">201</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Malay Chief (Sooloo)</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#malaychief">101</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Illanoan Pirate</td><td class="pg"><a href="#pirate">207</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Bruni</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#bruni">106</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Dusum</td><td class="pg"><a href="#dusum">210</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Court of the Sultan of Borneo</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#court">109</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Port Louis</td><td class="pg"><a href="#louis">220</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+
+<tr>
+<td class="tdtitle" colspan="4">WOODCUTS.</td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo"></td><td class="pg padr"><small>Page</small></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl"></td><td class="pg"><small>Page</small></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr><td class="illo">Mr. Brooke's House</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#brooke">7</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Procession of the Sultan of Gonong Tabor</td><td class="pg"><a href="#procession">133</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Dyak Head</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#head">13</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Ears of Dyaks at Gonong Tabor</td><td class="pg"><a href="#ears">135</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Malays of Kuchin</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#malays">23</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Portrait of Mahomed Pullulu, Sultan of Sooloo</td><td class="pg"><a href="#pullulu">139</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Native of Batan</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#batan">27</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Tanka Boats&mdash;Hong Kong</td><td class="pg"><a href="#tankaboats">141</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Native of Pa-tchu-san</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#patchusan">31</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Chinese Fishermen</td><td class="pg"><a href="#fishermen">145</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Sooloo Village</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#sooloo">42</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Cook's Shop</td><td class="pg"><a href="#cook">146</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Native Boat&mdash;Borneo</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#nativeboat">63</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Pagoda&mdash;Ningpo</td><td class="pg"><a href="#pagoda">154</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Dyak War Prahu</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#dyakprahu">64</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Tanka Boat Women</td><td class="pg"><a href="#tankawomen">165</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Dyak Women in Canoe</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#dyakwomen">74</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Man-of-War Junk</td><td class="pg"><a href="#warjunk">168</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Teeth of Dyaks</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#teeth">79</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Trading Junks</td><td class="pg"><a href="#tradejunk">169</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Costumes of Dyak Women</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#costumes">80</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Japanese Boat</td><td class="pg"><a href="#japboat">184</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Sum-pi-tan&mdash;Blow-pipe, with poisoned Arrows</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#blowpipe">80</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Salt Smugglers</td><td class="pg"><a href="#salt">193</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Dyak Village</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#dyakvillage">82</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Spanish Galleon</td><td class="pg"><a href="#galleon">196</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Obtaining Fire</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#fire">89</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Water Carriers&mdash;Manilla</td><td class="pg"><a href="#water">199</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">View of Sincapore</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#sincapore">93</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Illanoan Pirates</td><td class="pg"><a href="#pirateboat">208</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Malay Woman</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#malaywoman">100</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Natives of N. E. Coast of Borneo</td><td class="pg"><a href="#nativesne">210</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Proboscis Monkey</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#proboscis">103</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Convict</td><td class="pg"><a href="#convict">215</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">Natives of Bruni</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#nativesbruni">108</a></td>
+<td class="illo2 bl">Kling Woman</td><td class="pg"><a href="#kling">216</a></td>
+</tr>
+
+<tr>
+<td class="illo">City of Manilla</td><td class="pg padr"><a href="#manilla">121</a></td>
+<td></td><td></td>
+</tr>
+
+</table>
+
+<hr />
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_1" id="Page_1">[1]</a></span></p>
+
+<h1>
+BORNEO<br />
+<span class="tiny">AND</span><br />
+<small>THE INDIAN ARCHIPELAGO.</small></h1>
+
+<hr class="hr1" />
+
+<p>On the 25th of January, 1843, H. M. S. Samarang, being completely
+equipped, went out of Portsmouth harbour and anchored at Spithead. The
+crew were paid advanced wages; and, five minutes after the money had
+been put into their hats at the pay-table, it was all most dexterously
+transferred to the pockets of their wives, whose regard and affection
+for their husbands at this peculiar time was most exemplary. On the
+following day, the crew of the Samarang made sail with full hearts and
+empty pockets.</p>
+
+<p>On the 25th February, sighted Fuerto Ventura: when off this island, the
+man at the mast-head reported a wreck in sight, which, as we neared it,
+appeared to be the wreck of a brig. Strange to say, the captain
+recognised it as an old acquaintance, which he had seen off Cape
+Finisterre on his return from China in the Sulphur. If this was not a
+mistake, it would be evidence of a southerly current in this quarter of
+the Atlantic. This may be, but I do not consider the proof to be
+sufficient to warrant the fact; although it may lead to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_2" id="Page_2">[2]</a></span> the
+supposition. If this was the wreck seen at such a long interval by the
+captain, a succession of northerly winds and gales might have driven it
+down so far to the southward without the assistance of any current. It
+is well known that the great current of the Atlantic, the gulf stream
+(which is occasioned by the waters, being forced by the continuous trade
+winds into the Gulf of Mexico, finding a vent to the northward by the
+coast of America, from thence towards Newfoundland, and then in a more
+easterly direction), loses its force, and is expended to the northward
+of the Western Islands; and this is the cause why so many rocks have
+been yearly reported to have been fallen in with in this latitude.
+Wrecks, all over the Atlantic, which have been water-logged but do not
+sink, are borne by the various winds and currents until they get into
+the gulf stream, which sweeps them along in its course until they arrive
+to where its force is expended, and there they remain comparatively
+stationary. By this time, probably, years have passed, and they are
+covered with sea-weeds and barnacles, and, floating three or four feet
+out of the water, have every appearance of rocks; and, indeed, if run
+upon on a dark night, prove nearly as fatal.</p>
+
+<p>March 3rd.&mdash;Anchored off the town of Porto Praya, Island of St. Jago, in
+nine fathoms. Porto Praya is a miserable town, built on a most unhealthy
+spot, there being an extensive marsh behind it, which, from its miasma,
+creates a great mortality among the inhabitants. The consul is a native
+of Bona Vista: two English consuls having fallen victims to the climate
+in quick succession, no one was found very willing to succeed to such a
+certain provision from the Foreign Office. The interior of the island
+is, however, very different from what would be expected from the sight
+of Porto Praya. Some of the officers paid a visit to the valley of St.
+Domingo, which they described as a perfect paradise, luxuriant with
+every tropical fruit.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_3" id="Page_3">[3]</a></span> Porto Praya is renowned for very large sharks. I
+was informed by a captain in Her Majesty's service, that once, when he
+anchored at Porto Praya, he had left the ship to go on shore in one of
+the twenty-two-foot gigs, not unaptly nick-named coffins in the service.
+He had not pulled more than a cable's length from the ship, when a
+shark, nearly as long as the gig, came up swimming with great velocity
+after them; and as he passed, the animal shouldered the boat, so as
+nearly to upset it: as it was, the boat took in the water over the
+gunwale. As the animal appeared preparing for another attack, the
+captain thought it advisable to pull alongside, and go on shore in the
+cutter instead of his own boat; and on this large boat the shark did not
+make a second attempt.</p>
+
+<p>April 25th.&mdash;Anchored in Simon's Bay, Cape of Good Hope. Sailed again on
+the 7th of May, and fell in with a favourable wind; and too much of it.
+For six days we were scudding before it under a close-reefed
+main-topsail and fore-staysail. On the 10th we lost one of the best men
+in the ship, the sailmaker, Charles Downing, who fell overboard; the
+ship was rounded to, the life-buoy let go, but we saw nothing of him.
+June 7th saw Christmas Islands, and on the same afternoon the land of
+Java. On the 11th we arrived off the town of Anger, in company with a
+fleet of merchant vessels of all nations and of all rigs. Having been so
+long without a fresh meal, we were not sorry to find ourselves
+surrounded by boats loaded with fish, fruit, and vegetables; we ate
+enormously, and they made us pay in proportion.</p>
+
+<p>On the 19th we arrived at Sincapore, and found the roads very gay with
+vessels of all descriptions, from the gallant free trader of 1000 tons
+to the Chinese junk. As Sincapore, as well as many other places, was
+more than once visited, I shall defer my description for the present. On
+June the 27th we weighed and made sail for the river of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_4" id="Page_4">[4]</a></span> Sarawak
+(Borneo), to pay a visit to Mr. Brooke, who resides at Kuchin, a town
+situated on that river.</p>
+
+<p>The public have already been introduced to Mr. Brooke in the volumes
+published by Captain Henry Keppel. Mr. Brooke is a gentleman of
+independent fortune, who was formerly in the service of the Company. The
+usefulness and philanthropy of his public career are well known: if the
+private history which induced him to quit the service, and afterwards
+expatriate himself, could with propriety, and also regard to Mr.
+Brooke's feelings, be made known, it would redound still more to his
+honour and his high principle; but these I have no right to make public.
+Mr. Brooke, having made up his mind to the high task of civilising a
+barbarous people, and by every means in his power of putting an end to
+the wholesale annual murders committed by a nation of pirates, whose
+hands were, like Ishmael's, against every man, sailed from England in
+his yacht, the Royalist schooner, with a crew of picked and tried men,
+and proceeded to Sarawak, where he found the rajah, Muda Hassein, the
+uncle to the reigning sultan of Borneo, engaged in putting down the
+insurrection of various chiefs of the neighbouring territory. Mr.
+Brooke, with his small force, gave his assistance to the rajah; and
+through his efforts, and those of his well-armed band, the refractory
+chiefs were reduced to obedience. Willing to retain such a powerful
+ally, and partial to the English, the rajah made Mr. Brooke most
+splendid promises to induce him to remain; but the rajah, like all
+Asiatics, did not fulfil the performance of these promises until after
+much delay and vexation to Mr. Brooke, who required all the courage and
+patience with which he is so eminently gifted, before he could obtain
+his ends. At last he was successful: Muda Hassein made over to him a
+large tract of land, over which he was constituted rajah, and Mr. Brooke
+took up his residence at Kuchin; and this grant was ultimately confirmed
+by the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_5" id="Page_5">[5]</a></span> seal of the sultan of Borneo. Such, in few words, is the history
+of Mr. Brooke: if the reader should wish for a more detailed account, I
+must refer him to Capt. Henry Keppel's work, in which is published a
+great portion of Mr. Brooke's own private memoranda.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="loondoo" id="loondoo"></a>
+<img src="images/005.jpg" width="393" height="588" alt="Loondoo Dyak" />
+<div class="cap">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">LOONDOO DYAK.<br />
+<small>(N. W. COAST OF BORNEO.)</small></p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>On the morning of the 29th June we saw the high land of Borneo, but for
+several days were unsuccessful in discovering the mouth of the river. On
+the night of July the 4th we anchored off the entrance of a river, which
+the captain supposed to be the Sarawak. The next morning the two barges,
+well armed, were sent up the river to obtain information. After pulling
+with the stream six or eight miles, they discovered a small canoe,
+which, on their approach, retreated up the river with great speed. Mr.
+Heard, the officer in charge of the boats, had taken the precaution, as
+he ascended the river, of cutting a palm branch for each boat, and these
+were now displayed at the bows as a sign of peaceable intentions.</p>
+
+<p>These universal tokens of amity reassured the natives, who, seeing them,
+now turned the bows of their canoes, and paddled towards the boats. The
+canoe contained four men, almost in a state of nudity, their only
+covering consisting of a narrow slip of cotton fastened round the
+middle. They were copper-coloured, and extremely ugly: their hair jet
+black, very long, and falling down the back; eyes were also black, and
+deeply sunk in the head, giving a vindictive appearance to the
+countenance; nose flattened; mouth very large; the lips of a bright
+vermilion, from the chewing of the betel-nut; and, to add to their
+ugliness, their teeth black, and filed to sharp points. Such is the
+personal appearance of a Loondoo Dyak.</p>
+
+<p>They informed us that the river we were then in was the Loondoo, and
+that the Sarawak was some distance to the eastward. They also gave us
+the information that the boats of the Dido had been engaged with
+pirates, and had been successful, having captured one prahu and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_6" id="Page_6">[6]</a></span> sunk
+another. After great persuasion, we induced one of them to accompany us
+to the ship, and pilot her to the Sarawak.</p>
+
+<p>The same evening we weighed anchor, and stood towards a remarkable
+promontory (Tangong Sipang), to the eastward of which is the principal
+entrance of the Sarawak river; a second, but less safe, entrance being
+within a mile of the promontory. Light and variable winds prevented our
+arrival at the mouth of the river until the evening of the following
+day. From thence, after two days' incessant kedging and towing, we
+anchored off the town of Kuchin, on the morning of the 8th instant. The
+town of Kuchin is built on the left-hand side of the river Sarawak going
+up; and, from the windings of the river, you have to pull twenty-five
+miles up the river to arrive at it, whereas it is only five miles from
+the coast as the crow flies. It consists of about 800 houses, built on
+piles driven into the ground, the sides and roofs being enclosed with
+dried palm leaves. Strips of bamboo are laid across, which serve as a
+floor. In fact, there is little difference between these houses and
+those built by the Burmahs and other tribes in whose countries bamboo
+and ratan are plentiful. The houses of Mr. Brooke and the rajah are much
+superior to any others, having the advantage and comfort of wooden sides
+and floorings. We visited the rajah several times, who invariably
+received us with urbanity, and entertained us in a very hospitable
+manner. Muda Hassein is a man about fifty years of age,&mdash;some think
+more,&mdash;of low stature, as are most of the Malays, well made, and with a
+very prepossessing countenance for a Malay. His brother, Budruden, is a
+much finer man, very agreeable, and very partial to the English. The
+Malays profess Mahomedanism; but Budruden in many points followed
+European customs, both in dress and drinking wine.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="sarawack" id="sarawack"></a>
+<img src="images/006.jpg" width="600" height="397" alt="River Sarawack and town of Kuchin" />
+<div class="cap-horiz">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">RIVER SARAWACK AND TOWN OF KUCHIN.<br />
+<small>(BORNEO.)</small></p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>The residence of Mr. Brooke is on the side of the river opposite to the
+town, as, for the most part, are all the houses of the Europeans.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_7" id="Page_7">[7]</a></span> In
+structure it somewhat resembles a Swiss cottage, and is erected upon a
+green mound, which slopes down to the river's bank, where there is a
+landing-place for boats. At the back of the house is a garden,
+containing almost every tree peculiar to the climate; and it was a
+novelty to us to see collected together the cotton-tree, the areca,
+sago, palm, &amp;c., with every variety of the Camellia japonica in a state
+of most luxurious wildness.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="brooke" id="brooke"></a>
+<img src="images/007.jpg" width="500" height="492" alt="Mr. Brooke's House." />
+<p class="caption">MR. BROOKE'S HOUSE.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>The establishment consists of six Europeans, and the house contains one
+large receiving-room, and several smaller ones, appropriated to the
+residents as sleeping apartments, besides Mr. Brooke's own private<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_8" id="Page_8">[8]</a></span>
+rooms. The large room is decorated with rifles, swords, and other
+instruments of warfare, European and native; and it is in this room that
+the European rajah gives his audiences: and it is also in this room that
+every day, at five o'clock, a capital dinner is served up, to which we
+were made heartily welcome. During our stay, Mr. Brooke, accompanied by
+several of our officers and some of the residents, made an excursion up
+the river. We started early in the morning, with a flowing tide; and,
+rapidly sweeping past the suburbs of the town, which extend some
+distance up the river, we found ourselves gliding through most
+interesting scenery. On either side, the river was bounded by gloomy
+forests, whose trees feathered down to the river's bank, the water
+reflecting their shadows with peculiar distinctness. Occasionally the
+scene was diversified by a cleared spot amidst this wilderness, where,
+perchance, a half-ruined hut, apparently not inhabited for years, the
+remains of a canoe, together with fragments of household utensils, were
+to be seen, proving that once it had been the abode of those who had
+been cut off by some native attack, and probably the heads of its former
+occupants were now hanging up in some skull-house belonging to another
+tribe. The trees were literally alive with monkeys and squirrels, which
+quickly decamped as we approached them. Several times we were startled
+by the sudden plunge of the alligators into the water, close to the
+boats, and of whose propinquity we were not aware until they made the
+plunge. All these rivers are infested with alligators, and I believe
+they are very often mischievous; at all events, one of our youngsters
+was continually in a small canoe, paddling about, and the natives
+cautioned us that if he was not careful he certainly would be taken by
+one of these animals.</p>
+
+<p>Early in the afternoon we disembarked at a Chinese village twenty-five
+miles from Kuchin. The inhabitants of this village work the gold and
+antimony mines belonging to Mr. Brooke. We remained<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_9" id="Page_9">[9]</a></span> there for the
+night, and the next morning proceeded further up the river, and landed
+at another village, where we breakfasted, and then proceeded on foot to
+visit the mines. Our path lay through dense forests of gigantic trees,
+whose branches met and interlaced overhead, shading us from the burning
+rays of the sun. At times we would emerge from the wood, and find
+ourselves passing through cultivated patches of ravines, enclosed on all
+sides by lofty mountains, covered with foliage. In these spots we found
+a few natives with their families, who seemed to be contented in their
+perfect isolation; for in these secluded spots generations may pass
+away, and know no world beyond their own confines of forest jungle. At
+times our route was over mountains, whose appearance was so formidable
+that our hearts almost failed us at the prospect of having to scale
+them; but we succeeded beyond our expectations, and at length arrived at
+the antimony village, not a little pleased at our labours being ended.
+Our spirits, which had been flagging, were revived by a pull at the
+bottle. From our resting-place we had a good view of the mine, which is
+a source of great profit to Mr. Brooke. The antimony is obtained from
+the side of a hill, the whole of which is supposed to be formed of this
+valuable mineral. The side at which the men are at work shines like
+silver during the day, and may be seen several miles distant, strangely
+contrasting with the dark foliage of the adjoining jungles. The ore is
+conveyed to Kuchin, and is there shipped on board of the Royalist, (Mr.
+Brooke's schooner yacht,) and taken to Sincapore, where it is eagerly
+purchased by the merchants, and shipped for England.</p>
+
+<p>After partaking of a little refreshment we set off, through woods and
+over mountains, as before, to visit the gold mine. On our arrival at
+every village on the road, a certain number of guns were fired by the
+natives, in honour of the European rajah; and the same ceremony was
+repeated when we left it. It was late in the afternoon before we<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_10" id="Page_10">[10]</a></span>
+arrived at the village attached to the gold mine. It is prettily
+situated in the depth of a valley, through which runs a small rivulet.</p>
+
+<p>On every side mountains soar into the clouds, which must be passed
+before you can reach the village. Dinner had been prepared for us by the
+inhabitants of the village, who were a colony of Chinese; and it was
+served up in a large building dedicated to Joss, whose shrine was
+brilliantly illuminated with candles and joss-sticks. Some of the
+officers unthinkingly lighted their cigars at the altar. The Chinese,
+observing it, requested very civilly that they would do so no more; a
+request which was, of course, complied with. After dinner we all
+proceeded to the rivulet, in search of gold; the natives had cleared out
+the bed of the river; the sand and stones were thrown into an artificial
+sluice for washing it; and a little gold was found by some of the party.
+This gold mine, if it may be so called, is worth to Mr. Brooke about
+1000l. per annum, after all the expenses are paid. Its real value is
+much greater; but the Chinese conceal a great quantity, and appropriate
+it to themselves. But if the particles of gold which are brought down by
+a small rivulet are of such value, what may be the value of the mines
+above, in the mountains as yet untrodden by human feet? This, it is to
+be hoped, enterprise will some day reveal.</p>
+
+<p>We remained at the village that night, and at daylight commenced our
+journey back to the village from which we had started the day before.
+There we embarked, and proceeded down the river to the first Chinese
+village, at which we arrived in the course of the afternoon. A short
+distance inland is a mountain, called Sarambo, which it was proposed to
+ascend, as, by our telescopes, we could perceive houses near to its
+summit, and were told it was the residence of some of the mountain Dyaks
+under Mr. Brooke's sway. From the village this mountain wore the
+appearance of a huge sugar-loaf, and its sides appeared inaccessible.
+Mr. Brooke, with his usual kindness,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_11" id="Page_11">[11]</a></span> gave his consent, and despatched a
+messenger to the Dyak village, requesting the chief to send a party down
+by daylight the next morning, to convey our luggage up the mountain. At
+day-dawn we were awakened by a confused noise outside of the house, and,
+looking out, we perceived that more than a score of these mountain Dyaks
+had arrived. Most of them had nothing on but the usual strip of cotton;
+some few had on red baize jackets. They all wore a peculiar kind of
+<i>kris</i>, and many had spears, sampitans, and shields. They were
+fine-limbed men, with muscles strongly developed. Their hair fell down
+their backs, and nearly reached their middle: it was prevented from
+falling over the face by a fillet of grass, which was ornamented with
+mountain flowers.</p>
+
+<div class="figleft">
+<img src="images/013.jpg" width="157" height="300" alt="Dyak Head" />
+<p class="caption">DYAK HEAD.</p>
+<!--This picture was mid-paragraph top left on page 13 of the original text but
+has been moved here floated left on page 12 as it is relevant to the long paragraph
+of text on page 12-13.-->
+</div>
+
+<p><a name="head" id="head"></a>After a hurried breakfast we set off for the foot of the mountain, our
+party amounting to about eighty people. The guides led the way, followed
+by the Europeans; and the Dyaks, with the luggage, brought up the rear.
+In this order we commenced the ascent. Each person was provided with a
+bamboo, which was found indispensable; and thus, like a party of
+pilgrims, we proceeded on our way; and before we had gone very far, we
+discovered that we were subjected to severe penance. The mountain was
+nearly perpendicular. In some places we had to ascend by a single piece
+of wood, with rough notches for the feet, resting against a rock twenty
+or thirty feet above our heads; and on either side was a precipice, so
+that a false step must have been certain death. In other places a single
+piece of bamboo was thrown over a frightful chasm, by way of bridge.
+This, with a slight bamboo rail for the hand, was all that we had to
+trust to. The careful manner in which we passed these dangers was a
+source of great laughter and amusement to the Dyaks who followed us.
+Accustomed from infancy to tread these dangerous paths, although heavily
+laden, they scorned to support themselves. Some of our party were nearly
+exhausted,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_12" id="Page_12">[12]</a></span> and a long way in the rear before we came to the village. We
+had to wait for their coming up, and threw ourselves under the shade of
+some huge trees, that we might contemplate the bird's-eye view beneath.
+It was a sight which must be seen to be appreciated. Almost as far as
+the eye could reach was one immense wooded plain, bounded by lofty
+mountains in the far distance, whose tops pierced the clouds. The rivers
+appeared like silver threads, running through the jungles; now breaking
+off, and then regained. At our feet lay the village we had started from,
+the houses of which appeared like mere points. Shakspeare Cliff was as
+nothing to it, and his beautiful lines would have fallen very short of
+the mark; and while we gazed, suddenly a cloud below us would pass
+between us and the view, and all would be hidden from the sight. Thus we
+were far above the clouds, and then the clouds would break, and open,
+and pass and repass over each other, until, like the dissolving views,
+all was clear again, although the landscape was not changed. It was
+towards noon before we saw the first mountain village, which we did not
+immediately enter, as we waited the arrival of the laggards: we stopped,
+therefore, at a spring of cold water, and enjoyed a refreshing wash.
+Here we fell in with some pretty Dyak girls, very scantily clothed, who
+were throwing water at each other in sport. We soon came in for a
+plentiful share, which we returned with interest; and in this amusing
+combat we passed half an hour, until all had joined the party. We then
+entered the village, which was situated in a grove of trees. The houses
+were built upon posts, as those down by the river side. They were
+immensely large, with a bamboo platform running the whole length of the
+building, and divided into many compartments, in each of which a Dyak
+family resides. We were escorted, through a crowd of wondering Dyaks, to
+a house in the centre of the village, which was very different in
+construction from the others. It was perfectly round, and well
+ventilated <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_13" id="Page_13">[13]</a></span>by numerous port-holes in the roof, which was pointed. We
+ascended to the room above by means of a rough ladder, and when we
+entered we were rather taken aback at finding that we were in the Head
+House, as it is termed, and that the beams were lined with human heads,
+all hanging by a small line passed through the top of the skull. They
+were painted in the most fantastic and hideous manner; pieces of wood,
+painted to imitate the eyes, were inserted into the sockets, and added
+not a little to their ghastly grinning appearance. The strangest part of
+the story, and which added very much to the effect of the scene, was,
+that these skulls were perpetually moving to and fro, and knocking
+against, each other. This, I presume, was occasioned by the different
+currents of air blowing in at the port-holes cut in the roof; but what
+with their continual motion, their nodding their chins when they hit
+each other, and their grinning teeth, they really appeared to be endowed
+with new life, and were a very merry set of fellows. However, whatever
+might be the first impression occasioned by this very unusual sight, it
+very soon wore off, and we amused ourselves with those motions which
+were "not life," as Byron says; and, in the course of the day, succeeded
+in making a very excellent dinner in company with these gentlemen,
+although we were none of us sufficiently Don Giovannis to invite our
+friends above to supper. We visited three villages on the Sarambo
+mountain. Each of these villages was governed by a chief of its own, but
+they were subordinate to the great chief, residing in the first village.</p>
+
+<p>In the evening the major portion of the population came to the Head
+House, to exhibit to us their national dances. The music was composed of
+two gongs and two large bamboo drums. The men stood up first, in war
+costume, brandishing their spears and shields, and throwing<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_14" id="Page_14">[14]</a></span> themselves
+into the most extraordinary attitudes, as they cut with their knives at
+some imaginary enemy; at the same time uttering the most unearthly
+yells, in which the Dyak spectators joined, apparently highly delighted
+with the exhibition. The women then came forward, and went through a
+very unmeaning kind of dance, keeping time with their hands and feet;
+but still it was rather a relief after the noise and yelling from which
+we had just suffered. The chief, Macuta, expressing a wish to see a
+specimen of our dancing, not to let them suppose we were not as warlike
+as themselves, two of the gig's boat's crew stood up, and went through
+the evolutions of the broad-sword exercise in a very creditable manner.
+After this performance one of the seamen danced the sailor's hornpipe,
+which brought forth a torrent of yells instead of bravos, but they
+certainly meant the same thing. By this time, the heat from a large
+fire, with the smell of humanity in so crowded a room, became so
+overpowering, that I was glad to leave the Head House to get a little
+fresh air, and my ears relieved from the dinning of the drums and gongs.
+It was a beautiful starry night, and, strolling through the village, I
+soon made acquaintance with a native Dyak, who requested me to enter his
+house. He introduced me to his family, consisting of several fine girls
+and a young lad. The former were naked from the shoulders to below the
+breasts, where a pair of stays, composed of several circles of
+whalebone, with brass fastenings, were secured round their waists; and
+to the stays was attached a cotton petticoat, reaching to below their
+knees. This was the whole of their attire. They were much shorter than
+European women, but well made; very interesting in their appearance, and
+affable and friendly in their manners. Their eyes were dark and
+piercing, and I may say there was something wicked in their furtive
+glances; their noses were but slightly flattened; the mouth rather
+large; but when I beheld the magnificent teeth which required all its
+size to display, I<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_15" id="Page_15">[15]</a></span> thought this rather an advantage. Their hair was
+superlatively beautiful, and would have been envied by many a courtly
+dame. It was jet black, and of the finest texture, and hung in graceful
+masses down the back, nearly reaching to the ground. A mountain Dyak
+girl, if not a beauty, has many most beautiful points; and, at all
+events, is very interesting and, I may say, pretty. They have good eyes,
+good teeth, and good hair;&mdash;more than good: I may say splendid;&mdash;and
+they have good manners, and know how to make use of their eyes. I shall,
+therefore, leave my readers to form their own estimates by my
+description. Expecting to meet some natives in my ramble, I had filled
+my pockets with ship's biscuit, and which I now distributed among the
+ladies, who appeared very grateful, as they rewarded me, while they
+munched it, by darting wicked glances from their laughing eyes.</p>
+
+<p>Observing that the lad wore a necklace of human teeth round his neck,
+his father explained to me, in pantomime, that they were the teeth of an
+enemy whom he slew in battle, and whose head was now in the Head House.</p>
+
+<p>As it was getting late I bade my new friends farewell, by shaking hands
+all round. The girls laughed immoderately at this way of bidding
+good-bye, which, of course, was to them quite novel. I regretted
+afterwards that I had not attempted the more agreeable way of bidding
+ladies farewell, which, I presume, they would have understood better; as
+I believe kissing is an universal language, perfectly understood from
+the equator to the pole.</p>
+
+<p>At daylight the next morning we descended the mountain, and, embarking
+in the boats, arrived at the ship late in the afternoon.</p>
+
+<p>While at Sarawak we witnessed a very strange ceremony. Hearing a great
+noise in a house, we entered, and found ourselves in a large room
+crowded to excess by a numerous assemblage, singing in any<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_16" id="Page_16">[16]</a></span> thing but
+harmony. They proved to be natives of Java, assembled for the purpose of
+celebrating one of their festivals. On our entrance into the house, we
+were literally covered by the inmates with perfumes of the most
+delightful fragrance. Some of these odours were in a liquid state, and
+were poured down our backs, or upon our heads; others were in a state of
+powder, with which we were plentifully besprinkled. We were then
+escorted into the centre of the room, where we found a circle of elderly
+men, who were reading portions of their sacred books, and their voices
+were accompanied by music from instruments of native manufacture. We
+were treated with great attention, being permitted to enter the circle
+of the elders, who ordered the attendants to hand us refreshments, which
+consisted of cakes made of rice and cocoa-nut oil, and Sam-schoo. Some
+of our party, having become slightly elevated, volunteered a song, which
+proposition was opposed by the more reasonable. The Javanese were
+appealed to by the former, and they gave their votes in favour of the
+song. It was accordingly sung by our whole party, much to the delight of
+our kind entertainers, who, no doubt, considered that we felt and
+appreciated their rites. At length we took our leave, well pleased with
+our novel entertainment. So well did we succeed in making ourselves
+agreeable, that we received an invitation for the following night.</p>
+
+<p>July 10th.&mdash;In the evening a display of fireworks took place, notice of
+which had been given to the rajah, and, indeed, to the whole population
+of Kuchin, who had all assembled near to the ship, to witness what they
+considered a most wonderful sight. Seamen were stationed at all the
+yard-arms, flying jib, and driver booms, with blue-lights, which were
+fired simultaneously with the discharge of a dozen rockets, and the
+great gun of a royal salute. The echoes reverberated for at least a
+minute after the last gun of the salute had been fired; and, judging by
+the yells of the natives, the display must have created a<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_17" id="Page_17">[17]</a></span> strong
+sensation. Immediately after the salute, the anchor was weighed, and we
+commenced dropping down the river with the ebb tide; but we soon
+grounded on the mud, and we remained all night with the bowsprit in the
+bushes which grow on the banks of the river.</p>
+
+<p>The ship floated the next morning; the anchor was weighed, and with the
+assistance of the ebb tide, we dropped down the river at the rate of
+five miles per hour. As we were nearing a cluster of dangerous rocks,
+about a mile below Kuchin, we found that the ship was at the mercy of
+the rapid tide; and, notwithstanding all our endeavours, the ship struck
+on the rocks. Anchors were immediately laid out, but to no effect: the
+water rapidly shallowed, and we gave up all thoughts of getting off
+until the next flood tide. As the water left the ship, she fell over to
+starboard, and, an hour after she had grounded, she listed to starboard
+25 degrees. Our position was now becoming critical: the main deck ports
+had been shipped some time previous, but this precaution did not prevent
+the water from gaining entrance on the main and lower decks. As she
+still continued to heel over to starboard, a hawser was taken on shore,
+and, by purchases, set taut to the mast head; but before this could be
+accomplished she had filled so much that it proved useless.</p>
+
+<p>A boat was now despatched to Kuchin, to acquaint Mr. Brooke with our
+disaster, and to request the assistance of the native boats. During the
+absence of the boats, the top-gallant-masts had been sent down, and
+topmasts lowered; but the ship was now careening over 46 degrees, and
+full of water. All hopes of getting her off were therefore, for the
+present, abandoned; and we commenced removing every thing that could be
+taken out of her in the boats. The surveying instruments and other
+valuables, were sent up to Kuchin in the gig; and afterwards every thing
+that could be obtained from the ship was brought up in the native boats,
+as well as the whole crew of the <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_18" id="Page_18">[18]</a></span>Samarang. Mr. Brooke insisted upon all
+the officers making a temporary abode at his house, and prepared a shed
+for the crew. An excellent dinner was laid before the officers, while a
+substantial mess of fowls and rice was served out to the crew. In fact,
+the kindness of Mr. Brooke was beyond all bounds. The gentlemen who
+resided with him, as well as himself, provided us with clothes from
+their own wardrobes, and during our protracted stay did all in their
+power to make us comfortable; indeed, I may safely say, that we were so
+happy and comfortable, that there were but very few of the officers and
+crew of the Samarang that ever wished to see her afloat again. But I
+must return to my narrative.</p>
+
+<p>The morning after our disaster we went down to the ship, and commenced
+recovering provisions and stores, sending down masts and yards, and
+every other article deemed necessary; and this was continued for several
+days: during which the midshipmen, petty officers, and seamen were
+removed to the opposite shore, where two houses had been, by Mr. Brooke,
+prepared for their reception. Our house, (the midshipmen's) we
+christened Cockpit Hall; it was very romantically situate in the middle
+of a plantation of cocoa nut, palm, banana, and plantain trees. It was
+separated from the house in which the seamen were barracked by a small
+kind of jungle, not more than 300 yards in extent, but so intricate that
+we constantly lost our way in it, and had to shout and receive an
+answer, or go back and take a fresh departure. Our garden, in which
+there was a delightful spring of cold water, extended on a gentle slope
+about a hundred yards in front of the house, where its base was watered
+by a branch of the Sarawak; in which we refreshed ourselves by bathing
+morning and evening, in spite of the numerous alligators and water
+snakes with which the river abounds. But our incautious gambols received
+a check. Two of our party agreed to proceed to the mouth of the branch I
+have mentioned,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_19" id="Page_19">[19]</a></span> to determine which could return with the greatest
+speed. They had commenced their swimming race, when we, who stood ashore
+as umpires, observed an enormous water snake, with head erect, making
+for the two swimmers. We cried out to them to hasten on shore, which
+they did; while we kept up a rapid discharge of stones at the head of
+the brute, who was at last driven off in another direction. This
+incident induced us to be more cautious, and to keep within safe
+boundary for the future.</p>
+
+<p>Our repose at Cockpit Hall was, however, much disturbed by the nightly
+visits of wild hogs, porcupines, wild cats, guanos, and various other
+animals, some of which made dreadful noises. When they paid us their
+visits, we all turned out, and, armed with muskets, commenced an assault
+upon them, which soon caused them to evacuate our domain; but similar
+success did not attend our endeavours to dislodge the swarms of
+musquitos, scorpions, lizards, and centipedes from our habitations. They
+secreted themselves in the thatch, and the sides of the house during the
+day, and failed not to disturb with their onslaughts during the whole of
+the night.</p>
+
+<p>July 22d.&mdash;Mr. Hooper, the purser, was despatched in the Royalist to
+Sincapore, to purchase provisions and obtain assistance from any of the
+men-of-war who might be lying in the roads.</p>
+
+<p>It is not necessary to enter into a minute detail of the service which
+we were now employed upon. It certainly was not a service of love, as we
+had to raise a ship which we hoped would remain where she was. To enter
+into particulars, technical terms must be resorted to, which would only
+puzzle the reader. The position of the Samarang was simply this: she lay
+on a rock, and had filled by careening over; as long as she was on her
+side, the water rose and fell in her with the flood and ebb of the tide;
+but if once we could get her on an even keel, as soon as the water left
+her with the ebb of the tide, all we had to do<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_20" id="Page_20">[20]</a></span> was to pump her out, and
+then she would float again. To effect this, we had to lighten her as
+much as possible, by taking out of her her guns and stores of every
+description; then to get purchases on her from the shore, and assist the
+purchases with rafts under her bilge, so as to raise her again upon an
+even keel. On the second day after she filled, when the tide had run
+out, we removed all our chests from the lower deck; most of them were
+broken, and a large proportion of the contents missing. On the 27th May
+every thing had been prepared, and the attempt to get the vessel on an
+even keel was made, and it proved successful, as it well might with the
+variety of purchases, and the force of men we had at our disposition.
+When we repaired to the ship with 100 Malays to man the purchase-falls,
+the tide was ebbing fast, and the pumps were immediately set to work; so
+that at midnight, when the tide commenced flowing, the ship was nearly
+free of water. The purchases were then manned, and with the assistance
+of the rafts the ship gradually righted. The following day, about
+half-past two in the morning, the ship was free of water, and had risen
+to a careen of 30&deg;; at 3 o'clock she floated into deep water, and was
+then anchored. During the forenoon of the same day the ship was towed to
+her former anchoring ground off Kuchin. The same night the Harlequin and
+Royalist arrived in the river, and a day or two afterwards a brig and
+schooner came over with the intention of bidding for the remains of the
+ship, and of stocking the officers with clothes and necessaries. This
+was a losing speculation, as may be imagined, arising from a report
+having been circulated that it was impossible to raise the ship,
+whereas, as the reader will perceive, there was very little difficulty
+in so doing, nothing but sufficient strength being required.</p>
+
+<p>Our ship, as may be supposed, was in a most filthy state after the late
+immersion. Plunging into a river does not clean a vessel,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_21" id="Page_21">[21]</a></span> although it
+does a man. The decks were literally coated with mud and slime, which
+emitted the most foetid odour. Silver spoons, watches, and valuables of
+every description, were everywhere strewed about, few of which ever
+reached their rightful owners; for the Malays who were employed to clean
+the ship had an eye to business, and secreted every thing which was
+portable. By dint of great exertion, the ship was in a few days ready to
+receive her tanks, guns, and stores, which were embarked by the
+Harlequin's boats and boats' crews. She was soon in a forward state, and
+an expedition was formed to survey a part of the coast during the
+completion of her refitting. The gig and one of the barges were fitted
+out for this service, and on August the 13th, at daylight, we left
+Kuchin, well armed, and provisioned for ten days. At 10 <small>A. M.</small> we dropped
+anchor under the Peak of Santabong, from which the branch of the Sarawak
+we were then in derives its name. Here we remained a short time to
+refresh the men, who had not ceased tugging at the oar from the time
+that we started. The foot of the Santabong mountain is about a quarter
+of a mile from the river. It then ascends almost perpendicularly to a
+great height, towering far above the neighbouring mountains. Afterwards
+it runs seaward for a mile or two, and terminates in a remarkable peak,
+which forms the eastern horn of the extensive bay between it and Tanjon
+Datu. Here we were about a week, during which time we had extended our
+survey to the last-mentioned cape, which is about forty miles to the
+westward of Santabong. While in the vicinity of Datu, a strict watch was
+kept, that we might have timely notice of the approach of any prahus. A
+short distance from the cape is a delightful bay studded with small
+islets, which is known by the appellation of Pirate's Bay, so called
+from its being a favourite resort of the Illanoan pirates. It was in
+this bay that the Dido's boats were anchored when they were surprised by
+several<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_22" id="Page_22">[22]</a></span> piratical prahus, the look-out men in the European boats,
+exhausted by the heat and long pulling at the oar, having fallen asleep.
+They had scarcely time to cut the cables and grasp their weapons ere
+they were assailed on all sides by the pirates, who felt confident of
+success, from having found them napping. But they little knew what
+people they had to deal with, and if Jack was asleep when they made the
+attack, they found him wide awake when they came to close quarters. All
+their endeavours to board in the face of the rapid fire of the boats'
+guns and small arms proved abortive, and they soon discovered that it
+would be quite sufficient for their purpose if, instead of capturing the
+boats, they could make their own escape. One of the prahus, pierced by
+the well-directed shot, foundered, another was abandoned, and the rest,
+favoured by darkness, made their escape. For a more detailed account, I
+must refer the reader to Captain Keppel's work on Borneo.</p>
+
+<p>During the survey, we visited the islands of Talen Talen&mdash;the Malay word
+for turtle. These islands are the property of Mr. Brooke. A few Malays
+lived on the largest of them for the purpose of getting turtle eggs,
+with which they supply the trading prahus, who continually call here to
+lay in a stock of these eggs, which are considered a great luxury by the
+Malays. We landed with Mr. Williamson, the Malay interpreter at Sarawak,
+belonging to Mr. Brooke's establishment. We were well received by the
+Malays, who knew Mr. Williamson well, and he informed them that our
+object was to procure a live turtle. They requested us to take our
+choice of the numerous turtle then lying on the beach. We selected one
+of about three cwt.; but although the turtles are never turned on this
+island, she appeared to be aware that such was our intention, and
+scuttled off as fast as she could for the water; however, we intercepted
+her, and with some difficulty secured our prize. From one of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_23" id="Page_23">[23]</a></span> the
+numerous nests on the beach we took 600 turtle eggs. As many thousands
+could have been as easily procured, but we had sufficient for our wants.
+The Malays watch during the night, to ascertain where the turtle
+deposits her eggs, for as soon as she has finished her task, she covers
+them with her nippers with sand, and immediately retires into the sea. A
+piece of wood is then set up as a mark for the nest, which is rifled as
+occasion requires. It is a curious fact that the male turtle never
+lands.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="malays" id="malays"></a>
+<img src="images/023.jpg" width="600" height="353" alt="Malays Of Kuchin." />
+<p class="caption">MALAYS OF KUCHIN.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>After visiting several villages on the coast, we returned to Kuchin on
+Saturday the 19th, when we found that death had deprived us of our only
+musician on board the ship, a loss which was much felt by the crew, as
+he contributed much to their amusement. One of the supernumerary boys
+had also fallen a victim to the dysentery; but, although we deplored our
+loss, we had great reason to be thankful that it had been no greater, as
+on the day we left Kuchin, we had upwards of seventy men on the sick
+report. The same day, at noon, the anchor was weighed, and we dropped
+down the river with the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_24" id="Page_24">[24]</a></span> ebb tide. Strange to say, in spite of all our
+precautions, we struck on the same reef of rocks again; fortunately,
+however, the ship turned with the tide and grounded in the mud close to
+the bushes, from whence there was no extricating her till the flood tide
+had made. In the afternoon, when it was low water, a very large
+alligator was discovered asleep upon the rocks, which had been properly
+christened the Samarang Rocks, and which were now, at low ebb, several
+feet above water. A party of officers and marines pulled towards him,
+and fired a volley at him. The brute was evidently wounded, as he sprang
+up several feet in the air, and then disappeared under the water.
+Shortly after he again made his appearance, having landed on the
+opposite side of the river; his assailants again gave chase, and again
+wounded him, but he shuffled into the river and escaped.</p>
+
+<p>At three in the afternoon, we were much pleased at the arrival of the
+Diana, one of the Company's steamers, sent from Sincapore to our
+assistance. She proved extremely useful, for that night we gained
+fifteen miles, when we again grounded and remained all night. On the
+following day, at eleven <small>A. M.</small>, a cloud of thick smoke was observed
+rising above the jungle, which we immediately decided to proceed from a
+steamer. Shortly afterwards two masts appeared above the trees, and at
+one of them the Vixen's number was flying: she soon hove in sight. We
+weighed, and with the Harlequin, were towed down the river at a rapid
+pace. When we arrived at the entrance we anchored, finding there the
+Wanderer, and being joined soon afterwards by the Ariel, Royalist, and
+Diana, we formed a squadron of six vessels.</p>
+
+<p>On the 23d August, the Samarang, Harlequin, Ariel, and Royalist, weighed
+anchor and steered along the coast for Borneo Proper, where we arrived
+on Tuesday the 29th. On the Thursday following, Mr. Brooke, accompanied
+by the captains of the three men-of-war and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_25" id="Page_25">[25]</a></span> some officers, started in
+one of the barges for the city of Bruni, which was about eighteen miles
+from our anchorage. They had an audience with the sultan, but upon what
+cause I do not exactly know. They were treated with great civility, and
+returned to the ship about one o'clock on the following morning. My
+description of Bruni I shall reserve for a future visit. On the 5th of
+September we made sail for Hong Kong, with the Vixen in company, leaving
+the Ariel and Royalist to carry Mr. Brooke and the rajah's brother down
+to Sarawak. The Harlequin sailed for Sincapore. The Vixen having parted
+company to obtain fuel at Manilla, we continued our course to Hong Kong,
+where we arrived on the 14th inst., and found there Admirals Parker and
+Cochrane, in their respective ships the Cornwallis and Agincourt, with
+others of the squadron. We sailed again on the 2d of November, and after
+working up the coast of China for a week, we steered to the eastward,
+and on the 12th sighted the Bashee group. Here our surveying duties
+commenced in earnest, as we left the ship at four <small>A. M.</small> and did not
+return till darkness put an end to our labours. The governor of this
+group of islands sent a letter to our captain requesting the pleasure of
+seeing the ship in San Domingo Bay, where wood, water, and live stock
+could be obtained on reasonable terms. This letter was accompanied with
+a present of fruit and vegetables. A few days afterwards, we worked up
+to San Domingo Bay (Batan Island), and we were much surprised on our
+arrival to perceive that the town had a cathedral, of apparently ancient
+architecture, besides several houses built on the European style. The
+remainder of the town, which is of some extent, was composed of houses
+built of bamboo, and thatched with palm leaves.</p>
+
+<p>We anchored late in the afternoon, and were boarded by a Spanish
+military officer, who, to judge by certain signs and peculiarities, had
+been imbibing something stronger than water. The captain and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_26" id="Page_26">[26]</a></span> some of
+the officers went on shore, to call upon the governor. The governor's
+house was distinguished by a flag-staff, with the Spanish colours, or,
+rather, a remnant of the Spanish colours; and around the door stood a
+group of most indifferently clad Luzonian soldiers, turned out, we
+presumed, as a guard of honour. The governor was as much in dishabille
+as his troops, and shortly afterwards the party was joined by two
+priests and the governor's wife, a very pretty Creole, about twenty
+years of age. We were regaled with wine and chocolate, and parted late
+in the evening, on very friendly terms. The governor's house is a
+miserable abode: it has but one story, and the basement is a barrack for
+the soldiers. The upper part, inhabited by the governor, was very
+scantily furnished: a few old chairs, a couple of tables, and the walls
+whitewashed and decorated with prints of the Virgin Mary and his
+excellency's patron saint. The house of the priests, which adjoined the
+cathedral, was in much better repair, and more gaudy in the inside.</p>
+
+<p>There are three missions in Batan, each settlement having its cathedral
+and officiating priests. The natives, who are a distinct race, are
+well-proportioned, of a copper colour, and medium stature. They are very
+ugly: their hair is black, and cut short. Their usual dress consists of
+a piece of cotton, passed round the loins, and a peculiar-looking
+conical hat, surmounted with a tuft of goat's hair. In rainy weather
+they wear a cloak of rushes, through which the water cannot penetrate.
+The sole covering of the women is a piece of cotton, fastened below the
+bosom, and reaching down to the knee. Almost the whole of the Bashee
+group of islands are very mountainous. At the back of San Domingo the
+land rises to a great height, forming a remarkable peak, which can be
+seen many leagues distant. Bullocks, goats, pigs, and vegetables, can be
+obtained at a very moderate price; but very little fruit is grown, the
+natives usually preferring to cultivate<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_27" id="Page_27">[27]</a></span> yams, cocoas, and sweet
+potatoes. The sugar-cane is cultivated, and the tobacco grown here is
+considered, with great justice, far superior to any grown at Luzon.
+After a week's stay at San Domingo we ran down to Ivana, one of the
+missions, and made a rough survey of the bay. The mission house at this
+place was fitted up with every comfort, and we even found luxuries which
+we looked in vain for at San Domingo.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="batan" id="batan"></a>
+<img src="images/027.jpg" width="322" height="600" alt="Native of Batan." />
+<p class="caption">NATIVE OF BATAN.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>After completing the survey of this portion of the island, the governor
+(who had accompanied us from San Domingo) and a party of us set off to
+return to San Domingo by land. Our path lay over<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_28" id="Page_28">[28]</a></span> mountains nearly 2000
+feet in height, from the summit of which every point and inlet could be
+discerned, over the whole of the group which lay below, exactly as if
+they were laid down on a chart. Our walk was very fatiguing, and we were
+all rejoiced when, from an eminence, we descried the village of San
+Carlos, the residence of the warm-hearted and hospitable Father
+Nicholas. We descended into the vale, and were heartily welcomed by the
+jolly old priest, who regaled us with all that his larder could supply
+us. It had been arranged that the ship should leave Ivana for San
+Domingo on the following morning. At the entreaty of the good padre we
+remained at San Carlos all night, and the following morning returned to
+San Domingo, the ship anchoring in the bay on the same afternoon. We had
+now become quite domesticated with the friendly Spaniards. In the
+evenings we were received by an assemblage of the natives at the
+governor's house. They were dressed in their best, and went through an
+unmeaning dance, which was kept up till a late hour.</p>
+
+<p>On the 27th November we left Batan, and its kind inhabitants, who
+exacted a promise that we would return at some future period, and shaped
+a course for the Madjicosima islands, which are subject to the kingdom
+of Loo Choo. On the afternoon of the 1st of December land was discovered
+ahead, and a few hours afterwards we anchored in a narrow passage,
+surrounded by reefs on every side. We were anchored off the island of
+Pa-tchu-san, one of the group: it was very mountainous. On the following
+morning the captain and some of the officers went on shore. They were
+received by several hundred natives, who saluted them as they passed on
+their way to a temporary shed, where a levee was held by all the
+principal mandarins. Our Chinese interpreter, who was a native of
+Canton, explained the captain's wishes, and the nature of the service
+that we were employed on. They appeared uneasy at the proposal of our
+surveying the whole<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_29" id="Page_29">[29]</a></span> group, and informed the captain that they would
+refer the question to the viceroy, and give him a final answer on the
+morrow. This answer was in the affirmative, and a few days afterwards we
+commenced our survey of the islands. We were attended by the natives,
+who furnished us with horses, and anticipated our wishes in every thing
+that could make us comfortable. On the first day, at sunset, we arrived
+at a temple dedicated to Fo, romantically situated in a grove of trees,
+which concealed the elevation until you were within a few yards of it.
+Here it was proposed to take up our quarters for the night, and a more
+delightful spot could not well be imagined than our resting-place.</p>
+
+<p>The temple was built at the foot of a hill, within a few hundred yards
+of the sea. Lights were displayed as a signal to the stragglers, groups
+of whom might be seen by the light of the moon, reposing themselves on
+the ridge behind us. The glare of the torches brought them all down to
+us, both men and horses anxious for rest after the arduous toil of the
+day. Just as I was dropping off to sleep, one of my messmates said to
+another, "I say, Jemmy, I wonder whether your mother has any idea that
+you are sleeping in the temple of Fo, on the island of Pa-tchu-san?" A
+loud snore was the only reply, proving that the party addressed was
+unconscious of the island Pa-tchu-san, the temple of Fo, or of his
+mother, and the bells ringing for church.</p>
+
+<p>Pa-tchu-san, as I have before observed, is very mountainous and
+exceedingly picturesque. A high ridge covered with trees extends the
+whole length of the island, north and south. On either side of this
+ridge are innumerable grassy knolls and mounds from which we looked down
+upon the extensive plain on either side, which was studded with knolls
+similar to those that we were standing on. During our survey we passed
+through all the villages bordering the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_30" id="Page_30">[30]</a></span> sea, at the entrance of which we
+were invariably received by all the principal inhabitants. All their
+villages or towns are surrounded by the most luxurious groves, which
+have been apparently planted, for in many parts not a shrub could be
+seen beyond the confines of the town. The roads through the towns or
+streets generally meet at right angles, lined on each side with gigantic
+trees. The houses are built within enclosures raised with huge stones.
+These houses are strongly built, the frame being composed of four
+uprights of large timber, to which are attached cross pieces on the top
+of them, of the same dimensions as their supporters. Openings are left
+on each side of the house, which, when the owner pleases, can be closed
+by well-fitted shutters on the sliding principle. The roofs are thatched
+with paddy stalks. The floor frame is raised about two feet from the
+ground, and on it are fixed strong slips of bamboo, which are covered
+over with mats. These afford very comfortable sitting and sleeping
+apartments. The only inconvenience was, that the fire was made in the
+corner of the sitting-room, and as there was no vent for the smoke, we
+were nearly stifled. This nuisance was, however, soon removed by a word
+to the natives through the medium of the interpreter, and afterwards the
+fire was lighted, and the victuals cooked, at an adjoining shed.</p>
+
+<p>The natives of the Madjicosima islands are rather below the middle
+stature, but very strong and muscular. Their hair is worn in a very
+peculiar manner; the crown of the head is shaved, leaving a circle of
+long hair, which is turned up on the top of the head and tied into a
+knot of a peculiar shape. Through this knot of hair are passed two brass
+ornaments by the common people, but the chiefs are distinguished by
+silver ones. These are evidently intended to keep the knot in its right
+position. They cultivate the moustache and the beard, the latter being
+worn pointed. Their dress consists of a long<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_31" id="Page_31">[31]</a></span> loose robe of blue or
+cross-barred cotton stuffs, which reaches down nearly to the ancles.
+This robe is fastened to the waist by a girdle of the same material, and
+in which they keep their fans, pipes, &amp;c. The sleeves of the robe are
+very large, widening as they approach the wrists, which are consequently
+bare. Their shoes or sandals are very ingeniously made of wicker work,
+and confined to the foot by means of a strap between the larger toes of
+each foot.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="patchusan" id="patchusan"></a>
+<img src="images/031.jpg" width="450" height="535" alt="Native of Pa-tchu-san" />
+<p class="caption">NATIVE OF PA-TCHU-SAN.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>The inhabitants of these islands certainly deserve to be ranked among
+the most gentle and amiable of nations: no boisterousness attends their
+conversation, no violent gestures to give effect to the words; on the
+contrary, their voices are modulated when they are speaking, and their
+actions, although decided, are gentle. Their mode of salutation is
+graceful in the extreme. It consists in a low bending of the head,
+accompanied with a slight inclination of the body, and the hands closed,
+being raised at the same time to the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_32" id="Page_32">[32]</a></span> forehead. What a change in a few
+degrees of latitude, in manners, customs, and dispositions, between the
+savage pirates of Borneo and these amiable islanders!</p>
+
+<p>The plains between the mountains are cultivated as paddy fields: the
+soil appears very good, and there is little doubt but that every kind of
+fruit would grow if introduced into these islands; and what a fitting
+present it would be to them, if they were to be sent. They grow
+radishes, onions, and sweet potatoes, but not more than are sufficient
+for their own use. They supplied us with bullocks, pigs, goats, and
+fowls, but they seldom kill them for their own use; their principal diet
+being composed of shell fish and vegetables made into a sort of stew,
+which is eaten with rice, worked by the hand into balls. Every man of
+consequence carries with him a kind of portable larder, which is a box
+with a shelf in the middle, and a sliding door. In this are put cups of
+Japan, containing the eatables. This Chow Chow box is carried by a
+servant, who also takes with him a wicker basket, containing rice and
+potatoes for his own consumption.</p>
+
+<p>These islands have no intercourse with any part of the world except Loo
+Choo, to which they pay tribute as dependencies, and from whence they
+annually receive the necessaries they may require, by a junk. They had
+no idea that the continents of Europe or America existed. They had only
+heard of China, Loo Choo, and Japan, and they could hardly credit our
+assertions when we stated that we had lately gained a great victory over
+China. When we gave them a description of steam vessels, and first-rate
+men-of-war carrying 120 guns, they evidently disbelieved us. We were the
+first white men they had ever seen; and ludicrous was the repeated
+examination of our arms, which they bared and contrasted with their own.
+After great persuasion a few of the chief mandarins and their suites
+visited the ship, which was put in holiday attire upon the occasion. It
+would be<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_33" id="Page_33">[33]</a></span> impossible to attempt to describe their rapture at the
+neatness, order, and regularity which reigned on board. The guns were
+shotted and fired for their amusement: they threw up their hands in
+astonishment, and gazed on us and on each other with looks of blank
+amazement. During the whole of our peregrinations over these islands we
+never saw a female, for on our approach to any village a courier was
+sent ahead to warn the inhabitants of our arrival, when the women either
+shut themselves up or retired to an adjacent village until we had passed
+through. The men assisted us in our labours and attended to our comforts
+by all the means in their power. Horses were provided every day, houses
+for us at night, and good substantial repasts. Wherever they enter, the
+natives invariably eat and drink, more, I believe, from custom than from
+hunger. On these occasions tea is the general beverage, the kettle being
+a large shell, which admirably answers the purpose. It may be worthy of
+remark, that on entering a house, the shoes or sandals are invariably
+left at the door. Two of the chiefs were deservedly great favourites
+with our party; they were given the famous names of Chesterfield and
+Beaufort, the former from his gentlemanly manners, the latter from the
+profound knowledge he displayed of all rocks, shoals, &amp;c. On the 17th of
+December, having completed our survey of Pa-tchu-san, we returned to the
+ship: on the 22d we left our anchorage, which was christened Port
+Providence, and ran round to Kuchee Bay on the opposite side of the
+island. This noble bay was called Port Haddington, in honour of the late
+first lord of the Admiralty. On the 27th the first barge, cutter, and
+gig left the ship to survey the island Ku-king-san, the nearest port of
+which was about twenty miles from Kuchee Bay, alias Port Haddington,
+where we lay at anchor. The boats carried with them provisions for three
+weeks, by which time it was supposed that the survey would be completed.
+As the formation of this island is similar<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_34" id="Page_34">[34]</a></span> to Pa-tchu-san, it would be
+but repetition to describe it minutely, but it is worthy of remark that
+it is indented with numerous deep bays, in each of which there is
+sufficient water for a ship of the line. Many of these bays have natural
+breakwaters, created by shoals, with a deep water passage on either side
+of them, and which may be easily distinguished from the shoals by the
+deep blue colour of the water.</p>
+
+<p>On the 15th of January, 1844, the surveying party returned, having been
+absent twenty days. We were again visited by the mandarins, who came to
+bid us farewell: they quitted us with many expressions of good will, and
+expressed a wish that we would return again, and as <i>individuals</i>, I had
+no doubt of their sincerity.</p>
+
+<p>On the 18th of January we sailed for Ty-ping-san, which is situated
+about seventy miles north of Pa-tchu-san. On the following day we
+sighted the land, and late in the evening anchored off the coast. This
+island is low, compared with the other islands of the group. The
+following morning the captain landed and presented a letter of
+introduction given him by the mandarins of Pa-tchu-san. The letter of
+introduction had the best effects, for we were immediately visited by
+the principal mandarins, who informed us that we should be furnished
+with horses and every thing else that we might require.</p>
+
+<p>It was on a reef to the northward of this island that the Providence, of
+twenty guns, was wrecked about fifty years back. Captain Broughton and
+the crew arrived safely at Ty-ping-san, but the present inhabitants,
+when it was mentioned, either did not or would not recollect any thing
+of the circumstances. As a proof of the morality of these people, and
+how much crime is held in abhorrence, I have the following little
+history to narrate.</p>
+
+<p>During our survey, we fixed a station upon the extremity of a bleak and
+desolate point of land running more than a mile into the sea. There, in
+a cave formed by a reef on a mass of rock, we discovered<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_35" id="Page_35">[35]</a></span> two skeletons.
+This would not have so much excited our suspicion, had it not been from
+the remarkable locality, as in all the graves we fell in with the
+corpses were invariably uncoffined. We expressed a wish to know why such
+a spot should have been fixed upon as a last resting-place, as it was
+many miles from the nearest habitation. It was not until after much
+entreaty that they at length, very reluctantly, consented to give us the
+desired explanation, which, as nearly as I can recollect, was as
+follows:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>A young girl, who was considered as the belle and pride of the nearest
+town, had formed an attachment to a youth who had been brought up with
+her, as a playmate, from their earliest years; and it was acknowledged
+by the inhabitants of the town that a more fitting match could not be
+made, as the young man was of most graceful mien, and equally well
+favoured as his mistress; but the father of the girl, who had been all
+along blind to the natural consequences of their long intimacy, had
+other views for his daughter, and had selected a husband for her whose
+chief recommendation was his wealth. So far it is the old story.</p>
+
+<p>To oppose her father's commands was not to be thought of, for filial
+obedience is, with this people, one of the most sacred of duties. The
+bridal day approached; presents had been exchanged between the parents
+of the parties; and every thing was in a forward state for the
+celebration of the nuptials, with all the magnificence befitting the
+wealthy condition of the bridegroom. The lovers were in a state of
+phrensy, but solaced themselves with stolen interviews. At length the
+poor girl, urged by her lover, confessed every thing to her father, and
+implored his mercy. He was thunderstruck at this intelligence, for till
+that moment he had imagined that his daughter had not a thought to which
+he was not privy. The most rigorous discipline was resorted to&mdash;the girl
+was confined to her chamber, and spies<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_36" id="Page_36">[36]</a></span> placed to watch every motion.
+Those to whom she thought she could trust were suborned by her father,
+and to him were conveyed all the letters which she believed to have been
+safely conveyed to her lover. His notes being also intercepted, at last
+each considered the other as faithless. The poor girl, imagining that
+her lover had forsaken her, at last sent to her father, to acquaint him
+that she had returned to her duty, and was ready to receive the man whom
+he had selected for her husband. They were married: but she deceived
+herself; as soon as the ceremony was over, the courage which had
+supported her gave way, her former feelings returned stronger than ever,
+and she hated herself for her fickleness. Her heart whispered that it
+was impossible that one possessing every great and every amiable
+quality, as did her lover, could ever have proved faithless, or would
+have abandoned one who loved him so dearly. As she sat in the garden and
+wept, a slight noise attracted her attention, and she found in her
+presence her lover, disguised, who had come to take a last farewell.
+Explanations immediately ensued&mdash;they found that they had been
+tricked&mdash;their love and their despair overcame their reason, and they
+fled. The father and bridegroom pursued the guilty pair, and after a
+most rigorous search, they were discovered. They knew that their fate
+was sealed, and they bore up bravely to the last. They were arraigned,
+found guilty, and condemned to death; after which their bodies were to
+be removed far from any dwelling-place. The sentence was carried into
+effect, and their remains were deposited in the cave in which we
+discovered them. Many parents might draw a lesson from this tragedy, and
+anybody who feels inclined may write a novel upon it; it must not,
+however, bear the same title as the Chinese one translated by Governor
+Davis, which is styled the "Fortunate Union."</p>
+
+<p>In ten days we completed the survey of the island, and sailed for Batan,
+where we arrived on the 7th of February. There we remained<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_37" id="Page_37">[37]</a></span> a few days,
+and then sailed for Hong Kong, having but three days' provisions on
+board. We encountered a heavy gale; but, fortunately, it was in our
+favour. On the 9th a junk was reported in sight; and in the course of an
+hour we were sufficiently near to perceive that the people on board of
+her were making signals of distress, and cutting away her masts. We hove
+to as near to her as we could venture, for the sea ran high, and lowered
+a boat, which reached the junk in safety. They found her to be in a
+sinking state: a hawser was made fast to her, with the intention of
+towing her into Hong Kong, then not fifty miles distant. We again made
+sail, towing the junk at a rapid rate; but the strain caused her planks
+to sever, and consequently increased the rush of water in her hold. The
+Chinese hailed the ship, and entreated to be rescued from their perilous
+condition. She was immediately hauled alongside, and twelve of her crew
+succeeded in getting on board of us; but the hawser gave way, and the
+junk drifted astern, with five men still remaining on board. Sail was
+immediately made, and in a short time we ran alongside of her, staving
+in her bulwarks, for both vessels were rolling heavily. Fortunately her
+mainmast had gone by the board; had it been still standing, and had
+become locked in our rigging, we should have been in great peril
+ourselves. The remaining five men and a dog gained the ship, and the
+junk again went astern, and in three minutes afterwards went to the
+bottom. When they saw her sink, the Chinese raised up a cry at their
+miraculous escape. One poor fellow had his hand shockingly mutilated, it
+having been crushed between the sides of the two vessels.</p>
+
+<p>The wind had now much subsided, and we made sail for Hong Kong, where we
+arrived on the following day. There we found the Agincourt, Sir Thomas
+Cochrane, who was now commander-in-chief, Sir William Parker having
+sailed for England. The cutter and two of the Company's steamers were
+also here; and the Minden hospital ship,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_38" id="Page_38">[38]</a></span> as usual, crowded with the
+sick and dying. Our first lieutenant, Mr. Wade, took this opportunity of
+leaving the ship, and Mr. Heard succeeded him.</p>
+
+<p>On the 6th we sailed for Macao, which is too well known to require any
+description here. On the 10th we sailed for Manilla, an account of which
+I shall reserve for our future visit. On the 1st of April we again
+sailed, on a surveying cruise, to the southward. After fixing the
+positions of several small islands in the Mendoro Sea, we steered for
+Samboangan, a Spanish penal colony, situated at the southern extremity
+of Mindanao. On the 8th we arrived there, and took up our anchorage
+close to the town.</p>
+
+<p>Samboangan is built on an extensive plain; most of the houses are
+supported on poles ten or twelve feet from the ground. The roofs are
+thatched, and the sides covered with palm leaves, ingeniously secured by
+strips of bamboo. The fort is well built; and although a century old, is
+in very good preservation. It has a numerous garrison, and is defended
+by guns of large calibre. There is also an establishment of gun-boats,
+which scour the coast in search of pirates. On each side, and at the
+back of the town, are groves of cocoa-nuts, bamboos, plantains, and
+other fruit trees, through which narrow paths are cut, forming
+delightful shady walks to a stranger, who gazes with astonishment and
+pleasure upon the variety of delicious fruits, of whose existence he had
+no idea. The plain on which the town is built extends about eight miles
+inland, when it is bounded by a chain of mountains, which divides the
+Spanish territory from that of the warlike tribes who inhabit the
+interior.</p>
+
+<p>The plain I have spoken of is covered with small villages, pleasantly
+situated among thick groves of trees; and it is watered by numerous
+streams. The whole country around Samboangan abounds in scenery of the
+most picturesque description; and the groups of gaily-dressed<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_39" id="Page_39">[39]</a></span> and
+joyous natives in no small degree add to the beauty of the landscape.
+Horses can be obtained at very moderate charges; but unfortunately no
+one has ever thought of establishing an hotel, and the want of one was
+much felt. We were, therefore, thrown upon the hospitality and kindness
+of the natives, who made us welcome by every demonstration in their
+power. Fruit, chocolate, and sweet biscuits, were the ordinary
+refreshments, for which the charges made scarcely repaid the trouble of
+preparing them.</p>
+
+<p>The church, priests' and governor's houses, are the only respectable
+buildings in the colony; the other houses in the town are very inferior,
+being inhabited by liberated exiles from Manilla. We remained here five
+days, and early on the morning of the 13th ran down to a watering-place
+about fifteen miles from the town, and completed our water.</p>
+
+<p>The same night we sailed for Sooloo; and the next day, when performing
+divine service, it being Sunday, the officer of the watch reported five
+prahus in sight, full of men, and each armed with a long gun, pulling
+towards the ship. It was quite calm at the time, and our main deck ports
+were open. No doubt they perceived the daylight through the ports, and
+satisfied themselves that we were a man-of-war, for they soon afterwards
+altered their course, and made for the shore. We presumed that they were
+pirates from the island of Baselan, who, fancying we were a merchant
+vessel, had come out with the intention of attacking us.</p>
+
+<p>At noon on the 16th of April we made the town of Sooloo, the capital of
+the island of the same name. It being calm, and the ship at some
+distance from the anchorage, the gig was sent ahead to board one of the
+three schooners lying in the bay, and hoist a light, as a guide to the
+ship; and a rocket was put into the boat to fire in case of being
+attacked by superior numbers. There were but five men in the gig!</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_40" id="Page_40">[40]</a></span>After two hours' hard pulling, they arrived alongside the largest of the
+three vessels. She proved to be the Velocipede, an English vessel,
+trading to Sooloo for pearl oysters. The owner of the schooner soon came
+from the shore, having been sent off by the sultan of Sooloo to know the
+object of our visit. He was accompanied by several Datus or chiefs, who
+went back to the town perfectly satisfied with the explanation given.
+But the arrival of a man-of-war appeared to excite the fears of the
+natives, for gongs were sounding throughout the night, and lights were
+flitting to and fro, by the aid of which it was perceived that there was
+a strong assemblage of the natives.</p>
+
+<p>The ship anchored on the afternoon of the following day, and the
+captain, attended by several of his officers, visited the sultan. We
+were received by the prime minister, who informed us that the sultan was
+somewhat indisposed, and begged to postpone the interview until the
+following day. Leaving the palace, we strolled through the town, which
+is partly built in the water; bridges, formed of interlaced bamboo, were
+the means of communication between the houses. As these bridges were
+some hundred yards in length, the walking was somewhat dangerous; a slip
+would have been the cause of a good ducking and a swim to any unlucky
+wight, which, I have no doubt, would have given great satisfaction to
+the townspeople, who, armed with spears, krisses, and shields, were
+watching our motions; but no such mishap occurred, and we returned on
+board before sunset. Next day the captain and the same party went again
+on shore, and were received by the sultan in person. He was dressed in
+the extreme of Malay fashion. He was an excessively plain young man, and
+seemed to be ill at ease during the whole of the conference. He appeared
+to be a mere puppet in the hands of his ferocious chiefs, who had all
+the conversation, without referring to their royal master at any time.</p>
+
+<p>The sultan's dress consisted of a purple satin jacket and green<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_41" id="Page_41">[41]</a></span> velvet
+trousers, both trimmed with gold and silver lace; a red sash confined
+his trousers at the waist; and in the sash he wore a kris of the most
+costly description. He wore diamond buttons on his jacket, which, being
+open, exposed his naked chest. But the party who mostly excited our
+interest was the heir apparent, a child of four years old, who was
+dressed as an adult, even to his miniature kris. He bids fair to be a
+handsome man. His laughing face and engaging manner caused him to be
+caressed by the whole party, a circumstance which evidently gave much
+pleasure to the sultan. We were regaled with chocolate, sweet cakes, and
+fruit; and every attention paid to us by the chiefs. At our departure
+the sultan and ministers shook hands warmly with every one of our party,
+and we returned on board, accompanied by Mr. Wyndham, of the Velocipede
+schooner, who, being a perfect master of the tongue, had acted as an
+interpreter on this occasion.</p>
+
+<p>The Samarang was the first English man-of-war that had called at Sooloo
+since the visit of Dalrymple in 1761, when he reinstated on the throne
+the sultan (grandfather to the present one), who had been deposed by his
+rebellious subjects.</p>
+
+<p>Great Sooloo is about fifty miles in length, and twenty-five in breadth,
+being the largest of a group of islands known as the Sooloo Archipelago.
+This group of islands is inhabited by a fierce and warlike race, bearing
+in their personal appearance a strong resemblance to the Malays,
+although the two languages differ materially from each other. Great
+Sooloo, the residence of the sultan, is very mountainous. Many of the
+mountains are wooded to the summit, while others are covered with
+patches of cultivation. These islands are thickly populated; and if the
+islanders do not practise piracy as a profession, they are always ready
+to aid, assist, and protect those who do. The town of Sooloo is well
+known to be the principal rendezvous of pirates, who, whenever<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_42" id="Page_42">[42]</a></span> they
+have made a capture, resort there to dispose of their lawless booty. The
+ministers, and even the sultan himself, are not able to resist the
+temptation of being able to purchase European goods, and articles of
+value, for less than half their real value. If not the stealers, they
+are the receivers, and thus they patronise piracy of every description.
+Governed by their own prince, and independent of any other power, the
+people of Sooloo have most extravagant notions of their own prowess, and
+of the strength of their fortifications; and they ridicule the idea of
+any one venturing to interfere with or attack them.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="sooloo" id="sooloo"></a>
+<img src="images/042.jpg" width="550" height="525" alt="Sooloo Village" />
+<p class="caption">SOOLOO VILLAGE.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>On the 18th of April we sailed from Sooloo, and visited several<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_43" id="Page_43">[43]</a></span> islands
+in the Archipelago, on one of which we grounded, but escaped without
+sustaining any damage. On the 23rd we anchored off Unsang, the eastern
+province of Borneo, where we remained four days surveying the coast. A
+shooting and fishing party visited the shore daily: the former killed
+several wild hogs, and the latter brought every evening a plentiful
+supply of fish.</p>
+
+<p>On the 27th of April sailed from Unsang. This day we first served out
+our ship-brewed porter, in addition to the usual allowance of spirits.
+It continued to be served out nightly, but opinions were very different
+about its merits.</p>
+
+<p>For several days after leaving Unsang, we had but little or no wind, and
+we were borne away by a strong easterly current, till we were carried in
+sight of Celebes, which is high and mountainous, and covered with dense
+forests of gigantic trees. On Sunday, the 4th of May, we arrived off
+Cape Rivers (Celebes), the position of which was determined by
+astronomical observations. It was the intention of the captain to have
+passed through the Straits of Macassar, but light wind, and a strong
+current from the southward, would not permit us to gain a mile per day.
+After experiencing very disagreeable weather while off the coast, we
+bore up and made sail for Monado, a Dutch settlement on one of the
+north-western promontories of this remarkably shaped island. Our passage
+was any thing but agreeable; scarcely a night passed that we were not
+visited by strong squalls, accompanied by thunder, lightning, and heavy
+rain. On Sunday, the 18th, we anchored in forty-eight fathoms off the
+town of Monado, within two cables' length of the shore, which shelves
+very suddenly into deep water. A kedge was laid out in-shore of the
+ship, and kept well taut; a requisite precaution, as otherwise, if the
+land breeze blew off strong, the ship would have dragged her anchor down
+the steep beach, and drifted out.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_44" id="Page_44">[44]</a></span>The town of Monado is built on a plain surrounded by mountains, the
+highest of which, Klabat, is 6000 feet above the level of the sea. The
+houses are well built, and neatly thatched; they are all detached, and
+enclosed in a yard or garden. The roads are excellent, and reflect great
+credit upon a Prussian engineer, who undertook the task. The fort, which
+is at the water's edge, is small, but strongly built, and well adapted
+to resist the attack of any native force, although I should imagine it
+could not hold out any time against the well-directed fire of a
+frigate's broadside. A party of us enjoyed a pleasant ramble through the
+town and suburbs, which are dotted with neat cottages, where their
+owners invited us to enter and partake of refreshments. We went into
+several, and found them scrupulously neat and clean, as Dutch houses
+usually are. The people who entertained us refused all compensation, and
+it was with difficulty that we prevailed upon the black-eyed damsels to
+accept our silk handkerchiefs by way of reminiscences. Very few
+Europeans reside here, although their half-bred offspring may be seen in
+every tenth person, and they boast of the European blood which flows in
+their veins. Monado abounds with poultry, fruit, vegetables, and all the
+necessaries of life. Cocoa and sugar are cultivated. Stock is easily
+obtained, and very moderate; and water is procured from a small river
+which divides the town. Boats should enter the river at last quarter
+flood, and return first quarter ebb, as the tide falls rapidly; and at
+low water the bar at the entrance is dry. During our stay we surveyed
+the major portion of the bay, finding nothing under 150 fathoms of water
+at one-third of a mile from the shore.</p>
+
+<p>We found here a Mr. Hart, who had been left at this place in consequence
+of his precarious state, from a gun-shot wound he had received on the
+Coti River (Borneo). Mr. Hart was a volunteer in the ill-fated
+expedition undertaken by Mr. Murray, who attempted to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_45" id="Page_45">[45]</a></span> establish a
+colony in the Coti River, and who lost his life in an encounter with the
+natives. The vessels employed&mdash;a brig and a schooner&mdash;were fitting out
+at Hong Kong while we were there. We fell in with the schooner (the
+Young Queen) the day after we left Manilla. The captain of her came on
+board to give us the intelligence of the failure of the expedition, with
+the death of its leader. Misfortune appeared to cling to them, for, soon
+after the schooner left Coti, the crew of her mutinied, and the mutiny
+was not put down but by the death of the ringleader, who was shot by the
+commander. He was bound to Hong Kong to deliver himself up for trial for
+taking the life of the man, and I hardly need observe that he was fully
+acquitted. This gentleman was a brother of Mr. Hart.</p>
+
+<p>On the 26th of May, our observations being completed, we sailed from
+Monado; Mr. Hart, with the captain's permission, taking advantage of
+this opportunity of reaching Sincapore. The following day we ran through
+the Straits of Banca, and steered for Ternate, off which island we
+arrived on the following Saturday. On Sunday morning, before daylight,
+we struck heavily on a coral reef, but by dint of great exertion we got
+off, and floated at six. A boat was despatched to the Dutch governor of
+the town to state that it was not our intention to anchor. The island of
+Ternate is, I believe, governed by a sultan, who has sway over several
+other islands. The Dutch have a settlement here, and have long been on
+good terms with the ruling powers. It is the most important of the
+Molucca group, as it produces a vast quantity of cloves, beside every
+variety of tropical fruits. It was taken by us in 1810, and restored in
+1815. This island, as far as I could judge, is perfectly round, and
+about twenty-five miles in circuit, the land gradually rising to a huge
+peak in the centre. It is of volcanic formation. It is well wooded, and
+abounds with game; and on this island the boa constrictor grows to the
+largest size, being<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_46" id="Page_46">[46]</a></span> often found upwards of thirty feet in length. The
+Dutch town is built on the south-east side of the island. The houses
+appear to be better constructed than those of Monado, and the whole town
+better arranged. There are several forts, two churches, and apparently
+about 400 houses. The one occupied by the governor is distinguished from
+the others by its size, and superiority of architecture and decorations.
+We obtained quantities of every description of fruit from the boats
+which crowded round the ship: in addition to shaddocks, pineapples,
+oranges, bananas, and many other common varieties, we had the delightful
+treat of the mangosteins, which grow only in these latitudes. It is
+impossible to describe the peculiarly grateful taste of this cool and
+refreshing fruit. It is a mixture of the sweet and acid, blended in the
+most luscious manner. It is in size somewhat smaller than an apple, and
+the skin, which is very thick and bitter, of a dark plum colour. This
+when dried is used as a remedy for the dysentery. The inside, which is
+nearly white, is divided into four parts, resembling in substance a firm
+jelly; and, in my opinion, gives one more the idea of what nectar was,
+or ought to be, than any thing else which enters into the mouth of man.
+We decided that the Peak of Ternate was the true Mount Olympus, and that
+it was there that the gods were assembled and, in ancient days, ate
+mangosteins, called nectar by the Greeks.</p>
+
+<p>The boat which had been sent on shore to the governor at length
+returned, and we made sail to the southward, to survey a portion of the
+coast of Gilolo (another of the Spice Islands), which was supposed to be
+laid down incorrectly in the charts.</p>
+
+<p>On the morning of Monday, the 3rd of June, the ship being off the coast
+of Gilolo, the gig with the captain, and the barge with several
+officers, left the ship with four days' provisions to survey a portion
+of the coast. At 11 <small>A. M.</small> they landed on a reef, running out about a<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_47" id="Page_47">[47]</a></span>
+cable's length from a small island. About two in the afternoon a body of
+natives, armed with spears and krisses, issued with loud yells from the
+jungle, and advanced towards them. At the same time a prahu pulled round
+a point, and made towards the barge, which was at anchor about fifty
+yards from the shore. The captain was at the time on shore taking
+observations, but as the natives approached he retired to the gig and
+got the arms in readiness. The natives came within 100 yards of us, and
+then halted. The captain signed them to go away: they approached nearer;
+we gave them a volley, and they hastily retreated into the jungle.</p>
+
+<p>The barge was now prepared for the expected attack of the prahu, which
+by this time had approached within point blank range of the barge's gun,
+which was a brass six-pounder. Observing, it is to be presumed, that the
+boat was so well-armed, and the men were loading the gun, the prahu
+ceased pulling, and hoisted Dutch colours. They were ordered to pull for
+the Gilolo shore, which they did; a rocket fired at them quickening
+their speed considerably. At 3 <small>P. M.</small> the observations being completed,
+the astronomical instruments were re-embarked on the barge, and the
+captain quitted the gig and went into the barge. Both boats were pulled
+towards the main land. On the in-shore side of the small island I have
+mentioned, we discovered a village consisting of fifteen or twenty
+houses. The gig was despatched with two officers to burn the village,
+which was done; the natives who were in the huts escaping into the
+jungle. In the mean time, the barge proceeded towards a large village in
+search of the prahu. On their way they fell in with a large canoe, at
+anchor in one of the creeks.</p>
+
+<p>Taking the canoe in tow, we again took to the oars, and in a short time
+perceived the natives hauling the prahu into a creek. A round of grape
+quickly decided the matter; the natives fled, and the prahu was quietly
+taken possession of by our crew. Having effected our<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_48" id="Page_48">[48]</a></span> object, we
+proceeded along the coast with our two prizes in tow. At sunset, after
+rifling the boats of arms, flags, and gongs, we set them on fire, and
+made sail to the southward; the gig, which had rejoined us, being in
+company. About midnight we anchored in a small and lonely bay,&mdash;I should
+say, twenty miles from where the above occurrences took place. We took
+our meals, but did not attempt to repose till after two in the morning,
+although we were quite tired after the events of the day before. We then
+lay down, and composed ourselves to sleep.</p>
+
+<p>We had not, however, been recumbent long, ere the sounds of gongs were
+heard at a distance; and shortly afterwards the man on the look-out
+reported that three prahus were coming into the bay. A short time
+sufficed to have every thing in readiness for the expected conflict.</p>
+
+<p>The foremost of the prahus approached within ten yards of the barge,
+lowered her sail, and rounded to. A native, one of the chiefs we
+presumed, inquired in broken English if we belonged to a ship. The
+captain would not satisfy him on that point, but desired him to go away.</p>
+
+<p>The other two prahus, having been joined by a third (making four in
+all), had now closed within half pistol shot, and lowered their sails.</p>
+
+<p>Seeing that we were completely enclosed, a musket-ball was fired over
+the largest prahu. The men in the prahus gave their accustomed yell, and
+the whole force advanced towards us.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_49" id="Page_49">[49]</a></span>The six-pounder, loaded with round and grape, was now fired into the
+largest prahu; the cries and confusion were great; the crew of the prahu
+leapt into the water, but few arrived on shore,&mdash;they sunk under the
+fire of our muskets. The three other prahus then commenced a spirited
+fire from their guns and small arms, assisted by a flight of arrows and
+spears.</p>
+
+<p>Pulling within twenty yards of them, we plied them alternately with
+grape and canister from our six-pounder. The engagement continued with
+great vigour for some time, when their fire slackened; and shortly
+afterwards two more of the prahus were deserted by their crews, who made
+for the shore; the fourth made off. The three prahus were taken
+possession of, towed into deep water, and anchored. Leaving the gig in
+charge of them, we went in pursuit of the fourth prahu, and soon came up
+with her; but her crew escaped by running the boat on shore.</p>
+
+<p>Another prahu now hove in sight, pulling, or rather paddling, towards
+us. Leaving our prize, we faced our new antagonist, saluting her with
+grape and musquetry, and causing so much havoc, that, shrieking and
+yelling, they made for the nearest shore without returning a single
+shot. We followed her, firing into her as fast as possible. On coming up
+with her we found her aground, with six dead and one mortally wounded;
+the remainder of the crew had saved themselves by wading to the shore.
+After getting this prahu afloat, we brought the other prahu, which we
+had just before captured (No. 4.), alongside. This boat was crowded with
+dead and dying. Among the latter was a female child, apparently about
+eight months old, in a state of nudity. The poor little creature's left
+arm was nearly severed from its body by a grape shot. She was removed
+into the boat, where the rest of the wounded were placed, with as much
+care as possible. A low moaning sound escaped from her lips, her eyes
+were glazed, and she evidently was fast dying: it would have been a
+mercy to have put an end to her sufferings. The dead were then thrown
+overboard, and the prahu set on fire; the last prahu, containing the
+wounded, was left to her fate.</p>
+
+<p>It was now daylight, and on looking around we perceived five more prahus
+off a point between the gig and ourselves in the barge<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_50" id="Page_50">[50]</a></span> and several
+others pulling in from seaward. We gave way for the five prahus, which
+were drawn up in a line ready to receive us. Notwithstanding their fire,
+assisted by their spears and other missiles, we pulled within fifteen
+yards of the outermost prahu of the five, and discharged our gun,
+accompanied by a volley of musquetry. The other prahus now closed and
+poured in a heavy fire; but, although the barge was struck, not one of
+our men was injured. The repeated fire from the boats soon caused the
+people in the prahus to make for the shore through the water, when many
+of them fell from our musquetry. It was now about six o'clock in the
+morning, our last charge of canister shot was in the gun, the last
+rocket in the tube, and nearly all the percussion caps expended. The
+barge was pulled closer to the nearest prahu to give more effect to the
+discharge, and the captain was in the stern of the barge with the rocket
+tube in hand, when one of the prahus on shore fired her swivel; the ball
+struck the captain, and knocked him overboard. He was hauled in, and we
+found that he had received a severe wound in the groin, which was
+dressed by the surgeon.</p>
+
+<p><i>Lieutenant Baugh</i> now took the command, and the gun was discharged with
+good effect, and all the people on board of the prahus, who were able to
+escape, made for the shore. One of our marines was wounded in the neck
+with an arrow, and, with the exception of the captain, no other casualty
+took place.</p>
+
+<p>The fight would have been continued with the round shot still left in
+the barge, but the assistant surgeon was anxious that the captain should
+return to the ship and have the ball extracted. The barge therefore
+pulled for the ship, whose royals were just visible above the horizon.
+The pirates, finding that we were retreating, returned to their prahus
+and fired their guns at us, but without effect.</p>
+
+<p>We arrived on board about 9 <small>A. M.</small>, and the ship's head was put<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_51" id="Page_51">[51]</a></span> towards
+the scene of action, while the barge and two cutters were despatched in
+search of the gig, of whose safety we had great doubts. About 11.30, A.M
+., the second cutter, being in advance, discovered a sail in shore, and
+which, by the aid of our telescopes, we made out to be the gig. When we
+closed with her, and found that all was right we were greatly relieved.
+We heard from Mr. Hooper, the purser, who was in her, that after waiting
+in vain for the barge's return, he set fire to the prahus. In one of
+them he found a woman and child alive, whom he landed at the nearest
+point. He then pulled in the direction we had gone, being guided by the
+sound of our guns. On his arrival in the bay we were not in sight, and
+perceiving several prahus with flags flying and gongs beating, he
+naturally concluded that we had been overpowered, and he was making the
+best of his way towards the ship. The boats continued pulling towards
+the shore, leaving the gig to return to the ship and ease the minds of
+the ship's company respecting her safety.</p>
+
+<p>On our arrival in the bay with the barge and cutters, we found that the
+prahus had hauled into a creek, on the banks of which was a masked
+battery, which opened a spirited fire upon us as soon as we came within
+range. After an hour's cannonading on both sides we were joined by the
+gig, with orders for us not to land, but to return to the ship at
+sunset. This order was not received with pleasure, as we hoped to have a
+chance of punishing the fellows a little more. We pulled a short
+distance along the coast, and entered another bay, in which we destroyed
+two prahus; after which we returned to the ship. Calms, and a strong
+current setting to the northward, detained the ship near the scene of
+action for several days. We at length passed through the straits of
+Patientia, but did not get the breeze until we sighted the Isle of
+Bouro. Passing through the Bonta passage,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_52" id="Page_52">[52]</a></span> straits of Salayer, and Java
+sea, we arrived at Sincapore on the 28th of June.</p>
+
+<p>Here we found the Harlequin, which had had a brush with the pirates on
+the coast of Sumatra. The Harlequin, Wanderer, and Diana were sent to
+the villages of Micedo and Batta, to demand the murderers of an English
+captain. On the rajah refusing to deliver them up, the vessels opened
+their fire and burnt the villages. The Harlequin lost two men killed and
+five wounded; among the latter was Lieutenant Chads, whose arm was
+nearly severed by a Malay kris. While here the Superb arrived from Hong
+Kong on her way to England; the Driver, with Sir Henry Pottinger on
+board; and the Cambrian, Commodore Chads. Also the Iris from England,
+and the Dido from Hong Kong, which latter vessel sailed for Sarawak.</p>
+
+<p>I may as well here remark, that the Dutch made a formal complaint
+against our captain for having attacked their prahus, which they
+asserted were not pirates, but employed by them against the pirates. It
+is but fair to give the arguments that were used against us,
+particularly as the authorities at Sincapore appeared to think that we
+were to blame. They said, you were in boats, and you touched at Gillolo;
+the natives, accustomed to be taken off by the Illanoan pirates, were
+naturally jealous and suspicious, seeing no vessel. They came alone,
+armed, to ascertain who you were. At 100 yards they stopped; you
+signalled them to go away, and they advanced nearer to you, but they
+committed no act of hostility. You fired a volley at them, and they
+retreated. Here the aggression was on your side.</p>
+
+<p>At the same time, you say, a war prahu pulled round the point, and
+approached to within range; when the prahu was close to you she ceased
+paddling, and hoisted Dutch colours. You desired it to pull for the
+Gillolo shore, which it did. There was no aggression in this instance,
+and nothing piratical in the conduct of the prahu.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_53" id="Page_53">[53]</a></span> After she had obeyed
+your order to pull to the Gillolo shore, you wantonly fired a Congreve
+rocket at her; your conduct in this instance being much more like that
+of a pirate than hers. In the afternoon you pull along the Gillolo
+shore, and you discover a village; you send your boat ashore and set
+fire to it. Why so? You state that you were attacked by Illanoan
+pirates, who reside at Tampassook, some hundred miles from Gillolo, and
+you then burn the village of the people of Gillolo, and that without the
+least aggression on their part. Is it surprising that you should be
+supposed to be pirates after such wanton outrage? To proceed: you state
+that you then go in search of the prahu which you ordered away, and that
+on your way you captured a large canoe, which you take in tow, and
+afterwards perceive the pirates hauling their vessel into a creek. You
+attack them, and they run away, leaving the prahu in your possession,
+and, as usual, after rifling the prahu and canoe, you set them on fire.
+Up to this point there has been nothing but aggression on your part; and
+it is not, therefore, surprising that you were supposed to be pirates,
+and that the communication was made along the coast, and the vessels
+employed against the pirates were summoned for its protection. Again,
+the prahus came out and surrounded you; they did not fire at you, but
+hailed you in English, requesting to know if you belonged to a ship.
+Now, if any thing could prove that they were not pirate vessels, it was
+their doing this; and had you replied, they would have explained to you
+what their employment was: but you think proper to give no answer to
+this simple question, order them to go away, and then fire a loaded
+musket into them, which brings on the conflict which you so much
+desired. That these observations were true, it must be admitted, and the
+complaint of the Dutch, with the hoisting of the Dutch flag, gave great
+weight to them: however, pirates or no pirates, the Admiralty Court, on
+our arrival in England, considered<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_54" id="Page_54">[54]</a></span> them to have been such; and, as will
+be seen by the extract from the "Times" below, awarded head money to the
+amount of about 10,000l. to the captain and crew of the Samarang, and
+for his wound received, our captain obtained a pension of (I believe)
+&pound;250 a year.<a name="FNanchor_1_1" id="FNanchor_1_1"></a><a href="#Footnote_1_1" class="fnanchor">[1]</a></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot">
+<p class="center"><big>"ADMIRALTY COURT.</big></p>
+
+<p class="center">(<i>Before Dr. Lushington.</i>)</p>
+
+<p class="center">"ILLANOAN PIRATES.&mdash;BOUNTY.</p>
+
+<p>"In this case a petition was presented by Sir Edward Belcher,
+the captain, and the rest of the officers and crew of Her
+Majesty's ship-of-war Samarang, setting forth that on the 3d of
+June, 1844, the Samarang being then engaged in surveying
+duties, and near the island of Gillolo, on her passage towards
+the Straits of Patientia, Sir E. Belcher, with two officers and
+four men, quitted her in the gig, accompanied by the second
+barge, armed with a brass six-pounder gun and small arms, and
+manned with twenty officers and men. While engaged on the
+extreme side of a reef, extending from a small islet, in taking
+astronomical observations, they were disturbed by an
+extraordinary yell proceeding from about forty men of colour,
+who were advancing from the islet along both sides of the reef,
+with the evident intention of surrounding Sir E. Belcher and
+his party, on nearing whom they commenced hurling spears and
+arrows, though without effect. They were soon repulsed and put
+to flight by musketry. In the course of the day several large
+prahus made their appearance, manned by large crews of Malay
+pirates, and severe conflicts took place between the respective
+parties, in one of which a ball from the leading prahu struck
+Sir E. Belcher on the thigh, and knocked him overboard,
+severely and dangerously wounding him; but, having been lifted
+out of the water, and dragged into the barge, <i>he shortly after
+resumed the command</i>, and ultimately succeeded in destroying
+all the prahus.</p>
+
+<p>"Dr. Addams applied to the Court to award the bounties
+specified in the 6th of George IV. c. 49. for the capture and
+destruction of piratical ships and vessels. He submitted that
+the affidavits produced clearly showed the character of the
+persons on board the prahus, and that not less than 1,330
+persons were alive on board the several prahus at the beginning
+of the attack, 350 of whom were killed.</p>
+
+<p>"The Queen's Advocate, on behalf of the Crown, admitted that a
+very meritorious service had been performed, and made no
+opposition to the application.</p>
+
+<p>"The Court pronounced for the usual bounties on the number of
+pirates stated."</p>
+
+</div>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_55" id="Page_55">[55]</a></span>Our captain having now nearly recovered from the wound which he had
+received, we found that our destination was Borneo; but previous to the
+ship getting under weigh, the boats were ordered to be manned and armed,
+to proceed on an excursion to Romania Point, distant about thirty miles
+from Sincapore. It was expected that we might there fall in with some of
+the piratical vessels which so completely infest the Indian Archipelago;
+and if so, we trusted to give them a lesson which might for a time put a
+check to their nefarious and cruel system of plunder and rapine. I found
+that my name was down in the list of the party selected for the
+expedition. Bidding, therefore, a temporary adieu to Sincapore, on the
+2d of August we set off on the expedition, with a force consisting of
+two barges, one cutter, and a gun-boat belonging to the merchants of
+Sincapore, which had been expressly built to resist any attacks of these
+bold assailants.</p>
+
+<p>Although the real object of the expedition was, as I have above stated,
+to fall in with the pirates, our ostensible one was to survey the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_56" id="Page_56">[56]</a></span>
+islands off the Point Romania, which is the most unfrequented part of
+the Malay peninsula. We arrived there late at night, as ignorant whether
+the pirates were there, as the pirates would have been of our arrival.
+We had, therefore, nothing to do but to anchor close under the land, and
+keep a sharp look-out, in case of being the attacked instead of the
+attacking party. As we were not indifferently provided with the creature
+comforts which Sincapore afforded, we amused ourselves pretty well; but
+if we occasionally opened our mouths, we took good care not to shut our
+eyes, and were constantly on the alert. There is a far from pleasant
+feeling attached to lying in an open boat, in a night as dark as pitch,
+expecting a momentary attack from an insidious enemy, and wholly in a
+state of uncertainty as to from what quarter it may be made, or as to
+what odds you may be exposed. Under these circumstances, we remained in
+watching and silence during a night which appeared interminably long;
+and daylight was gladly welcomed by the whole party; and when it arrived
+we found ourselves anchored among a crowd of small islands, which were
+covered from the beach to their summits with the most luxuriant foliage.
+Within shore of us was a beautiful little sandy bay; while the whole
+coast, as far as the eye could reach, was one extended jungle, by all
+accounts extending many hundred miles inland, and infested with tigers
+and other beasts of prey. As for pirates, we saw nothing of them, or any
+signs of their having been in that quarter; either they were away on
+some distant marauding party, or, having received intelligence of our
+approach and force, had considered us too strong to be opposed, and had
+kept out of the way. Our warlike expedition, therefore, was soon changed
+into a sort of pic-nic party&mdash;we amused ourselves with bathing, turning
+of turtle, shooting, and eating the wild pine-apples which grew on all
+the islands. We remained there for three days, during which nothing
+occurred worth<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_57" id="Page_57">[57]</a></span> narrating, unless it is an instance of the thoughtless
+and reckless conduct of midshipmen. We were pulling leisurely along the
+coast in one of the boats, when we perceived a very large Bengal tiger
+taking an evening stroll, and who, by the motion of his tail, was
+evidently in a state of much self-satisfaction. We winded the boat's
+head towards him, and were preparing to give him a round of grape from
+the gun, but before we could get the gun well pointed, he retreated
+majestically into the jungle, which was in the bight of a small bay, and
+cut off from the main jungle by some large rocks. Three of our party
+immediately declared that they would have a tiger-hunt, and bring back
+his skin as a trophy. They landed, two of them having each a ship's
+musket, a very uncertain weapon, as they are at present provided, for,
+whether from damp or careless manufacture, the percussion caps will not
+often go off; and the third armed with nothing but a knife. On their
+landing, they took their position on the rocks, and were delighted to
+find that the tiger could not retreat to the main jungle without passing
+them. They had not long taken up their position before they heard the
+crackling of the wood in the jungle, announcing the tiger's approach
+towards them. They fixed their bayonets and cocked their locks; the
+young gentleman with the knife was also prepared; but the noise in the
+jungle ceased. Whether it was that the tiger was afraid to attack three
+at the same time, or was making a circuit for a more convenient spring
+upon them, certain it is that our three young gentlemen either became
+tired of waiting for him, or had thought better of their mad attempt.
+One proposed returning to the boat, the others assented; and after
+denouncing the tiger as a coward, and wholly unworthy of the name of a
+royal tiger, they commenced their retreat as the dark set in; gradually
+their pace quickened, in two minutes they were in a hard trot; at last
+the panic took them all, and by the time they arrived at the boats they
+could not speak from want of breath, so hurried had<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_58" id="Page_58">[58]</a></span> been their retreat.
+We sincerely congratulated them upon their arrival safe and sound, and
+having escaped without loss of life and limb from a very mad adventure.
+I subsequently related this incident to an old Indian sportsman, who
+told me that my messmates had had a most fortunate escape, as they would
+have had little or no chance had the tiger made his spring, which he
+certainly would have done had they remained much longer, and that one of
+them at least must have been sacrificed. On the morning of the fourth
+day, the ship, having made sail from Sincapore, hove in sight, and
+picked us up. The boats were hoisted in, and we steered for Borneo, to
+complete some surveys on the north-east coast.</p>
+
+<p>The island of Borneo, throughout the whole of the N. E. coast, is, with
+few exceptions, a low land, covered with jungle; but so beautifully
+verdant does it appear when viewed from some distance, that you would be
+led to suppose that it was widely cultivated. This idea is, however,
+soon dispelled on a near approach, when you discover the rich groups of
+acacias, palms, pandani, and numerous trees as yet unknown, so luxuriant
+in themselves, but forming one entangled mass, alike impenetrable to
+European or native. What, in the distant view, we fancied a verdant
+meadow, where we might relax from our long confinement, and amuse
+ourselves with recreation, now proved to be ranges of long damp grass,
+interspersed with swamps, and infested with venomous snakes. In short, I
+never yet was on a coast which, on arriving on it, promised so much,
+and, on landing, caused such a series of disappointments to those who
+love to ramble about, than the coast of Borneo. To the naturalist,
+however, confined as he is to the shelving beach, there is ample food
+for employment and research: the island abounds in novel objects of
+natural history, both in the animal and vegetable kingdom.</p>
+
+<p>Nothing certain is as yet ascertained relative to the interior of this<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_59" id="Page_59">[59]</a></span>
+immense island, if island it can with propriety be called. From the
+accounts of the natives (which, however, must be received with due
+caution), it consists of a large plain, devoid of jungle, and inhabited
+by cannibals. Two adventurous Dutchmen have latterly set off from
+Pontiana, the Dutch settlement, on an excursion into the interior; but
+it is doubtful if they succeed, where so many others have already
+failed.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="keeney" id="keeney"></a>
+<img src="images/059.jpg" width="600" height="390" alt="Keeney-ballo" />
+<div class="cap-horiz">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">KEENEY-BALLO.<br />
+<small>(OOSOKAN BAY, BORNEO.)</small></p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>Borneo has but small elevation for so large an island; in the immediate
+vicinity of Keeney Ballu the country is hilly, but by far the greatest
+portion of Borneo is but a few feet above the level of the sea. Keeney
+Ballu is the highest mountain in the island,&mdash;its height is estimated at
+14,000 feet or more,&mdash;and it can be seen at 150 miles distant on a very
+clear day. It is very singular that there should be a mountain of so
+great a height rising from an island of otherwise low land. Near Sarawak
+there is mountainous country, where live the Dyaks, previously
+described, and a mountain of the name of Santabong, which has already
+been made mention of. On the S. E. coast of the island we saw no
+elevation of land of any consequence. I have given a drawing of the
+mountain of Keeney Ballu, distant forty miles. At this distance, with
+the aid of the glass, you may perceive the numerous cascades which fall
+from its summit in every direction. The Dyaks of Borneo imagine that a
+lake exists at the top of this mountain, and that it is to be their
+receptacle after death.</p>
+
+<p>As the island is in most parts a flat and marshy jungle, extending about
+200 miles inland, and the rivers are not rapid, although numerous, it
+would be presumed, especially as the dews of the night are very heavy,
+that the island would be fatal to Europeans. Such, however, proved not
+to be the case. During our repeated visits to the island (a period of
+nearly two years), we only lost one man, by a<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_60" id="Page_60">[60]</a></span> most imprudent exposure
+to the night air, sleeping in an open boat, without the awning being
+spread, and exposed to a very heavy dew.</p>
+
+<p>Borneo abounds with rivers, some of them very fine, running inland for
+one or two hundred miles. Most of these rivers have been taken
+possession of and colonised by the various tribes indigenous to the
+neighbouring isles and continent, to wit, Arabs, Malays, Illanoans,
+Bughis, the natives of Celebes, Chinese, &amp;c. The reason for this
+emigration to Borneo is the protection afforded by these rivers; for as
+all these tribes live entirely by piracy, they here find a safe retreat
+for themselves and their vessels. How long ago their settlements may
+have been first made, or what opposition they may have received from the
+Dyak aborigines, it is impossible to say; but as most of the head men in
+Borneo claim to be of Arab descent, it may be presumed that many years
+must have elapsed since the aboriginal tribes of Dyaks and Dusums were
+dispossessed of the rivers, and driven into the interior. Of these
+people I shall speak hereafter; there is no doubt but that they were the
+original inhabitants of the whole island, and that the various tribes I
+have mentioned are but colonists for piratical purposes.</p>
+
+<p>These piratical hordes generally infest the high lands upon the shores
+of these rivers, which are difficult of navigation; and, moreover, from
+their numerous branches, their resorts are not very easily discovered.
+These towns are fortified with stockades, guns of various calibre, and
+the passage up the river defended by booms or piles of timber, which
+admit of but one narrow passage for their prahus.</p>
+
+<p>It must be understood that these piratical hordes are not only
+independent of each other, but often at war, in consequence of their
+spoliations. Some of their chiefs have taken upon them the titles of
+princes; and one has assumed, as is well known, that of Sultan of
+Borneo, another of Sooloo,&mdash;how far entitled to such a rank it would be
+difficult to say; but this is certain, that there must be a beginning<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_61" id="Page_61">[61]</a></span>
+to every dynasty; and if we trace back far into history, we shall find,
+both at home and abroad, that most dynasties have had their origin in
+freebooting on a grand scale,&mdash;even the House of Hapsburg itself is
+derived from no better an origin; and the Sultan of Borneo, whoever he
+may be, and if a Sultan does exist, some 800 years hence will, by the
+antiquity of his title, prove his high descent, as the German emperor
+now does his own.</p>
+
+<p>On the 20th of August we came to an anchor at the mouth of the Sarawak
+river, where we remained three weeks completing some very important
+surveys. When our work was done, the captain, accompanied by several
+officers, went up the river.</p>
+
+<p>On our arrival at Kuchin, we found the Dido corvette, commanded by
+Captain Keppell, lying abreast of the town. We also found that Kuchin
+was at present nearly deserted, as the Dido's boats, with the Phlegethon
+steamer, and all the native war prahus which could be mustered, had
+proceeded with Mr. Brooke to the Sakarron, a neighbouring river, to
+punish some of the mixed tribes who had lately been detected in an act
+of flagrant piracy. On the change of the tide we started for the
+Sakarron, with the hope of gaining the Dido's boats, and rendering them
+some assistance. Our men exerted themselves to the utmost; but it
+requires time to pull eighty miles; and I will therefore, <i>en voyage</i>,
+explain more fully the cause and the object of the expedition.</p>
+
+<p>The river Sakarron, with its tributaries, the Linga and Serebis, have
+been for a long while in the possession of a proverbial piratical tribe
+of Malays, governed by chiefs, who are of Arab descent, and much better
+acquainted with the art of war than those lawless communions are in
+general. Their towers and fastnesses on the banks of their rivers they
+have contrived to fortify in a very superior manner. Living wholly by
+the proceeds of their piratical excursions, and,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_62" id="Page_62">[62]</a></span> aware of the efforts
+made by the European rajah, Mr. Brooke, to put it down, they resolved to
+take the first opportunity which might offer to show their hostility and
+contempt to their new-raised enemy. The occasion soon presented itself.
+Seven of the Kuchin Malays, having ventured in a canoe up the Sakarron
+river, were all murdered, and their heads cut off, and kept, as usual,
+as trophies; and the intelligence of this outrage communicated by them
+to Mr. Brooke, with defiance.</p>
+
+<p>Captain Keppell, of the Dido, had just arrived at Sarawak when this news
+was brought to Mr. Brooke. Captain Keppell had been sent by Admiral Sir
+Thomas Cochrane to the island on purpose to look out for pirates, and to
+destroy them and their nests wherever he could find them. He therefore
+gladly offered his assistance to Mr. Brooke to punish these murderous
+wretches; and the Phlegethon steamer coming in while they were preparing
+for the expedition, was, of course, added to the force employed. This
+fortunate accession of strength, assisted by all the Malay war boats
+which Mr. Brooke could muster, enabled them to give an effectual check
+to a band of pirates, so numerous and so warlike as to have become most
+formidable. To proceed:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>That night we anchored with the last of the flood at the entrance of the
+Sakarron. We had great fear, from the intelligence we had received from
+time to time, from boats we fell in with on our passage, that we should
+arrive too late to be partakers of the affray; and so it proved, for the
+next morning, while proceeding higher up the river, we perceived a large
+force of native boats coming down with the ebb, and all of them filled
+to the gunwale with plunder.</p>
+
+<p>The Malay and Dyak canoes are made out of a hollowed tree, or, as they
+are termed in many ports of India, "dug-outs." They are long and narrow,
+and are capable of being propelled with great swiftness.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_63" id="Page_63">[63]</a></span> Although very
+easy to capsize, they are constantly loaded till so deep that at the
+least inclination the water pours over the gunwale, and one man is
+usually employed baling with a scoop made out of a banana leaf. Custom,
+however, makes them so used to keep the equilibrium, that you often see
+the Dyaks, whose canoes are similar to the Malays', standing upright and
+propelling them with their spears.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="nativeboat" id="nativeboat"></a>
+<img src="images/063.jpg" width="600" height="342" alt="Native Boat&mdash;Borneo" />
+<p class="caption">NATIVE BOAT&mdash;BORNEO.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>The Malay war-boat, or <i>prahu</i>, is built of timber at the lower part,
+the upper is of bamboo, rattan, and kedgang (the dried leaf of the Nepa
+palm). Outside the bends, about a foot from the water line, runs a
+strong gallery, in which the rowers sit cross-legged. At the after-part
+of the boat is a cabin for the chief who commands, and the whole of the
+vessel is surmounted by a strong flat roof, upon which they fight, their
+principal weapons being the kris and spear, both of which, to be used
+with effect, require elbow-room.</p>
+
+<p>The Dyak war-boat is a long built canoe, more substantially constructed
+than the prahu of the Malays, and sufficiently capacious to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_64" id="Page_64">[64]</a></span> hold from
+seventy to eighty men. This also has a roof to fight from. They are
+generally painted, and the stern ornamented with feathers.</p>
+
+<p>Both descriptions of war-boats are remarkably swift, notwithstanding
+such apparent top-weight. To proceed:&mdash;</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="dyakprahu" id="dyakprahu"></a>
+<img src="images/064.jpg" width="600" height="288" alt="Dyak War Prahu" />
+<p class="caption">DYAK WAR PRAHU.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>We hove to, to speak to those on board of the canoes, and were informed
+by them that the pirates had sustained a severe defeat, and that the
+European force was about to descend the river on their return to Kuchin.
+As a proof of the victory having been gained, they produced several
+heads which had been taken in the fight.</p>
+
+<p>We proceeded about six miles further up the river, when we discovered
+the European boats and crews lying at anchor abreast of the smoking
+ruins of what had been a Malay town. Here we learnt that the pirates had
+been completely routed, after a desperate resistance, that four large
+towns had been burnt, and seventy-five brass guns of the country, called
+leilas, had been captured. The victory, however, had not been gained
+without loss on our side, and had the pirates been better prepared, we
+must have suffered much more. Several of the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_65" id="Page_65">[65]</a></span> people of Kuchin had been
+killed, and of Europeans we had to lament the loss of Mr. Wade, first
+lieutenant of the Dido, and formerly of the Samarang, and Mr. Stewart,
+one of the residents at Kuchin; the latter gentleman lost his life by an
+excess of zeal which quite overcame all prudence. Mr. Wade had landed
+with his men after an attack and capture of a fort, and when in advance
+received a bullet in the heart. He fell instantly dead; his body was
+recovered by his shipmates, and borne to the boat, and during a
+temporary cessation of hostilities was conveyed to the river. His loss
+was much deplored by his shipmates in both vessels, by whom he was
+respected as an officer, and beloved as a friend.</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Stewart, pulling in advance in a small canoe, with some of the
+natives belonging to Kuchin, was suddenly pounced upon by three or four
+of the enemy's prahus full of men. They ran down the canoe, and thus
+were Mr. Stewart and his companions at their mercy. Mercy!&mdash;a wrong term
+to use when speaking of those who never show any. They were all krissed,
+to the number of seventeen, in sight of their companions in the other
+boats, who were too far behind to arrive in time to render them any
+assistance, although it hardly need be said that every effort was made.
+The last that was seen of poor Stewart was his body being carried by one
+of the Dyaks into the jungle by the side of the river, and the fellow
+was so anxious to obtain the much-valued trophy of a white man's head,
+that, as he bore it along, he kept his knife sawing at the head to sever
+it from the body. Indeed, so much do these people value a white man's
+head, that they will build a separate room on purpose to contain it.</p>
+
+<p>Whilst lying at this place, riding to a strong flood tide, a canoe
+floated past us, in which we could discern two dead bodies; they were
+both dressed as Malays, and the garments were good. Over the bows of the
+canoe there hung a handsomely ornamented kris. We tried to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_66" id="Page_66">[66]</a></span> hook the
+canoe with the boat-hook, but the strength of the tide was so great that
+we could not succeed in securing it, and it floated away with the
+stream. We presumed that they were the bodies of some of the Malays
+killed in the recent conflict, who probably inhabited a higher portion
+of the river, and that they had been put into the canoe by their friends
+to be carried home, and had been swept away by the tide from not having
+been securely fastened, for nothing would have induced the enemy thus to
+make us a present of <i>two heads</i>.</p>
+
+<p>"We weighed, in company with the steamer and boats, on the same evening,
+and returned to Kuchin, where we arrived on the following day. The
+men-of-war boats having been towed by the steamer, we arrived some time
+before the native prahus belonging to the river, which had accompanied
+us. On the following day they arrived, and the scene was novel and
+interesting. They all rounded the point together, dressed out with flags
+of all descriptions, beating their gongs and tom-toms, and firing blank
+cartridges from their "Leilas." Highly elated with their victory, and
+with the plunder which had accompanied it, they celebrated it by all
+getting excessively drunk that night upon shamsoo.</p>
+
+<p>We remained at Kuchin for three days, enjoying Mr. Brooke's hospitality;
+and during that time it was proposed and arranged that we should pay a
+visit to the river Loondoo, the residence of a very remarkable tribe of
+Dyaks under Mr. Brooke's authority; but not being able to fix the exact
+period for the visit, on that night we returned to the ship.</p>
+
+<p>We had not been much more than twenty-four hours on board, when the
+captain, who had been away, returned at midnight; and, at this unusual
+hour, ordered all the boats, manned and armed, to be piped away
+immediately. We were informed that the river Sakarron was again our
+destination; and at four o'clock in the morning we<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_67" id="Page_67">[67]</a></span> started, with
+fourteen days' provisions, and armed to the teeth, to join the Dido's
+boats at the mouth of the river Morotabis, from thence to be towed with
+them by the steamer to our destination. The cause of this new expedition
+was the intelligence that the Arab chief, Serib Saib, who had escaped
+during the late conflict, had returned to the Sakarron to collect
+together and re-organize his piratical subjects. We soon arrived at the
+same spot which we had before visited when the town had been burnt down;
+but the expedition proved to be one of little interest. Notwithstanding
+his threats, Serib Saib's confidence gave way at the approach of our
+force, and he made a precipitate retreat up the river, accompanied by
+four or five hundred of his warriors. Nevertheless, we continued to
+force our way up the river, with the expectation that, when fairly at
+bay, he would make a stand. Our advance was made known to the enemy by
+fires lighted on the different hills abreast of the boats. This speedy
+mode of communication is adopted by all the natives in this part of the
+world. Determined not to abandon the pursuit while a chance remained, we
+followed the redoubtable Serib Saib for eighty miles up the river, which
+in some parts was too narrow for our boats' crews to make use of their
+oars; but all obstacles were overcome in the ardour of the chase.</p>
+
+<p>To impede our progress, large trees had been felled so as to fall across
+the river where it was narrow; but these were removed, and we forced our
+way on. At last the river, as we approached the source, became little
+wider than a ditch, the barges grounded, and could proceed no farther;
+the gigs only could float, and we continued, till, after forty-eight
+hours of severe labour, we found ourselves at the head of the river; and
+we also discovered that Serib Saib had escaped, having with his whole
+force landed, and made his way through the jungle into the interior,
+leaving at our disposal the forty war canoes<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_68" id="Page_68">[68]</a></span> which had carried him and
+his men. To follow him was impossible; so we were obliged to content
+ourselves with the capture of the war canoes, which were all that we had
+to show for our exertions. Disappointed, and hungry withal, we were not
+sorry to find ourselves once more with our heads down the river.</p>
+
+<p>I must not omit, however, to narrate a little trick played upon our
+gallant captain. I have stated that the river was so narrow near its
+source that we could not use the oars, and the gigs, which continued the
+pursuit, had to be hauled through the bushes by the boat-hooks.
+Returning to where the larger boats had been left aground, our bow-man,
+who was employed shooting the gig along by such aid as the branches of
+the trees, or the tendrils which hung to them, afforded him, stuck his
+boat-hook into what appeared to be a suspended ball of moss; but he soon
+discovered that it was something more, as it was a nest of hornets,
+which sallied out in great numbers, and resented the insult to their
+domicile by attacking the bowman first, as the principal aggressor, and
+us afterwards, as parties concerned. Now the sting of a hornet is no
+joke; we covered our faces with our handkerchiefs, or any thing we could
+find, and made a hasty retreat from the spot, pushing the gig down the
+stream, till we were clear of their attacks. In the hurry of our escape
+we left the boat-hook hanging in the hornet's nest, and not feeling at
+all inclined to go back for it, we hailed the captain's gig, which was
+following us, and requested very humbly that they would be pleased to
+recover our boat-hook for us, as we could not well re-ascend the stream
+from the want of it. As we did not mention that it was so peculiarly
+situated, the captain saw no objection, and as they came to where it
+hung, his bow-man caught hold of the staff, and wrested it from its
+position; but this time such force was used that the tendril gave way,
+and the nest itself fell down into the boat, and the irritated insects
+poured out their<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_69" id="Page_69">[69]</a></span> whole force to revenge this second aggression. The
+insects after all appeared to have a knowledge of the service, for they
+served out their stings in the same proportion as the prize-money is
+divided: the captain came in for his full share.</p>
+
+<p>Returning rather in a bad humour at having had so long a pull for
+nothing, we anchored off a fortified Malay town, which went by the name
+of Bintang, and which had been brought to terms by Captain Keppell on a
+previous expedition up the river. The people had consequently remained
+neutral, although it was well known that they were not to be trusted,
+and that, had we been defeated above and beaten back, they would, in all
+probability, have attacked us in the rear. As the evening closed in, by
+way of astonishing the natives, and giving them some idea of our perfect
+equipment, the boats were directed to give a <i>feu-de-joie</i>. Some fifteen
+guns, with rockets, port-fires, blue lights, supported by a
+well-sustained roulade of musketry, had a very warlike effect; and, no
+doubt, gave the natives an impression of our superiority in the use of
+fire-arms. At the conclusion, Captain Keppell, who was always ready for
+fun, gave out the order that all hands were to join in "God save the
+Queen," taking the time from him. A dead silence was immediately
+produced, waiting for him to lead off, which he did; but, to our great
+amusement, he, by mistake, commenced with "Rule Britannia;" and this,
+being more to the seamen's taste, certainly, as far as lungs were
+concerned, was done most ample justice to.</p>
+
+<p>The saying is, "No song no supper;" of course it must be presumed that a
+song deserves a supper. It proved so in this instance; for just as the
+chorus was hushed, the Sultan of Bintang, as he styles himself, sent off
+to the head boat (the one I happened to be in) a superb supper for seven
+people, consisting of seven bronze trays, each tray containing about a
+dozen small plates, in which were many varieties of flesh and fowl
+cooked in a very superior manner. To each tray was<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_70" id="Page_70">[70]</a></span> a spoon, made of the
+yellow leaf of some tree unknown; but, as specimens of primitive
+elegance and utility combined, they were matchless. We had some doubts,
+from our knowledge of the treachery of the Malays, whether we should
+fall to upon these appetising viands, as there was no saying but that
+they might be poisoned. Mr. Brooke, however, who, although not the
+commandant, was the mentor of the party, explained that he invariably
+observed one rule when treating and dealing with these people,&mdash;which
+was, never to exhibit any unworthy suspicion of them, as, by so doing,
+they became convinced of our own integrity and honour. That this
+confidence might have, in many instances, proved dangerous, unless
+adopted with great caution, must be admitted; but in our relations with
+the people on the rivers of Borneo it was of great service. The Malays
+are so very suspicious themselves, that nothing but confidence on your
+part will remove the feeling; and, in treating with Malays, this is the
+first object to be obtained. The remarks of Mr. Brooke, which were not a
+little assisted by the tempting nature of the viands, and no small
+degree of hunger, had the effect, and the trays were all cleared out in
+consequence.</p>
+
+<p>While I was in this river I was capsized by a <i>bore</i>. This, I must
+explain to my non-nautical readers, is a huge rolling wave, which is as
+upright as a wall, and travels almost as fast as a locomotive. It is
+occasioned by the flood tide pouring in and overcoming the feeders to
+the river, forcing them back to their source. On this occasion I was
+pulling down the river in a small gig, following the other boats, which
+had turned up another branch of it, when I perceived it rapidly
+advancing, and making a noise not unlike the animal of the same name,
+only a great deal louder. Had I been steering a straight course down the
+river I should have faced it, and probably have got off with the boat
+half full of water; but I calculated upon reaching the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_71" id="Page_71">[71]</a></span> point and
+entering the branch of the river before its arrival. But I had not
+calculated upon its speed, and a strong eddy current at the point was
+wicked enough to draw our boat broadside to the middle of the stream.</p>
+
+<p>The wall of water rushed on us, turned us over and over; but fortunately
+by its force it also threw us all, with the gig, upon the point. It did
+not, however, throw us our oars, which were performing a <i>pas de quatre</i>
+in a whirlpool close to us. This was a narrow escape, as, had we
+remained in the agitated waters, the alligators would soon have dragged
+us under. For two minutes the river was in a state of ebullition, but
+gradually subsided. We then launched the boat, regained our oars, and
+proceeded to join our comrades. Thankful as we were for our lives having
+been preserved, still as we were wet through and had lost all our
+provisions and necessaries, we were compelled to admit that it was a
+very great bore.</p>
+
+<p>Shortly after our leaving this river a fatal accident happened to one of
+our best men. The wind was blowing a heavy gale from the westward,
+accompanied by thunder and lightning, such as is only to be seen and
+heard on the coast of Borneo. The carpenters were on shore felling trees
+for masts and yards, and as we were anchored some distance from the
+shore a tent was pitched for their accommodation. They had not been in
+the tent long when a large iron-wood tree was struck by lightning, and
+fell, burying one of the carpenters, Miller by name, in the sand
+underneath it. He was extricated with great difficulty; but before any
+surgical assistance could be rendered him he was a corpse. On
+examination most of his bones were found to be crushed.</p>
+
+<p>Soon after our return from the Sakarron the expedition to Loondoo was
+arranged, and we started in the barge and gig, accompanied by Captain
+Keppell in his own boat, and Mr. Brooke and Hentig in one of the native
+boats, called a Tam-bang. The distance<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_72" id="Page_72">[72]</a></span> was about forty miles, and we
+should have arrived at four o'clock in the afternoon, but, owing to the
+narrowness of the channel, and a want of knowledge of the river, we
+grounded on the flats, where we lay high and dry for the space of four
+hours. Floating with the following tide, we discovered the proper
+channel, and found our way up the river, although the night was dark as
+pitch: when near the town, we anchored for daylight.</p>
+
+<p>I may as well here give a slight description of the scenery on the
+Borneo rivers, all of which, that we have visited, with the exception of
+the Bruni, bear a close resemblance to each other. They are far from
+picturesque or beautiful, for the banks are generally low, and the
+jungle invariably extends to the water's edge. For the first fifteen or
+twenty miles the banks are lined with the nepa-palms, which then
+gradually disappear, leaving the mangrove alone to clothe the sides of
+the stream. When you enter these rivers, it is rare to see any thing
+like a human habitation for many miles; reach after reach, the same
+double line of rich foliage is presented, varying only in the
+description of trees and bushes as the water becomes more fresh; now and
+then a small canoe may be seen rounding a point, or you may pass the
+stakes which denote that formerly there had been a fishing station. At
+last a hut appears on the bank, probably flanked with one or two Banana
+trees. You turn into the next reach and suddenly find yourself close to
+one or more populous and fortified towns. As you ascend higher the
+scenery becomes much more interesting and varied from the mangroves
+disappearing. Few of the rivers of Borneo are more than eighty miles in
+extent. The two rivers of Bruni and Coran are supposed to meet in the
+centre of the island, although for many miles near their source they are
+not much wider than a common ditch.</p>
+
+<p>Before day-light of the following morning our slumbers were disturbed<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_73" id="Page_73">[73]</a></span>
+by the crowing of a whole army of cocks, which assured us of the
+proximity of the town we were in search of. We got under weigh, and,
+rounding the point, Loondoo hove in sight, a fine town, built in a grove
+of cocoa-nut trees, and by no means despicably fortified. We found our
+progress arrested by a boom composed of huge trees fastened together by
+coir cables, and extending the whole width of the river. Had our
+intentions been hostile, it would have taken some time to have cut the
+fastenings of this boom, and we should, during the operation, have been
+exposed to a double line of fire from two forts raised on each side of
+the river. The Chief of Loondoo had, however, been duly advised of our
+intended visit, and as soon as our boats were seen from the town, a
+head-man was sent out in a canoe to usher us in. After a little delay we
+got the barge within the boom. When within, we found that we had further
+reason to congratulate ourselves that we came as friends, as the raking
+fire from the forts would have been most effectual, for we discovered
+that we had to pass an inner boom equally well secured as the first. The
+town was surrounded by a strong stockade made of the trunks of the
+knee-bone palm, a wood superior in durability to any known. This
+stockade had but one opening of any dimensions. A few strokes of the
+oars brought us abreast of it, and we let go our anchors. The eldest son
+of the Chief came to us immediately in a canoe. He was a splendidly
+formed young man, about twenty-five years old. He wore his hair long and
+flowing, his countenance was open and ingenuous, his eyes black and
+knowing. His dress was a light blue velvet jacket without sleeves, and a
+many-coloured sash wound round his waist. His arms and legs, which were
+symmetrical to admiration, were naked, but encircled with a profusion of
+heavy brass rings. He brought a present of fowls, cocoa-nuts, and
+bananas to Mr. Brooke<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_74" id="Page_74">[74]</a></span> from his father, and an invitation for us to pay
+him a visit at his house whenever we should feel inclined.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="dyakwomen" id="dyakwomen"></a>
+<img src="images/074.jpg" width="600" height="406" alt="Dyak Women in Canoe" />
+<p class="caption">DYAK WOMEN IN CANOE.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>Preparatory to landing, we began performing our ablutions in the boat,
+much to the amusement and delight of the naked groups of Dyaks who were
+assembled at the landing place, and who eyed us in mute astonishment.
+The application of a hair brush was the signal for a general burst of
+laughter, but cleaning the teeth with a tooth brush caused a scream of
+wonder, a perfect yell, I presume at our barbarous customs. There were
+many women among the groups; they appeared to be well made, and more
+than tolerably good looking. I need not enter into a very minute
+description of their attire, for, truth to say, they had advanced very
+little beyond the costume of our common mother Eve. We were soon in
+closer contact with them,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_75" id="Page_75">[75]</a></span> for one of our party throwing out of the boat
+a common black bottle, half a dozen of the women plunged into the stream
+to gain possession of it. They swam to the side of our boat without any
+reserve, and then a struggle ensued as to who should be the fortunate
+owner of the prize. It was gained by a fine young girl of about
+seventeen years of age, and who had a splendid pair of black eyes. She
+swam like a frog, and with her long hair streaming in the water behind
+her, came pretty well up to our ideas of a mermaid.</p>
+
+<p>As we had contrived to empty a considerable number of these bottles
+during our expedition, they were now thrown overboard in every
+direction. This occasioned a great increase of the floating party, it
+being joined by all the other women on the beach, and for more than half
+an hour we amused ourselves with the exertions and contentions of our
+charming naiads, to obtain what they appeared to prize so much; at last
+all our empty bottles were gone, and the women swam on shore with them,
+as much delighted with their spoil as we had been amused with their
+eagerness and activity.</p>
+
+<p>About 10 o'clock we landed, and proceeded to pay our visit to the Chief.
+We were ushered into a spacious house, built of wood and thatched with
+leaves, capable of containing at least 400 people. The Chief was sitting
+on a mat with his three sons by his side, and attended by all his
+warriors. The remainder of the space within was occupied by as many of
+the natives as could find room; those who could not, remained in the
+court-yard outside. The Chief, who was a fine looking grey-bearded man
+of about sixty years of age, was dressed in velvet, and wore on his head
+a turban of embroidered silk. The three sons were dressed in the way I
+have already described the one to have been who came to us in the canoe.
+Without exception, those three young men were the most symmetrical in
+form I have ever seen. The unrestrained state of nature in which these
+Dyaks<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_76" id="Page_76">[76]</a></span> live, gives to them a natural grace and an easiness of posture,
+which is their chief characteristic. After the usual greetings and
+salutations had been passed through, we all sat down on mats and
+cushions which had been arranged for us; a short conversation with Mr.
+Brooke, who speaks the language fluently, then took place between him
+and the Chief, after which refreshments were set before us. These
+consisted of various eatables and sweetmeats made of rice, honey, sugar,
+flour, and oil; and although very simple as a confectionery, they were
+very palatable. We remained with the Chief about an hour, and before we
+went away he requested our company in the evening, promising to treat us
+with a Dyak war dance. We took our leave for the present, and amused
+ourselves with strolling about the town. I will take this opportunity of
+making known some information I have at this and at different times
+obtained relative to this people.</p>
+
+<p>The villages of the Dyaks are always built high up, near the source of
+the rivers, or, should the river below be occupied by the piratical
+tribes, on the hills adjoining to the source. Their houses are very
+large, capable of containing two hundred people, and are built of palm
+leaves. A village or town may consist of fifteen or twenty houses.
+Several families reside in one house, divided from each other by only a
+slight partition of mats. Here they take their meals, and employ
+themselves, without interfering with each other. Their furniture and
+property are very simple, consisting of a few cooking utensils, the
+paddles of their canoes, their arms, and a few mats.</p>
+
+<p>In all the Dyak villages every precaution is taken to guard against
+surprise. I have already described the strength and fortifications of
+Loondoo, and a similar principle is every where adopted. The town being
+built on the banks of the river, the boom I have described is invariably
+laid across the stream to prevent the ascent of boats.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_77" id="Page_77">[77]</a></span> Commanding the
+barriers, one or more forts are built on an eminence, mounting within
+them five or six of the native guns, called leilas. The forts are
+surrounded by a strong stockade, which is surmounted by a
+cheveaux-de-frise of split bamboos. These stockaded forts are, with the
+houses and cocoa nuts adjoining, again surrounded by a strong stockade,
+which effectually secures them from any night attack.</p>
+
+<p>Great respect is paid to the laws and to the mandates of their Chiefs,
+although it but too often happens that, stimulated by revenge, or other
+passions, they take the law into their own hands; but if crimes are
+committed, they are not committed without punishment following them, and
+some of their punishments are very barbarous and cruel: I have seen a
+woman with both her hands half-severed at the wrists, and a man with
+both his ears cut off.</p>
+
+<p>The religious ideas of the Dyaks resemble those of the North American
+Indians: they acknowledge a Supreme Being, or "Great Spirit;" they have
+also some conception of an hereafter. Many of the tribes imagine that
+the great mountain Keney Balloo is a place of punishment for guilty
+departed souls. They are very scrupulous regarding their cemeteries,
+paying the greatest respect to the graves of their ancestors. When a
+tribe quits one place to reside at another, they exhume the bones of
+their relations, and take them with them.</p>
+
+<p>I could not discover if they had any marriage ceremony, but they are
+very jealous of their wives, and visit with great severity any
+indiscretion on their parts.</p>
+
+<p>The Dyaks live principally upon rice, fish, and fruit, and they are very
+moderate in their living. They extract shamshoo from the palm, but
+seldom drink it Their principal luxury consists in the chewing the
+betel-nut and chunam; a habit in which, like all the other inhabitants
+of these regions, from Arracan down to the island of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_78" id="Page_78">[78]</a></span> New Guinea, they
+indulge to excess. This habit is any thing but becoming, as it renders
+the teeth quite black, and the lips of a high vermilion, neither of
+which alterations is any improvement to a copper-coloured face.</p>
+
+<p>They both chew and smoke tobacco, but they do not use pipes for smoking;
+they roll up the tobacco in a strip of dried leaf, take three or four
+whiffs, emitting the smoke through their nostrils, and then they
+extinguish it. They are fond of placing a small roll of tobacco between
+the upper lip and gums, and allow it to remain there for hours. Opium is
+never used by them, and I doubt if they are acquainted with its
+properties.</p>
+
+<p>They seldom cultivate more land than is requisite for the rice, yams,
+and sago for their own consumption, their time being chiefly employed in
+hunting and fishing. They appear to me to be far from an industrious
+race of people, and I have often observed hundreds of fine-looking
+fellows lolling and sauntering about, seeming to have no cares beyond
+the present. Some tribes that I visited preferred obtaining their rice
+in exchange from others, to the labour of planting it themselves. They
+are, in fact, not agriculturally inclined, but always ready for barter.</p>
+
+<p>They are middle-sized, averaging five feet five inches, but very
+strong-built and well-conditioned, and with limbs beautifully
+proportioned. In features they differ very much from the piratical
+inhabitants of these rivers. The head is finely formed, the hair,
+slightly shaven in front, is all thrown to the back of the head; their
+cheek-bones are high, eyes small, black and piercing, nose not exactly
+flat&mdash;indeed in some cases I have seen it rather aquiline; the mouth is
+large, and lips rather thick, and there is a total absence of hair on
+the face and eyebrows. Now the above description is not very much unlike
+that of an African; and yet they are very unlike, arising, I <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_79" id="Page_79">[79]</a></span>believe,
+from the very pleasing and frank expression of their countenances, which
+is their only beauty. This description, however, must not be considered
+as applicable to the whole of these tribes,&mdash;those on the S. E. coast of
+the island being by no means so well-favoured.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="serebis" id="serebis"></a>
+<img src="images/079a.jpg" width="394" height="600" alt="Serebis Dyak" />
+<div class="cap">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">SEREBIS DYAK.<br />
+<small>(N. W. COAST OF BORNEO.)</small>
+</p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>The different tribes are more distinguishable by their costumes than by
+their manners. The Dyaks of Loondoo are quite naked, and cover the arms
+and legs with brass rings. Those of Serebis and Linga are remarkable for
+wearing as many as ten to fifteen large rings in their ears. The Dusums,
+a tribe of Dyaks on the north coast, wear immense rings of solid tin or
+copper round their hips and shoulders, while the Saghai Dyaks of the
+S. E. are dressed in tigers' skins and rich cloth, with splendid
+head-dresses, made out of monkeys' skins and the feathers of the Argus
+pheasant.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="teeth" id="teeth"></a>
+<img src="images/079b.jpg" width="500" height="273" alt="Teeth of Dyaks" />
+<p class="caption">TEETH OF DYAKS.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>The invariable custom of filing the teeth sharp, combined with the use
+of the betel-nut turning them quite black, gives their profile a very
+strange appearance. Sometimes they render their teeth concave by
+filing.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_80" id="Page_80">[80]</a></span></p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="costumes" id="costumes"></a>
+<img src="images/080a.jpg" width="500" height="530" alt="Costumes of Dyak Women." />
+<p class="caption">COSTUMES OF DYAK WOMEN.</p>
+</div>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="blowpipe" id="blowpipe"></a>
+<img src="images/080b.jpg" width="600" height="161" alt="Blow-pipe" />
+<p class="caption">SUM-PI-TAN&mdash;BLOW-PIPE WITH POISONED ARROWS.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>Their arms consist of the blow-pipe (sum-pi-tan), from which they eject
+small arrows, poisoned with the juice of the upas; a long sharp knife,
+termed pa-rang; a spear, and a shield. They are seldom without their
+arms, for the spear is used in hunting, the knife for cutting leaves,
+and the sum-pi-tan for shooting small birds. Their warfare is carried on
+more by treachery and stratagem than open fighting&mdash;they <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_81" id="Page_81">[81]</a></span>are all
+warriors, and seldom at peace. The powerful tribes which reside on the
+banks of the river generally possess several war prahus, capable of
+holding from twenty to thirty men, and mounting a brass gun (leila) on
+her bows, carrying a ball of one to two pounds weight. These prahus,
+when an expedition is to be made against a neighbouring tribe, are
+manned by the warriors, one or two of the most consequential men being
+stationed in each prahu. Before they start upon an expedition, like the
+North American Indians, they perform their war dance.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="saghai" id="saghai"></a>
+<img src="images/080c.jpg" width="394" height="600" alt="Saghai Dyak" />
+<div class="cap">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">SAGHAI DYAK.<br />
+<small>(S. E. COAST OF BORNEO.)</small>
+</p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>Should their enemies have gained intelligence of the meditated attack,
+they take the precaution of sending away their women, children, and
+furniture, into the jungle, and place men in ambush on the banks of the
+river, who attack the assailants as they advance. The Dyaks are all very
+brave, and fight desperately, yelling during the combat like the
+American Indians. The great object in their combats is to obtain as many
+of the heads of the party opposed as possible; and if they succeed in
+their surprise of the town or village, the heads of the women and
+children are equally carried off as trophies. But there is great
+difficulty in obtaining a head, for the moment that a man falls every
+effort is made by his own party to carry off the body, and prevent the
+enemy from obtaining such a trophy. If the attacking party are
+completely victorious, they finish their work of destruction by setting
+fire to all the houses, and cutting down all the cocoa-nut trees; after
+which they return home in triumph with their spoil. As soon as they
+arrive another war dance is performed; and after making very merry, they
+deposit the heads which they have obtained in the head-house. Now,
+putting scalps for heads, the reader will perceive that their customs
+are nearly those of the American Indians.</p>
+
+<p>Every Dyak village has its head-house: it is generally the hall of
+audience as well. The interior is decorated with heads piled up in<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_82" id="Page_82">[82]</a></span>
+pyramids to the roof: of course the greater the number of heads the more
+celebrated they are as warriors.</p>
+
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="dyakvillage" id="dyakvillage"></a>
+<img src="images/082.jpg" width="500" height="495" alt="Dyak Village." />
+<p class="caption">DYAK VILLAGE.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>The women of the north-east coast are by no means bad-looking, but very
+inferior to the mountain Dyaks before described. I have seen one or two
+faces which might be considered as pretty. With the exception of a
+cloth, which is secured above the hips with a hoop of rattan, and
+descends down to the knees, they expose every other portion of their
+bodies. Their hair, which is fine and black, generally<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_83" id="Page_83">[83]</a></span> falls down
+behind. Their feet are bare. Like the American squaws, they do all the
+drudgery, carry the water, and paddle the canoes. They generally fled at
+our approach, if we came unexpectedly. The best looking I ever saw was
+one we captured on the river Sakarron. She was in a dreadful fright,
+expecting every moment to be killed, probably taking it for granted that
+we had our head-houses to decorate as well as their husbands. While
+lying off the town of Baloongan, expecting hostilities to ensue, we
+observed that the women who came down to fill their bamboos with water
+were all armed.</p>
+
+<p>And now to resume the narrative of our proceedings:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>I stated that after our interview with the old chief, and promising to
+return in the evening to witness a war dance, we proceeded on a stroll,
+accompanied by the chiefs eldest son, who acted as our guide, and
+followed by a large party of the natives. We first examined the forts:
+these were in a tolerable state of efficiency, but their gunpowder was
+coarse and bad. We next went over the naval arsenal, for being then at
+peace with every body, their prahus were hauled up under cover of sheds.
+One of them was a fine boat, about forty feet long, mounting a gun, and
+capable of containing forty or fifty men. She was very gaily decorated
+with paint and feathers, and had done good service on the Sakarron river
+in a late war. These war prahus have a flat strong roof, from which they
+fight, although they are wholly exposed to the spears and arrows of the
+enemy.</p>
+
+<p>We then invaded their domestic privacy, by entering the houses, and
+proceeded to an inspection of the blacksmith's shop, where we found the
+chiefs youngest son, with his velvet jacket thrown aside, working away
+at a piece of iron, which he was fashioning into a pa-rang, or Dyak
+knife. The Dyak pa-rang has been confounded with the Malay kris, but
+they differ materially. The Dyaks, I believe, seldom use the kris, and
+the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_84" id="Page_84">[84]</a></span> Malays never use the knife; and I observed, when we visited the
+south coast of Borneo, that the knife and other arms of the tribes
+inhabiting this portion, were precisely similar to those of the Dyaks on
+the northern coast. Customs so universal and so strictly adhered to
+proves not only individuality, but antiquity. Having examined every
+thing and every body, we were pretty well tired, and were not sorry that
+the hour had now arrived at which we were again to repair to the house
+of the rajah.</p>
+
+<p>On our arrival we found the rajah where we left him, and all the chief
+men and warriors assembled. Refreshments had been prepared for us, and
+we again swallowed various mysterious confections, which, as I before
+observed, would have been very good if we had been hungry. As soon as
+the eatables had been despatched, we lighted our cheroots, and having,
+by a dexterous and unperceived application out of a brandy bottle,
+succeeded in changing the rajah's lemonade into excellent punch, we
+smoked and drank until the rajah requested to know if we were ready to
+witness the promised war dance. Having expressed our wishes in the
+affirmative, the music struck up; it consisted of gongs and tom-toms.
+The Malay gong, which the Dyaks also make use of, is like the Javanese,
+thick with a broad rim, and very different from the gong of the Chinese.
+Instead of the clanging noise of the latter, it gives out a muffled
+sound of a deep tone. The gong and tom-tom are used by the Dyaks and
+Malays in war, and for signals at night, and the Dyaks procure them from
+the Malays. I said that the music struck up, for, rude as the
+instruments were, they modulate the sound, and keep time so admirably,
+that it was any thing but inharmonious.</p>
+
+<p>A space was now cleared in the centre of the house, and two of the
+oldest warriors stepped into it. They were dressed in turbans, long
+loose jackets, sashes round their waists descending to their feet,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_85" id="Page_85">[85]</a></span> and
+small bells were attached to their ankles. They commenced by first
+shaking hands with the rajah, and then with all the Europeans present,
+thereby giving us to understand, as was explained to us, that the dance
+was to be considered only as a spectacle, and not to be taken in its
+literal sense, as preparatory to an attack upon us, a view of the case
+in which we fully coincided with them.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="wardance" id="wardance"></a>
+<img src="images/085.jpg" width="600" height="399" alt="War Dance of The Dyaks" />
+<div class="cap-horiz">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">WAR DANCE OF THE DYAKS.</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>This ceremony being over, they rushed into the centre and gave a most
+unearthly scream, then poising themselves on one foot they described a
+circle with the other, at the same time extending their arms like the
+wings of a bird, and then meeting their hands, clapping them and keeping
+time with the music. After a little while the music became louder, and
+suddenly our ears were pierced with the whole of the natives present
+joining in the hideous war cry. Then the motions and the screams of the
+dancers became more violent, and every thing was working up to a state
+of excitement by which even we were influenced. Suddenly a very
+unpleasant odour pervaded the room, already too warm from the numbers it
+contained. Involuntarily we held our noses, wondering what might be the
+cause, when we perceived that one of the warriors had stepped into the
+centre and suspended round the shoulders of each dancer a human head in
+a wide meshed basket of rattan. These heads had been taken in the late
+Sakarron business, and were therefore but a fortnight old. They were
+encased in a wide net work of rattan, and were ornamented with beads.
+Their stench was intolerable, although, as we discovered upon after
+examination, when they were suspended against the wall, they had been
+partially baked and were quite black. The teeth and hair were quite
+perfect, the features somewhat shrunk, and they were altogether very
+fair specimens of pickled heads; but our worthy friends required a
+lesson from the New Zealanders in the art of preserving. The appearance
+of the heads was the signal for the music to play louder,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_86" id="Page_86">[86]</a></span> for the war
+cry of the natives to be more energetic, and for the screams of the
+dancers to be more piercing. Their motions now became more rapid, and
+the excitement in proportion. Their eyes glistened with unwonted
+brightness. The perspiration dropped down their faces, and thus did
+yelling, dancing, gongs, and tom-toms become more rapid and more violent
+every minute, till the dancing warriors were ready to drop. A farewell
+yell, with emphasis, was given by the surrounding warriors; immediately
+the music ceased, the dancers disappeared, and the tumultuous excitement
+and noise was succeeded by a dead silence. Such was the excitement
+communicated, that when it was all over we ourselves remained for some
+time panting to recover our breath. Again we lighted our cheroots and
+smoked for a while the pipe of peace.</p>
+
+<p>A quarter of an hour elapsed and the preparations were made for another
+martial dance. This was performed by two of the rajah's sons, the same
+young men I have previously made mention of. They came forward each
+having on his arm one of the large Dyak shields, and in the centre of
+the cleared space were two long swords lying on the floor. The ceremony
+of shaking hands, as described preparatory to the former dance, was
+first gone through; the music then struck up and they entered the arena.
+At first they confined themselves to evolutions of defence, springing
+from one side to the other with wonderful quickness, keeping their
+shields in front of them, falling on one knee and performing various
+feats of agility. After a short time, they each seized a sword, and then
+the display was very remarkable, and proved what ugly customers they
+must be in single conflict. Blows in every direction, feints of every
+description, were made by both, but invariably received upon the
+shields. Cumbrous as these shields were, no opening was ever left,
+retreating, pursuing, dodging, and striking, the body was never exposed.
+Occasionally, during this<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_87" id="Page_87">[87]</a></span> performance, the war cry was given by the
+surrounding warriors, but the combatants held their peace; in fact they
+could not afford to open their mouths, lest an opening should be made.
+It was a most masterly performance, and we were delighted with it.</p>
+
+<p>As the evening advanced into night, we had a sort of extemporary drama,
+reminding us of one of the dances, as they are called, of the American
+Indians, in which the warriors tell their deeds of prowess. This was
+performed by two of the principal and oldest warriors, who appeared in
+long white robes, with long staves in their hands. They paraded up and
+down the centre, alternately haranguing each other; the subject was the
+praise of their own rulers, a relation of their own exploits, and an
+exhortation to the young warriors to emulate their deeds. This
+performance was most tedious; it lasted for about three hours, and, as
+we could not understand a word that was said, it was not peculiarly
+interesting. It, however, had one good effect: it sent us all asleep. I
+fell asleep before the others, I am told; very possible. I certainly
+woke up the first, and on waking, found that all the lights were out,
+and that the rajah and the whole company had disappeared, with the
+exception of my European friends, who were all lying around me. My
+cheroot was still in my mouth, so I re-lighted it and smoked it, and
+then again lay down by the side of my companions. Such was the wind-up
+of our visit to the rajah, who first excited us by his melodramas, and
+then sent us to sleep with his recitations.</p>
+
+<p>The next morning, at daylight, we repaired to our boats, and when all
+was ready took leave of the old rajah. The rajah's eldest son had
+promised to accompany us to the mouth of the river, and show us how the
+natives hunted the wild pigs, which are very numerous in all the jungles
+of Borneo.</p>
+
+<p>We got under weigh and proceeded down the river accompanied by a large
+canoe, which was occupied by the rajah's son, six or seven<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_88" id="Page_88">[88]</a></span> hunters, and
+a pack of the dogs used in hunting the wild boar on this island. These
+dogs were small, but very wiry, with muzzles like foxes, and curling
+tails. Their hair was short, and of a tan colour. Small as they are,
+they are very bold, and one of them will keep a wild pig at bay till the
+hunters come up to him.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="fire" id="fire"></a>
+<img src="images/089.jpg" width="400" height="477" alt="fire making." />
+<p class="caption">OBTAINING FIRE.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>We arrived at the hunting ground at the mouth of the river in good time,
+before the scent was off, and landed in the <i>Tam-bang</i>. Our captain
+having a survey to make of an island at the mouth of the river, to our
+great delight took away the barge and gig, leaving Mr. Brooke, Hentig,
+Captain Keppell, Adams, and myself, to accompany the rajah's son. Having
+arranged that the native boat should pull along the coast in the
+direction that we were to walk, and having put on board the little that
+we had collected for our dinners, we shouldered our guns and followed
+the hunters and dogs. The natives who accompanied us were naked, and
+armed only with a spear. They entered the jungle with the dogs, rather
+too fatiguing an exercise for us, and we contented ourselves with
+walking along the beach abreast of them, waiting very patiently for the
+game to be started. In a very few minutes the dogs gave tongue, and as
+the noise continued we presumed that a boar was on foot; nor were we
+wrong in our conjecture; the barking of the dogs ceased, and one of the
+hunters came out of the jungle to us with a fine pig on his back, which
+he had transfixed with his spear. Nor were we long without our share of
+the sport, for we suddenly came upon a whole herd which had been driven
+out of the jungle, and our bullets did execution. We afterwards had more
+shots, and with what we killed on the beach, and the natives secured in
+the jungle, as the evening advanced we found ourselves in possession of
+eight fine grown animals. These the rajah's son and his hunters very
+politely requested our acceptance of. We now had quite sufficient
+materials for our dinner, and as we were literally as hungry as
+hunters,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_89" id="Page_89">[89]</a></span> we were most anxious to fall to, and looked upon our pigs with
+very cannibal eyes. The first thing necessary was to light a fire, and
+for the first time I had an opportunity of seeing the Dyak way of
+obtaining it. It differs slightly from the usual manner, and is best
+explained by a sketch. Captain Keppell, who was always the life and soul
+of every thing, whether it was a fight or a pic nic, was unanimously
+elected caterer, and in that capacity he was most brilliant. I must
+digress a little to bestow upon that officer the meed of universal
+opinion; for his kindness, mirth, and goodness of heart, have rendered
+him a favourite wherever he has been known, not only a favourite with
+the officers, but even more so, if possible, with the men. In the
+expeditions in which Keppell has been commanding officer, where the men
+were worn out with continued exertion at the oar, and with the many
+obstacles to be overcome, Keppell's voice would be heard, and when
+heard, the men were encouraged and renewed their endeavours. Keppell's
+stock,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_90" id="Page_90">[90]</a></span> when provisions were running short, and with small hopes of a
+fresh supply, was freely shared among those about him, while our gallant
+captain, with a boat half filled with his own hampers, would see, and
+appeared pleased to see, those in his company longing for a mouthful
+which never would be offered. If any of the youngsters belonging to
+other ships were, from carelessness or ignorance, in trouble with the
+commanding officers, it was to Keppell that they applied, and it was
+Keppell who was the intercessor. In fact, every occasion in which
+kindness, generosity, or consideration for others could be shown, such
+an opportunity was never lost by Keppell, who, to sum up, was a beloved
+friend, a delightful companion, and a respected commander. As soon as
+our fire was lighted, we set to, under Keppell's directions, and, as may
+be supposed, as we had little or nothing else, pork was our principal
+dish. In fact, we had pig at the top, pig at the bottom, pig in the
+centre, and pig at the sides. A Jew would have made but a sorry repast,
+but we, emancipated Christians, made a most ravenous one, defying Moses
+and all his Deuteronomy. We had plenty of wine and segars, and soon
+found ourselves very comfortably seated on the sand, still warm from the
+rays of the burning mid-day sun. Towards the end of a long repast we
+felt a little chilly, and we therefore rose and indulged in the games of
+leap-frog, fly-the-garter, and other venturous amusements. We certainly
+had in our party one or two who were as well fitted to grace the senate
+as to play at leap-frog, but I have always observed that the cleverest
+men are the most like children when an opportunity is offered for
+relaxation. I don't know what the natives thought of the European Rajah
+Brooke playing at leap-frog, but it is certain that the rajah did not
+care what they thought. I have said little of Mr. Brooke, but I will now
+say that a more mild, amiable, and celebrated person I never knew. Every
+one loved him, and he deserved it.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_91" id="Page_91">[91]</a></span>After we had warmed ourselves with play, we lighted an enormous fire to
+keep off the mosquitoes, and made a bowl of grog to keep off the effects
+of the night air, which is occasionally very pernicious. We smoked and
+quaffed, and had many a merry song and many a witty remark, and many a
+laugh about nothing on that night. As it is highly imprudent to sleep in
+the open air in Borneo, at ten o'clock we broke up and went to repose in
+the boats under the spread awnings. Just as we were selecting the
+softest plank we could find for a bed, we had an alarm which might have
+been attended with fatal consequences. I omitted to mention that when we
+rose to part and go into the boats, one of the party threw a lighted
+brand out of the fire at the legs of another; this compliment was
+returned, and as it was thought very amusing, the object being to leap
+up and let the brand pass between your legs, by degrees all the party
+were engaged in it, even the rajah and the natives joined in the sport,
+and were highly amused with it, although with bare legs they stood a
+worse chance of being hit than we did. At last the brands were all
+expended and the fire extinct, and then, as I said, we went away to
+sleep under the boats' awnings. We were in the act of depositing our
+loaded rifles by our sides in a place of security, when the unearthly
+war cry rose in the jungle, and in the stillness of the night these
+discordant screams sounded like the yelling of a legion of devils.
+Immediately afterwards a body of natives rushed from the jungle in the
+direction of the boats, in which we supposed that our European party
+were all assembled. Always on our guard against treachery, and not
+knowing but that these people might belong to a hostile band, in an
+instant our rifles were in our hands and pointed at the naked body of
+natives, who were now within twenty yards of us. Mr. Hentig was on the
+point of firing, when loud shouts of laughter from the Dyaks arrested
+his hand, and we then perceived that Mr. Brooke and others were with the
+natives, who<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_92" id="Page_92">[92]</a></span> enjoyed the attempt to intimidate us. It was fortunate
+that it ended as it did; for had Mr. Hentig been more hasty, blood must
+have been shed in consequence of this native practical joke. We joined
+the laugh, however, laid down our rifles, then laid ourselves down, and
+went fast asleep, having no further disturbance than the still small
+voice of the mosquito, which, like that of conscience, is one that
+"murders sleep."</p>
+
+<p>The following morning we bade adieu to our friendly hunting party, and I
+must not here omit to mention a trait of honesty on the part of the
+Dyaks. I had dropped my pocket handkerchief in the walk of the day
+before, and in the evening it was brought to me by one of the natives,
+who had followed a considerable distance to bring it to me. It must be
+known, that a coloured silk handkerchief is to one of these poor Dyaks,
+who are very fond of finery, an article of considerable value. He might
+have retained it without any fear; and his bringing it to me was not
+certainly with any hope of reward, as I could have given him nothing
+which he would have prized so much as the handkerchief itself. He was
+made a present of it for his honesty.</p>
+
+<p>We bade farewell to our friends at Kuchin, and continued our survey on
+the coast. The boats were now continually employed away from the ship,
+which moved slowly to the westward. At this time exposure and hard work
+brought the fever into the ship. The barge returned in consequence of
+four of her men being taken with it, and our sick list increased daily.
+A few days afterwards the coxswain of the barge died, and was buried
+along side the same morning. This death, after so short an illness,
+damped the spirits of the officers and men, particularly of those who
+were ill. After this burial we sailed for Sincapore. At this time our
+sick report contained the names of more than thirty men, with every
+probability of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_93" id="Page_93">[93]</a></span> the number being increased; but, thanks to God, from
+change of air, fresh provisions, and a little relaxation from the
+constant fatigue, the majority were in a short time convalescent. On the
+25th of September we arrived at Sincapore.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="sincapore" id="sincapore"></a>
+<img src="images/093.jpg" width="500" height="492" alt="View of Sincapore." />
+<p class="caption">VIEW OF SINCAPORE.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>From the anchorage the town of Sincapore has a very pleasing appearance.
+Most of the public buildings, as well as some of the principal
+merchants' houses, face the sea. The church is also close to the beach,
+I presume to allow the congregation the benefit of the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_94" id="Page_94">[94]</a></span> sea breezes. It
+has no architectural beauty to recommend it, being a plain building with
+a spiral steeple, surmounted by a cross. The interior is fitted up with
+more regard to neatness than elegance. It has an organ, and is supplied
+with a host of young choristers from the academy.</p>
+
+<p>Between the beach and Government Hill is a delightful upland, which is
+generally attended by all the beauty and fashion of Sincapore in the
+cool of the evening. A canal or small river divides the town into two
+parts. On the western side of it, stand all the stone houses of the
+merchants, and it is here that all commercial business is transacted. It
+is densely populated with Armenian Jews, Chinese, and people from every
+part of India, each nation residing in its own quarter, in the houses
+peculiar to and characteristic of their country. Indeed, one of the
+first things that strikes the stranger in Sincapore is the variety of
+costume; Chinamen, Malays and Indians, Armenians and Jews, all mingle
+together in every variety of picturesque costume, giving you an idea of
+a carnival. The palanquins resemble an omnibus on a small scale, they
+are drawn on four wheels, have a door on either side, and seats for four
+people. They are very high, and drawn by one horse. The conductors,
+however, are not perched up on high, but run by the side of the horse,
+as do all the syces in India.</p>
+
+<p>There are two hotels, the proprietors of which are of course rivals. One
+is kept by an Englishman, the other by a Frenchman; both are equally
+attentive, but the Frenchman's house has the preference, in consequence
+of its superior locality, facing the esplanade, and looking upon the
+sea. The governor's house is situated on the summit of a hill, about a
+quarter of a mile from the beach. From it you have a bird's eye view of
+the whole town, and also of the country in the interior for some
+distance. From this eminence the town has a very<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_95" id="Page_95">[95]</a></span> picturesque
+appearance; the houses on the east side of the river (the May fair of
+Sincapore), are built apart and surrounded by pretty gardens and lawns;
+beyond this you have the roads and the sea studded with every variety of
+vessels; and the island of Binting rises from sea in the distance. The
+interior is not without beauty: the eye ranges over a vast expanse of
+grove and forest, interspersed with plantations of nutmegs, cinnamon,
+cloves, and sugar canes, and from which a most delightful perfume is
+brought by the breeze, while here and there white houses may be
+perceived, looking like mere specks in the dark foliage by which they
+are surrounded. It is surprising, when we reflect how short a space of
+time has passed since this settlement was first made, how such a mass of
+building and such a concourse of people can have been collected.</p>
+
+<p>It certainly does appear strange, but it is no less true, that no nation
+can colonise like the English, and I have often made that remark in my
+wanderings and visitings of the various parts of the globe. England
+fills the world and civilises the world with her redundant population,
+and all her colonies flourish, and remind you of a swarm of bees which
+have just left the old hive and are busy in providing for themselves.
+The Dutch colonies are not what you can call thriving; they have not the
+bustle, the enterprise, and activity which our colonies possess. The
+Dutch have never conciliated the natives, and obtained their goodwill;
+they have invariably resorted to violence, and to a disregard of
+justice. One would have thought that the French, from their <i>bonhomie</i>,
+would have been one of the very best nations to civilise, and certain to
+have succeeded; but such is not the case. What can be the cause of this,
+if it be not that, instead of raising the character of the native
+population by good example and strict justice, they demoralise by
+introducing vices hitherto unknown to them, and alienate them by
+injustice? There<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_96" id="Page_96">[96]</a></span> was an outcry raised at the French taking possession
+of Taheite, as if any attempt on their part to colonise was an
+infringement on our right as Englishmen of universal colonisation. I
+think if we were wise, we should raise no objection to their colonising
+as much as they please. The whole expence of founding the colony,
+raising the fortifications, and building the towns, and, if I may use
+the phrase, of settling every thing, may safely be left to them. If a
+war breaks out, they will have done a great deal of expensive work for
+our benefit, as we are certain then to take possession. Algiers has cost
+an enormous sum to France, and will cost still more, and yet it can
+hardly be considered as a colony. It is a military possession, an
+African barrack, no more; and what will be the result in case of the
+breaking out of hostilities? Their possession of Algiers will be most
+advantageous to England, for defend it they will with all their power.
+We, with Gibraltar as a rendezvous, shall of course have a most
+favourable position for assailing it, and the consequence will be, that
+the whole focus of the war will be drawn away from our own coasts, and
+the Mediterranean will be the arena of all the fighting. The struggle
+must be before the Pillars of Hercules. The more we increase our fleets,
+the larger must her force be, and she will have no squadron to spare to
+send out to annoy our trade and colonial possessions. But as this is a
+digression, and has nothing to do with my narrative, I beg pardon and go
+on.</p>
+
+<p>We found that the Dido had anchored there before us, and had received
+her orders to proceed to England. Oh! how we envied her good fortune;
+and surely if envy is a base passion, in this instance it becomes
+ennobled by the feelings of home and country which excite it. The Dido
+left on the 10th, and we regretted the loss of Captain Keppell most
+deeply. Many merchant vessels had been lately wrecked on the north coast
+of Borneo, and their crews made prisoners<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_97" id="Page_97">[97]</a></span> by the pirate hordes. Some of
+the vessels had had females on board, who had not been heard of since. A
+letter from a master of a merchant vessel was received by the
+authorities at Sincapore, wherein it was stated on oath, that, having
+lately put into the port of Ambong, in Borneo, an European woman had
+been seen near one of the huts of the village; but that on their
+approach, she disappeared. This account was corroborated by the evidence
+of some Lascar seamen, who formed a portion of the crew of the vessel.
+The contents of this letter being forwarded by the authorities to our
+gallant captain, he determined upon proceeding to Ambong, accompanied by
+our old ally, the Phlegethon steamer. Fortunately the town lay in our
+track, as we were about to proceed to Labuan, and from thence to
+Manilla. We again weighed anchor for Sarawak, whither the steamer had
+already proceeded. On our arrival at the mouth of the river we anchored,
+and the captain went up in his gig. The following day, to our great
+surprise, we received an intimation that we might make a party of
+pleasure (a party quite unknown in the Samarang), and go up to Kuchin.
+We hurried away before the captain had time to repent his indulgence,
+and set off, some seven or eight of us, in the cutter, and pulled away
+as fast as we could, till we were first out of hail, and then out of
+sight, when we considered that we were safe.</p>
+
+<p>I have already stated that the native houses are built on the left side
+of the Sarawak river, and those of the Europeans on the right. These
+latter are pretty commodious little bungalows, built of cedar and pine
+wood. At present there are but three, belonging to Mr. Brooke, Mr.
+Williamson the interpreter, and Hentig, a merchant who has lately
+settled there. Ruppell, Mr. Brooke's superintendent, and Treecher, the
+surgeon, live in a large house on the native side of the river. Each of
+these European houses has its chatty bath adjoining to it, and this
+luxury is indulged in at all hours of the day. At nine<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_98" id="Page_98">[98]</a></span> o'clock a gong
+summons all the Europeans to the breakfast table of Mr. Brooke. When
+breakfast is over, they all separate, either to follow business or
+pleasure, and seldom meet again till six in the evening, when dinner is
+served, and the time is passed away till all retire to bed.</p>
+
+<p>Let me describe the view from the front of Mr. Brooke's house:&mdash;The
+schooner lying half way across the river is the Julia, belonging to Mr.
+Brooke: she sails every month for Sincapore, laden with antimony ore;
+and thus, at the same time, she forms a mail-packet between Sincapore
+and Kuchin. The large open building, with a wharf, leading down to the
+river, is the store in which the antimony is sifted, smelted, and
+weighed. On the point near the bend of the river is the fort. It is a
+strong building of large timbers, and mounts eight 24-lb. iron guns, in
+very excellent condition. This is a very necessary defence, as the
+European rajah has many enemies. The building whose top just appears
+above the trees is the Chinese joss-house, or temple; for there are many
+Chinese settlers at Kuchin, who are very useful in their capacities of
+carpenters, blacksmiths, and agriculturists. Sweeping with the eye a
+range of dwelling houses built on stakes, you stop at one of tolerable
+proportions, which has a platform in front of it, on which are mounted
+about twenty small guns, and there is a flag-staff, on which is hoisted
+a red and yellow flag: that is the palace of Rajah Muda Hassan. Take a
+canoe, and cross over to it. You will find Muda sitting cross-legged in
+the centre of it: he shakes hands with you, and offers you cigars and
+tea. You will also meet his brother, Bud-ruddeen. You take your leave of
+the rajah, and amuse yourself with a walk round the town, during which
+you examine the natives and their wives, their customs, their houses,
+and their gardens.</p>
+
+<p>With the exception of the more civilised tribes in the vicinity of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_99" id="Page_99">[99]</a></span> the
+Sarawak, the Malays who inhabit the coast of Borneo are a cruel,
+treacherous, and disgusting race of men, with scarcely one good quality
+to recommend them. The numerous tribes of these people are separately
+governed, either by a rajah or petty sultan. Their laws are much more
+respected than would be supposed in a country where every man is armed,
+and is a robber by profession. The dress of the Malay is very uniform,
+consisting of a loose jacket, a sash, and trousers: in some parts a
+cloth is worn round the head; in others, a hat, made of leaves or
+rattan. Their arms are the kris and spear; occasionally they carry the
+sum-pi-tan, and poisoned arrows. Their houses are built upon stakes,
+probably for the sake of cleanliness; as the flooring consists of a kind
+of grating made of rattan, all dirt falls through. The houses are small,
+and contain but one family, and, like those of the Dyaks, are built of
+the lightest materials. The Malays pretend to Mahomedanism, and there is
+generally a large empty building in every town which is dignified with
+the name of a mosque: on the outside are hung drums or tom-toms, of huge
+dimensions, which are used as gentle reminders of the hours of prayer.</p>
+
+<p>I have already stated that these Malay tribes live almost wholly by
+piracy, to carry on which each town possesses several large prahus,
+which they man, and send out to intercept any unfortunate junk or other
+vessel incapable of much resistance, which fate or the currents may have
+driven too near their coast. When the vessels are captured the cargoes
+are deposited in their warehouses, the vessels are broken up, and the
+crews are retained as slaves, to dig yams or pound paddy. Unless they
+are irritated by a desperate resistance, or they attack an inimical
+tribe, they do not shed blood, as has generally been supposed;
+restrained, however, by no other feeling than that of avarice, for the
+slaves are too valuable to be destroyed. In their physiognomy these
+Malays are inferior to the Dyaks: they have a strong resemblance to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_100" id="Page_100">[100]</a></span> the
+monkey in face, with an air of low cunning and rascality most
+unprepossessing. In stature they are very low, and generally
+bandy-legged. Their hair and eyes are invariably black, but the face is,
+in most cases, devoid of hair; when it does grow, it is only at the
+extreme point of the chin. The Borneo Malay women are as plain as the
+men, although at Sincapore, Mauritius, and the Sooloos, they are well
+favoured; and they wind their serang, or robe, so tight round their
+bodies, that they walk in a very constrained and ungainly fashion. Many
+of these tribes are intermixed with the natives of the Celebes, such as
+the inhabitants of Sooloo.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="malaywoman" id="malaywoman"></a>
+<img src="images/100.jpg" width="300" height="500" alt="Malay Woman" />
+<p class="caption">MALAY WOMAN.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>The Malays deal with criminals in a very summary manner, the knowledge
+of which prevents many crimes among this semi-barbarous people. Robbers,
+for the first offence, lose their right hand; for the second they
+undergo the penalty of death. When we were at Kuchin <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_101" id="Page_101">[101]</a></span>a Chinaman was
+convicted of selling sam-schoo without permission: his goods were
+confiscated for a time, to be redeemed only by his good behaviour. I am
+not acquainted with their punishments for minor offences, except in the
+above instance; but I believe it is generally by fine. Every rajah holds
+despotic sway over the inhabitants of his province, and punishes as he
+thinks proper, without reference to any tribunal, even in cases where
+the sentence is death. The method of executing criminals with the kris
+is as follows:&mdash;He is made to sit down in a chair, with his arms
+extended horizontally, and held in that position by two men. The
+executioner, who stands behind him, inserts his kris above the
+collar-bone, in a perpendicular manner, which causes instant death, as
+the weapon enters the heart.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="malaychief" id="malaychief"></a>
+<img src="images/101.jpg" width="396" height="600" alt="War Dance of The Dyaks" />
+<div class="cap">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">MALAY CHIEF.<br />
+<small>(SOOLOO.)</small></p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>The following anecdote, related to me by some of the Roche people, may
+amuse the reader:&mdash;A celebrated Malay pirate, whose sanguinary deeds had
+filled the Archipelago with terror, became violently enamoured with one
+of the slaves of a rajah living on the river Sarawak. After vainly
+endeavouring to obtain her from her master by offers of money and
+entreaties, he lay in wait for her, and ran away with her into the
+jungle.</p>
+
+<p>He had hardly passed his honeymoon before the rajah discovered his
+retreat, and he sent to the Malay to inform him, that, if he would make
+his appearance at the audience upon a certain day, he should have
+justice done him.</p>
+
+<p>The Malay chief, who was a man of undaunted courage, and who felt
+confident that the reputation he had acquired by his piratical exploits
+was alone sufficient to awe his enemies, consented to appear, hoping
+that arrangements might be made which would permit him to leave the
+jungle, and allow him to enjoy his new bride in quiet.</p>
+
+<p>On the day appointed he appeared before the council, armed, and
+accompanied by his brother, both resting their hands upon the handles<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_102" id="Page_102">[102]</a></span>
+of their krisses, a movement which among the Malays proclaims no
+feelings of amity. In this attitude of preparation they walked into the
+audience room, which was crowded with a host of enemies. The council
+decided, that if on a certain day he would produce a specified sum of
+money the girl should be his, and he should return unmolested. The sum
+named was exorbitant, but the Malay chief agreed to the payment, and was
+permitted to depart.</p>
+
+<p>When the day of payment arrived, the council sat as before, and the
+Malay chief again made his appearance; but this time he came alone, his
+brother being absent on a piratical expedition. He had, in consequence
+of his violent affection for the girl, made every attempt to raise the
+stipulated sum, but could not succeed. He brought all that he could
+collect, but it fell far short of the sum which had been agreed upon,
+and he requested time to procure the remainder. The council consulted a
+while, and then stipulated, that the chief, not having brought the sum
+agreed upon, should leave his kris as a pledge till the rest should be
+forthcoming. The kris that the chief wore was itself of great value,
+very handsomely ornamented with precious stones. It had belonged to his
+ancestors, and was, as they always are, highly prized, and they knew
+that it would, if possible, be reclaimed. The chief was most reluctant
+to part with it, but his love for his mistress overcame his scruples,
+and also his prudence, for it left him unarmed amidst his implacable
+enemies. He pulled out his kris, and laid it on the table upon the
+money, and was busy disengaging the sheath to add to it, when, by a
+signal from the rajah, he was seized from behind. He started up, but it
+was too late; his trusty weapon, which had so often stood by him in his
+need, was no longer within his reach, and he was in a moment transfixed
+with a dozen blades, falling a victim to his love of the girl and the
+treachery of his foes.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_103" id="Page_103">[103]</a></span>After passing two very pleasant days at Kuchin, we prepared to descend
+the river. I have omitted to say that Mr. Treecher, the surgeon, was
+fond of natural history, and possessed a very tolerable collection of
+birds, and other animals indigenous to the country. I was shown several
+skeletons of the orang outang, some of which were of great size. There
+is no want of these animals in the jungle, but a living specimen is not
+easy to procure; I saw but one, an adult female, belonging to Mr.
+Brooke. It was very gentle in its manners, and, when standing upright,
+might have measured three feet six inches.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="proboscis" id="proboscis"></a>
+<img src="images/103.jpg" width="550" height="435" alt="Proboscis Monkey" />
+<p class="caption">PROBOSCIS MONKEY.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>On board of the Phlegethon there were two specimens of the wa-wa, or
+long-armed ape, which had been presented to Mr. Brooke by one of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_104" id="Page_104">[104]</a></span> the
+neighbouring rajahs, and they are by the natives considered very
+valuable. Their affection when domesticated is remarkable; their first
+act when they meet one they know is to leap upon your breast and embrace
+you with their arms, just like a child will its mother, and they will
+remain, if permitted, in this position for hours, and complain if
+removed. Their cry is very plaintive, and, heard at night in the jungle,
+sounds like that of a female in distress. I was given to understand that
+in the presents made by chiefs, a scarce variety of monkey is often the
+principal gift, and most esteemed.</p>
+
+<p>The scarcest monkey in Borneo is the proboscis, or long-nosed. I saw but
+two specimens of this animal, one a female, with the nose very long, and
+pendulous at the extremity; the other a male, very young, and with the
+nose more or less prominent, and giving its face a more actual
+resemblance to that of a man's than I had ever before seen. This monkey
+has never, I believe, been brought to England alive. The British Museum
+has a stuffed specimen. It is not so mischievous in its habits as the
+tribe in general.</p>
+
+<p>As Rajah Muda Hassan has been so frequently mentioned, it may be as well
+to give a succinct outline of his history. At the death of the late
+sultan, Muda Hassan was the heir-apparent to the throne, but he resigned
+in favour of his nephew, retaining the office of prime minister, which
+office he had held during the former reign, not only to the satisfaction
+of the sultan, but also of the people, with whom he was deservedly a
+great favourite. His influence, being even greater than that of the
+sultan, occasioned a jealous feeling, and a contention of party, which
+induced Muda Hassan to retire to Sarawak with his wives and personal
+attendants. He was succeeded in his office of prime minister by an Arab,
+Pangeran Usop, a man of unbounded ambition, who by his harsh and
+tyrannical conduct soon became hated by the Brunese, who longed for the
+return of Muda Hassan, under<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_105" id="Page_105">[105]</a></span> whose sway they had been quiet and happy.
+Pangeran Usop, aware of the popular feeling, now considered Muda Hassan
+as his enemy, and took every opportunity of vilifying and creating
+suspicion of Muda Hassan on the mind of the sultan, who was little
+better than an idiot. He asserted that Muda Hassan and his brother
+Bud-ruddeen were leagued with the English, and were their only
+supporters in their pretensions to the isle of Labuan, and that they
+would assist the English in taking possession of Borneo.</p>
+
+<p>These reports, although at first treated with disdain, continually
+repeated had their effect, not only upon the sultan, but upon the
+people; and Muda Hassan, who was informed of what had been going on, and
+had not deigned to notice it, now considered that it was advisable to
+repair to Borneo, and refute the charges brought against him.</p>
+
+<p>When Mr. Brooke purchased the rajahship and mines of Sarawak, he agreed
+to compensate Muda with a life annuity of two or three hundred per
+annum, and give him a passage to his native city, Bruni, whenever he
+should feel disposed to leave Kuchin. Some time had now elapsed since
+the signing of the contract, during which Muda had remained at his
+palace at Kuchin, enjoying his income, and living on the very best terms
+with the Europeans. He now, however, expressed a wish to return to
+Bruni, and as it was Mr. Brooke's intention to proceed to that port in
+the Samarang, it was proposed that the Phlegethon steamer should embark
+Muda and his suite, and that on our arrival at Bruni we should see this
+rajah and his brother Bud-ruddeen installed in their positions which by
+their birth they were entitled to. Another object was in view, and
+expected to be gained by this step. Up to the present, no efforts had
+been made by the Bornean government to discountenance piracy; on the
+contrary, the plunder of the pirates was brought in and openly disposed
+of at Bruni, which is the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_106" id="Page_106">[106]</a></span> royal residence. Muda and his brother
+Bud-ruddeen were stanch friends to the English, and it was anticipated
+that by their being appointed to offices of power, and forcing the
+sultan to a treaty to put down piracy, and pay respect to the English
+flag, a very important advance would be made towards the extermination
+of these marauders, and commerce, once rendered secure, and property
+respected, Borneo would soon be brought to a state of comparative
+civilisation.</p>
+
+<p>As soon as the two rajahs, with all their wives and suite, &amp;c., could be
+got on board of the Phlegethon, Mr. Brooke, and Mr. Williamson the
+interpreter, came on board the Samarang, and we sailed. On our arrival
+at the island of Labuan, we anchored the ship, and despatched the
+steamer, with her cargo, up to Bruni. The captain of the Samarang and
+one or two officers proceeded up to Bruni in the barge on the following
+day; and I was the midshipman in charge of the boat. We did not arrive
+at the city till 8 o'clock in the evening; and it was too dark to
+distinguish the houses. With some difficulty, we discovered the steamer,
+which was anchored on the main street. We pulled alongside, and landing
+the captain and Kuchinians, Adams, the surgeon of the party, and I,
+found ourselves in undisturbed possession of the barge.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="bruni" id="bruni"></a>
+<img src="images/106.jpg" width="600" height="399" alt="Bruni" />
+<div class="cap-horiz">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">BRUNI.<br />
+<small>(BORNEO PROPER.)</small></p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>Bruni is called by Crawfurd the Venice of the East; and he is so far
+correct, that it is built in the same peculiar way, and is a most
+extraordinary town. It is built almost entirely on the water. It is of
+great size, containing from thirty to forty thousand inhabitants, most
+of whom are Malays, but who, from having so long intermixed with the
+tribes on the coast, now style themselves Brunese, after the town. This
+town, which is situated where the river forms a wide and shallow
+estuary, is built with little regard to regularity. There are, however,
+two large main streets, intersecting each other in the form of an
+irregular cross. These divide the town into four parts, one of which<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_107" id="Page_107">[107]</a></span> is
+partly built upon terra firma, while the other three portions are
+composed of massive wooden houses, built on piles, and just sufficiently
+separated here and there to admit of the passage of a canoe. On the
+portion which is on dry land is built the sultan's palace, a church or
+mosque, and most of the more prominent buildings. It was in the main
+street (if such a term may be used), and as near as possible in the
+centre of the town, that the steamer was anchored.</p>
+
+<p>When we awoke and roused up it was broad daylight, and the scene was
+most novel: surrounding the steamer and the barge, and extending many
+yards from them, lay hundreds of canoes, filled with natives of every
+tribe to be found on the coast, and dressed in every variety of costume.
+From the wild Dusum to the civilised Arab and Malay rajah, natives in
+every posture, and decked in every colour, impelled by curiosity, were
+crowded around us. Here was a chief, dressed in an embroidered jacket,
+sitting cross-legged, and shading himself with a yellow silk umbrella.
+There were some wild-looking Dyaks, with scarcely as much covering as
+decency demanded, standing up on their narrow canoes, one hand resting
+on the handle of their knives, the other on their hips, eying us from
+under their long matted hair with glances that told of no good feeling
+towards us. In another quarter were women, in a covered boat, whose
+jealous lattices only permitted us a glimpse of sparkling eyes, and of
+the yellow array which proclaimed them as some of the royal favourites.
+As far as you could see on all sides there was a confused mass, composed
+of embroidered chiefs, black-eyed women, grey-bearded Arabs, spears,
+shields, paddles and umbrellas. Taking out my sketch-book, I amused
+myself with drawing the various costumes&mdash;no very easy task, as the
+canoes were continually on the move; and before I could well catch the
+head and shoulders of a native, when I raised my eyes from the paper he
+had<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_108" id="Page_108">[108]</a></span> often disappeared in the crowd, and I found another party and
+another costume in his place.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="nativesbruni" id="nativesbruni"></a>
+<img src="images/108.jpg" width="600" height="252" alt="Natives of Bruni" />
+<p class="caption">NATIVES OF BRUNI.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>Rajah Muda Hassan had already landed, and 10 o'clock had been fixed upon
+as the hour for a full-dress visit to the sultan. As the time
+approached, Mr. Brooke, with our captain and the officers composing the
+party, came into the barge, and were pulled up to the sultan's audience
+chamber. This was a large three-sided building, facing the water, with a
+platform in front, on which were mounted five or six leilas, or native
+guns. The roof was slightly carved, and the gables ornamented with large
+wooden rams' horns. The red and yellow flag of Borneo waved above it.</p>
+
+<p>We were received at the platform by a numerous party of chiefs,
+handsomely dressed in silks, satins, and gold embroidery. They ushered
+us into the audience chamber, the walls of which were lined with a sort
+of cloth, and ornamented with shields. The floor was matted. The chamber
+was filled with natives, all well dressed and armed. They sat
+cross-legged, preserving a respectful silence. A vacant aisle was
+preserved between them leading to the throne, which<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_109" id="Page_109">[109]</a></span> was at the upper
+end of the chamber. The throne was a frame of painted wood, gilt and
+carved, and bearing a very suspicious resemblance to a Chinese bedstead.
+On this, sitting cross-legged, was the sultan of Borneo, to whom we were
+all separately presented as English warriors, &amp;c. &amp;c. Chairs were then
+placed in a half circle in front of the sultan, and we seated ourselves.
+The sultan, a man of about sixty years of age, is said to be very
+imbecile, and under the control of his ministers, who do with him as
+they please. He was dressed in a loose jacket and trousers of purple
+satin, richly embroidered with gold, a close-fitting vest of gold cloth,
+and a light cloth turban on his head. In his sash he wore a gold-headed
+kris of exquisite workmanship. His head was bald, and his features wore
+a continual air of suspicion, mixed with simplicity. The first is not to
+be wondered at, as he lives in the happy expectation of being poisoned
+every day. He has two thumbs on the right hand, and makes the
+supernumerary one useful by employing it in charging his mouth with the
+beetle-nut and chunan, in which luxury he indulges to excess.
+Immediately below him were his two body attendants, who have charge of
+his beetle-nut box and his weapons. In front of the throne, and inside
+the half aisle formed by the Europeans, Seraib Yussef, the prime
+minister, Muda Hassan, and Bud-ruddeen, were seated on their hams. On
+each side and below the throne were hundreds of attendants or guards;
+those in the front row sitting cross-legged, with drawn krisses; those
+behind them standing with long spears, tipped with bunches of red
+horsehair, in their hands. The remainder of the chamber was occupied by
+chiefs, all of them armed.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="court" id="court"></a>
+<img src="images/109.jpg" width="600" height="405" alt="Court of the Sultan of Bruni" />
+<div class="cap-horiz">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">COURT OF THE SULTAN OF BRUNI.<br />
+<small>(SIGNING THE TREATY WITH ENGLAND.)</small></p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>The communications and demands we had to make were carried on through
+Mr. Williamson, the interpreter. The speakers were Mr. Brooke, our
+captain, the sultan's prime minister, Muda and Bud-ruddeen, the sultan
+occasionally nodding his head in approval of replies<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_110" id="Page_110">[110]</a></span> made by his prime
+minister. The whole of the conversation was carried on in so low a tone
+as not to be heard except by those sitting nearest to the throne. The
+subject of it was, however, no secret; and it was as follows:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>Near to the mouth of the river, is an island called Pulo Cheremon, on
+which the sultan has built some forts. On our entering the river, one of
+our boats had been fired at from one of these forts, although the
+English flag was hoisted at the time. The demands made in this
+conference were, that the proper respect should be paid to the English
+flag, that the forts upon Pulo Cheremon should be dismantled, and that
+the sultan should reinstate Muda and Bud-ruddeen in offices becoming
+their rank. Now, that the first demand was reasonable must be admitted;
+but what right we had to insist upon the forts being destroyed, and the
+sultan's uncles put into office, I really cannot pretend to say.</p>
+
+<p>Seraib Yussef, who was inimical to the English, expressed his
+disapprobation of their demands in very strong terms: as for the sultan,
+he had very little to say. As it appeared that there was no chance of
+our demands being complied with without coercion, the conference was
+broken up by our principals pointing to the steamer, which lay within
+pistol-shot of the palace, and reminding the sultan and the ministers
+that a few broadsides would destroy the town. Having made this
+observation, we all rose to take our departure, stating that we would
+wait for an answer to our demands upon the following day. Our situation
+was rather critical, only eight Europeans among hundreds of armed
+natives taking their sultan in this manner by the beard, when, at a
+signal from him, we might have all been despatched in a moment. More
+than one chief had his hand upon his kris as we stalked through a
+passage left for us out of the audience chamber; but whatever may have
+been their wishes, they did not venture further<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_111" id="Page_111">[111]</a></span> without authority. On
+reaching the platform outside, a very strange sight presented itself.
+With the exception of a lane left for our passage to the boat, the whole
+space was covered with naked savages. These were the Maruts, a tribe of
+Dyaks who live in the mountains. The word marut signifies brave. These
+naked gentlemen, who are very partial to the sultan, had come down from
+the mountains to render assistance in case of hostility on our part.
+They were splendidly framed men, but very plain in person, with the long
+matted hair falling over their shoulders. They were armed with long
+knives and shields, which they brandished in a very warlike manner,
+occasionally giving a loud yell. They certainly appeared very anxious to
+begin work; and I fully expected we should have had to draw and defend
+ourselves. I was not sorry, therefore, when I found myself once more in
+the stern sheets of the barge, with our brass six-pounder loaded with
+grape, pointed towards them. The poor fellows little knew the effect of
+a shower of grape-shot, or they would not have been so anxious for a
+"turn-up."</p>
+
+<p>The sultan had offered a house for the accommodation of the Europeans
+during our stay at Bruni. It was a small wooden building over the water
+and resting upon piles. It communicated by a platform with the Mahomedan
+mosque, which was built of brick and of tolerable dimensions. The
+interior of this mosque had no other furniture in it except a sort of
+pulpit painted, which stood in the centre. Outside on a raised platform
+was a very large tom-tom or drum, upon which a native played from
+morning to night, much to our annoyance, as it was so close to us.
+Religious worship appears at a very low ebb at Bruni, for during the
+whole time that we remained there I did not see one person enter the
+mosque.</p>
+
+<p>At the back of the mosque there was a piece of green sward, which
+separated us from the royal buildings. Passing through the mosque<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_112" id="Page_112">[112]</a></span> we
+strolled over this piece of pasture, when, close to the water's edge, we
+discovered several fine old brass 32-pounders, dismounted and
+half-buried in the swamp. On inspection we found them to be Spanish,
+bearing the inscription of Carolus Tertius, Rex Hispaniorum, with the
+arms of Castile above. How they came into the sultan's possession we
+could not find out. He was said to value them exceedingly; if so, he did
+not show it by the neglect paid to them.</p>
+
+<p>Bruni on a calm day presents a novel and pretty appearance. The masses
+of houses appear to float on the water, and the uniformity is broken by
+gay flags and banners, which indicate the rank and the office of them
+who hoist them. The large square sails of the prahus, the variety of
+boats and canoes, the floating bazaar, and the numerous costumes
+continually in moving panorama before you, all combine to form a very
+admirable picture. Add to this the chiming and beating of gongs and
+tom-toms in every cadence, and from every quarter, and you are somewhat
+reminded of an Asiatic Bartholomew fair.</p>
+
+<p>The right-hand side of the river, which is opposite to the town,
+consists of a series of small hills, which are partially cleared, but
+present little appearance of cultivation. Here we were shown a specimen
+of the upas tree: it was growing close to a small stone fountain in the
+vicinity of some straggling huts. It was a solitary tree, tall and
+red-stemmed, with the foliage branching out in a canopy at the top.</p>
+
+<p>So much has been said for and against this tree, usually supposed to be
+fabulous, that we looked upon it with great curiosity; and although
+aware that its noxious qualities have been much exaggerated, we were
+anxious to test its powers, if we could. We procured a ladder, which we
+raised against the tree, and one of our party ascended to the uppermost
+branches without experiencing the fainting sensation ascribed to be
+produced by close contact with its foliage. We then tapped the tree at
+the bottom, and there issued from it a<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_113" id="Page_113">[113]</a></span> white viscous fluid, which the
+natives asserted to be a virulent poison, and used by them for dipping
+the points of their arrows. We carried off a bottle of this poison, and
+having drunk from the fountain beneath the tree, without fear and
+without injury, we went away. This was the only specimen of the upas
+tree that I saw in Borneo. The lower orders at Bruni, in addition to a
+jacket and trousers, wear an immense straw hat of a conical shape, with
+a brim as wide as an umbrella. This hat, unless thrown back on the
+shoulders, entirely conceals the face. At times, when the river is
+crowded with canoes, nothing is to be seen but a mass of these straw
+hats, which present a very strange appearance. But the greatest novelty
+at Bruni is the floating bazaar. There are no shops in the city, and the
+market is held every day in canoes. These come in at sunrise every
+morning from every part of the river, laden with fresh fruit, tobacco,
+pepper, and every other article which is produced in the vicinity; a few
+European productions, such as handkerchiefs, check-cotton prints, &amp;c.,
+also make their appearance. Congregated in the main street the canoes
+are tacked together, forming lanes through which the purchasers, in
+their own canoes, paddle, selecting and bargaining for their goods with
+as much convenience as if the whole was transacted on terra firma. Iron
+is here so valuable that it is used as money. One hundred flat pieces an
+inch square are valued at a dollar, and among the lower classes these
+iron pieces form the sole coin. They are unstamped, so that every person
+appears to be at liberty to cut his own iron into money; but whether
+such is really the case I cannot vouch.</p>
+
+<p>We remained at Bruni for a week, during which time a great deal of
+diplomatic duty was got through by the seniors of the party, leaving the
+juniors to amuse themselves with discovering fresh objects of interest,
+and illustrating every thing worthy of notice.</p>
+
+<p>Our whole party met every evening at the small house which had<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_114" id="Page_114">[114]</a></span> been
+appropriated for our use by the sultan. It staggered fearfully upon its
+wooden legs under our accumulated weight, and we constantly expected
+that we should be let down into the water. Here we dined and passed the
+evening in conversation, with our arms all ready at hand, guns and
+pistols loaded, and the boats anchored close along side of us, in case
+of any treachery. Every day an interview was had with the sultan, but no
+definite answer had been obtained to our demands. On the 6th, however,
+it was resolved by our diplomatists that no more time should be wasted
+in useless discussion, but that the sultan must be at once brought to
+terms; indeed, our own safety demanded it, for the popular feeling was
+so much excited, and the people were so indignant at our attempt to
+coerce their sultan, that we were in hourly expectation of an attack.</p>
+
+<p>At seven in the evening the party repaired to the audience chamber,
+leaving their arms behind them, for they felt that any effort from five
+Europeans to defend themselves against so many hundreds, would be
+unavailing, and that more would be gained by a show of indifference.
+They landed at the platform, and the barge, in which were Lieutenant
+Baugh (since dead) and myself, was ordered to lie on her oars abreast of
+the audience chamber, and to keep her 6-pounder, in which there was a
+fearful dose of grape and canister, pointed at the sultan himself during
+the whole of the interview.</p>
+
+<p>It was an anxious time: the audience chamber was filled with hundreds of
+armed men, in the midst of whom were five Europeans dictating to their
+sultan. The platform outside was crowded with the wild and fearless
+Maruts: not a native in the city but was armed to the teeth, and anxious
+for the fray.</p>
+
+<p>We, on our parts, were well prepared for fearful vengeance; the barge
+was so placed that the assassination of Mr. Brooke and the Europeans
+would have been revenged on the first discharge of our<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_115" id="Page_115">[115]</a></span> gun by the
+slaughter of hundreds; and in the main street lay the steamer, with a
+spring on her cable, her half ports up, and guns loaded to the muzzle,
+awaiting, as by instruction, for the discharge of the gun from the
+barge, to follow up the work of death. The platform admitted one of the
+steamer's guns to look into the audience chamber, the muzzle was pointed
+direct at the sultan, a man held the lighted tow in his hand. Every
+European on board had his musket ready loaded, and matters assumed a
+serious appearance.</p>
+
+<p>From where I was on the barge, all appeared hushed in the audience room.
+I could see the prime minister, Muda, and Bud-ruddeen, as they rose in
+turns to speak. I could perceive by the motion of their lips that they
+were talking, but not a sound came to our ears. This state of things
+lasted about half an hour, and then there was a slight stir, and Mr.
+Brooke and his party marched towards us through the crowd of warriors.</p>
+
+<p>By dint of threats he had gained his point. The sultan had signed a
+treaty by which he bound himself to respect the British flag, to make
+over to us the island of Labuan, to destroy the forts on Pulo-Cheremon,
+to discountenance piracy, and to instal Muda and Bud-ruddeen into
+offices becoming their birth and high rank.</p>
+
+<p>I have since heard Mr. Brooke remark, that considering the natives were
+well aware that our guns were directed against them, the self-possession
+and coolness shared by every one of them were worthy of admiration. They
+never showed the slightest emotion, their speeches were free from
+gesticulation, and even their threats were conveyed in a quiet subdued
+tone; and every thing was carried on with all the calmness and
+deliberation that might be expected at a cabinet council at St. James's.</p>
+
+<p>Whilst at Bruni, we picked up several specimens of coal, and asking one
+of the chiefs if much could be procured, he showed us a few<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_116" id="Page_116">[116]</a></span> sacks.
+Ignorant of its value, he was still cunning enough to perceive how much
+interest Ave felt in the discovery, and immediately asked a most
+tremendous price for his stock. One would really have thought that we
+were bargaining for precious stones; at all events he must have had an
+intuitive idea that we considered them as "black diamonds." On the other
+hand, an old Arab at Bruni, who had supplied us with one or two live
+bullocks, when he saw the Samarang at anchor at the mouth of the river,
+had the modesty to offer our captain 400 dollars for her, less than
+100l. sterling. Sell dear and buy cheap is the way to get rich, and
+proves how fit for commerce are all the people of the archipelago.</p>
+
+<p>While we were lying at Bruni in the barge, one day, when Adams the
+assistant-surgeon and myself were sole occupants, we were surprised at
+the appearance of a handsomely dressed Malay youth, who stepped into the
+boat, greeting us, although strangers, <i>sans c&eacute;r&eacute;monie</i>. Always wishing
+to study native character, we amused him as well as we could, and on his
+departure gave him to understand that he might come whenever he pleased.
+About dark we were surprised by a canoe coming under our stern, and the
+occupant throwing into the barge several fine fowls and a large basket
+of fruit. We could not imagine to whom we were indebted for this
+civility, but suspected our Malay friend, and when he came again we
+taxed him with it, and he acknowledged it. On this visit he sat in the
+boat for some time, appearing to take a great interest in every thing
+connected with us, and observed that we were bargaining with the natives
+in the canoes alongside of us for the various arms of the country, which
+they are content to sell provided they obtain a most exorbitant price.
+Our Malay friend went off in his canoe, and in the course of an hour
+returned with a large collection of shields, spears, krisses, and mats,
+which he begged our acceptance of. Every day did he bring us<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_117" id="Page_117">[117]</a></span> presents
+of some description or another, refusing to take any thing in return,
+except perhaps an English pocket handkerchief or something of very
+trifling value. Suddenly his visits were discontinued, and we saw no
+more of him. One day, dining at the house lent us by the sultan, Mr.
+Brooke was talking with some of our party of a young Malay chief, who,
+being mad, had attempted to kill his wife, and had in consequence been
+placed in durance, but had since been liberated. Mr. Brooke wishing to
+speak to him, sent for him, and on his appearance this madman proved to
+be our generous unknown.</p>
+
+<p>The day after the signing of the treaty we left Bruni, the steamer
+taking the barge in tow, and the same afternoon we joined the Samarang
+at our newly-acquired possession, the isle of Labuan. This island is
+about thirty miles in circumference, flat, and covered with thick
+jungle. It has no inhabitants. Its anchorage is good, being protected by
+the main and two smaller islands. The embouchure of a rivulet forms a
+small bay, which we dignified with the title of Victoria. We found water
+plentiful, and several specimens of coal.</p>
+
+<p>From Labuan we proceeded to Ambong, a place where it was supposed that
+an European female had been detained as a slave. Ambong is a pretty
+little bay, with a Malay village built in the bight of it, and there is
+a fine view of Keeney Balloo, the great mountain of Borneo, in the
+back-ground. This mountain, estimated to be 14,000 feet high, is about
+forty miles from Ambong, and with the aid of a glass we could discern
+cataracts and ravines innumerable. It is certainly a most splendid
+affair, on one side rising almost perpendicularly, and in appearance
+nearly flat at the top. At sunset, from the bay, its appearance was
+splendid. We found nothing at Ambong to lead us to suppose that European
+females had at any time been made prisoners by the inhabitants: they
+were apparently a quiet, peaceable people, living entirely by
+agriculture. Their close neighbours,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_118" id="Page_118">[118]</a></span> however, the Moros of Tampassook,
+are a notorious tribe of the Illanoan pirates, who are the terror of the
+Asiatic seas. It was not improbable that these people might have many
+European prisoners as their slaves, but from what we knew of their
+character, we felt assured that if they possessed white female
+prisoners, they would never consent to their being ransomed.</p>
+
+<p>After making a survey of Ambong, we only waited to take in a supply of
+fresh beef, and then started the Phlegethon on her return to Sarawak
+with Mr. Brooke and Mr. Williamson, while we shaped our course in an
+opposite direction on our way to Manilla.</p>
+
+<p>I may here remark that the bullocks at Ambong were remarkably fine and
+the price of them ridiculously cheap. Two of the largest were to be
+purchased for about twenty-five shillings worth of calico or any other
+European manufacture. Wherever we went on this island, and I may say
+over the Indian archipelago generally, the spirit of trade and barter
+appeared to be universal; and if the inhabitants of Borneo were inclined
+to look into the riches of their island, and with them procure English
+manufactures, which when piracy is abolished they will do, the
+commercial opening to this country will be great indeed. The scenery in
+the bay of Ambong varies from that of the Borneo coast in general. The
+bay is backed by a series of small hills, cleared away and partially
+cultivated, instead of the low jungle which is elsewhere so universal.</p>
+
+<p>On our way to Manilla we touched at the entrance of a river up which is
+situated the town of Tampassook. Bodies of armed men came down in haste
+to oppose our landing, which we did with a view of taking sights to
+verify the chronometers. We came to a parley before we came to blows,
+and the captain drew a line close to the beach, telling the Illanoans
+that his men would remain inside of it, on condition that they would
+remain outside. This arrangement was<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_119" id="Page_119">[119]</a></span> agreed to, and the observations
+were taken between four or five hundred armed warriors on one side, and
+four boats with the guns ready to fire on the other.</p>
+
+<p>The pirates were all very well dressed in stuffs and cloths: they
+carried shields so large as to cover the whole body, and long heavy
+swords with the handles ornamented with balls and human hair. Many were
+on horseback, and formed a very respectable irregular cavalry, wearing a
+light loose dress, and armed with long spears and short round shields.
+One costume was quite novel, being a coat of armour made of buffalo
+leather scaled with oyster shells. Both parties adhered to the
+agreement, and all therefore passed off quietly; the observations were
+completed, and we returned to the ship.</p>
+
+<p>Tampassook, it is asserted, would be a grand place for booty if it was
+stormed, as the inhabitants possess a great deal of money and diamonds.
+They are, however, a very brave people, and would not part with their
+riches without a terrible resistance.</p>
+
+<p>While off this river we had notice given us that there was a fleet of
+100 piratical prahus lying off the island of Balabac. We shaped our
+course thither, hoping to surprise them, but we were disappointed: the
+birds had flown, and the bay of Balabac was untenanted. We cruised for a
+week among the islands in search of them, but could not discover their
+retreat; so we shaped our course for Manilla, taking the passage to the
+eastward of Palawan, which was considered the best at this season of the
+year.</p>
+
+<p>While off the north-east coast of Palawan, our boats left to survey
+discovered an Illanoan prahu at anchor off one of the small islands that
+surround the coast. The boats gave chase, and the pirates used every
+exertion to get away. The gig soon headed the other boats, but gained
+very slowly on the pirate, and her muskets caused no apparent execution,
+but one of the cutters with the grape from her<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_120" id="Page_120">[120]</a></span> gun killed several of
+their fighting men, who stood on the roof brandishing their krisses, and
+fearlessly exposing themselves to the fire. On turning a point the prahu
+kept before the wind, and walked away from us so fast that we gave up
+the chase.</p>
+
+<p>In about a fortnight afterwards, the Corregidor, a small island at the
+mouth of Manilla Bay, hove in sight. On our arriving abreast of it, a
+gun-boat came out to board us, and inquire after our bill of health; but
+as we had a spanking breeze, and men-of-war do not heave-to to be
+boarded, the gun-boat returned to the island as wise as she came out.
+Manilla Bay is of immense size, being thirty miles deep, and twenty
+wide. Near the mouth of the Bay the land is high, but at the head, where
+the city of Manilla is built, it is remarkably low and flat. As we had
+the wind in our teeth, and Manilla was twenty-five miles distant, we did
+not arrive there till sunset. After shaving the sterns of several
+merchant ships, who would have been better pleased if we had given them
+a wider berth, we at last dropped anchor about two miles from the town.</p>
+
+<p>Manilla, from the anchorage, has not an inviting appearance. I have said
+that the land upon which it is built is very low, and as the town is
+strongly fortified, nothing is to be seen from the shipping but a long
+line of sea wall, with the roofs of the largest buildings, and a mass of
+brick, which we were told was the cathedral, overtopping it. At one end
+of this sea wall is the canal, or river, flanked on one side by a mole,
+and on the other by a light-house.</p>
+
+<p>Manilla is, however, a very delightful place; and to us, who had been so
+many months among savages, it appeared a Paradise. The canal I have
+alluded to divides the fortified city from the suburban towns of San
+Fernando, San Gabriel, and others, in which are situated all the
+commercial houses, stores, godowns, dock-yards, and saw mills. All the
+Chinese and lower orders also reside in these suburbs,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_121" id="Page_121">[121]</a></span> and I may add
+that all the amusements, feasts, &amp;c., are carried on in this quarter.
+The city of Manilla within the fortifications is a very quiet, clean,
+and well-regulated town, inhabited entirely by the higher orders: the
+streets are well laid out, the houses regular, and built of white
+freestone. In the centre of the city is the Plaza, on one side of which
+is the cathedral, and opposite it the governor's palace; both very
+insignificant buildings. The cathedral, which is very ancient, is devoid
+of all attempt at architecture, and resembles a huge barn; while the
+governor's palace, in appearance, reminds you of a stable.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="manilla" id="manilla"></a>
+<img src="images/121.jpg" width="500" height="477" alt="City of Manilla" />
+<p class="caption">CITY OF MANILLA.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_122" id="Page_122">[122]</a></span>During the day the streets of Manilla are perfectly quiet and deserted.
+At dusk the people begin to move, and show signs of life. The sallyport
+gates are closed at eleven o'clock at night, after which hour there is
+neither ingress or egress, and on this point they are most absurdly
+particular.</p>
+
+<p>The natives of Luzon are much below the middle size. The men are
+slightly made, weak, and inoffensive; the women, on the contrary, are
+remarkable for their pretty faces, feet, and figures, set off by a dress
+of the most picturesque description: a short petticoat, of
+gaily-coloured silk or cotton, and a boddice of similar material, of
+sufficient height to cover the bosom, is their usual costume. Their long
+jet black hair is allowed to fall in tresses down their backs. Many have
+a kerchief tastefully thrown over their heads; and they wear little
+velvet slippers, embroidered with gold and silver thread. Their
+appearance is extremely captivating to foreigners, who do not in a hurry
+forget their graceful mien and the arch glances from their brilliant
+eyes. Manilla supports a considerable body of infantry and cavalry, the
+whole composed of natives of the island. Their horses are small, as well
+as the men, and are not well trained; but the object of the Spaniards is
+to make a show to intimidate the Indians, who, having no discipline
+whatever, are, of course, inferior even to these very moderate troops.
+Not long ago, one of the strongest forts was taken possession of by a
+party of rebels, assisted by some soldiers who had revolted: the fort
+was recaptured, and, as an example, a dreadful slaughter ensued. The
+parade ground, outside the citadel, was the scene of carnage. A large
+pit was dug, at the brink of which the victims were placed; they were
+then shot, and thrown into this grave. Eighty-two were thus butchered,
+and buried in the pit, over which a mound has been raised, to
+commemorate their execution.</p>
+
+<p>Outside the town, and half encircling it, there is a splendid
+esplanade,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_123" id="Page_123">[123]</a></span> between an avenue of trees. This leads to the water, when
+the road runs parallel with it for nearly a mile, terminating at one of
+the piers of the canal. This is known by the, I presume, correct name of
+Scandal Point. A number of carriages, filled with all the <i>&eacute;lite</i> of
+Manilla, turn out on this drive a little before sunset, and the scene is
+very gay and exciting. I leave the reader to conceive upwards of 200
+carriages passing and repassing, besides equestrians and pedestrians.
+The reader may say that it must be like the ring at Hyde Park; but it is
+more brilliant, although not in such good taste; and then it is the
+beauty of the climate&mdash;the contrast between the foliage and the blue
+ocean&mdash;which gives the effect. No buttoning up to an east wind, nor
+running away from a shower; but ever gay, and fresh, and exhilarating.
+Here you meet the old Don, enjoying his quiet stroll and cigar, all
+alone. Soldier officers, in plain dress and long mustachoes, doffing
+their hats to every se&ntilde;ora. The English merchant, in his unassuming
+undress of a white jacket; the British naval officers, with their gay
+uniforms and careless manners, prying, with a sailor's curiosity, into
+every pretty face; and now and then a saucy mid, mounted on a hack,
+dashing between the line of carriages at a full gallop, disturbing their
+propriety, and checking the cavalcade, to the great consternation, real
+or assumed, of the ladies. All was gaiety and gladness; on every side
+was to be heard the merry laugh and hail of recognition. To add to the
+excitement, the bands of the several regiments played the most popular
+airs on a parade adjoining to the esplanade.</p>
+
+<p>While the carriages were driving up and down, the vesper bell tolled
+from the cathedral. In an instant every carriage stopped&mdash;every head was
+uncovered, and bent in an attitude of devotion. Horses, women, men&mdash;all
+as if transfixed: every tongue silent&mdash;nothing heard but the bell of the
+cathedral, and the light breeze<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_124" id="Page_124">[124]</a></span> which bore away its vibrations. The
+bell at last ceased, and in a moment every thing was in full activity as
+before.</p>
+
+<p>Twice a week a military band plays at the public almeda from nine till
+ten in the evening; and on one of these nights we started in a carriage
+to the spot. The almeda is situated close to the gates of the city, and
+joins to the esplanade. It is an open square, bordered with a row of
+trees, to which are suspended lamps; while in the spaces between the
+trees there are seats for the accommodation of the public. In the middle
+of the almeda is a stand erected for the musicians. On our arrival there
+we found it well lighted up; the place was surrounded by carriages,
+which were empty, their occupants having joined the parade. Following
+the example, we mixed with the throng, which was numerous. The women
+were mostly collected in groups, and the men were smoking their cheroots
+and beating time to the music, which was excellent. Lighting our cigars,
+we strolled lazily along, and, by dint of lamp-light and impudence,
+managed to form a very tolerable idea of the beauty of the senoras. At
+ten o'clock, the band struck up a lively polka, which was the signal for
+a general dispersion. This is considered one of the principal and most
+favourite recreations at Manilla.</p>
+
+<p>The inhabitants of Manilla are composed of the pure Spaniard, and the
+Mustichas, or mixed breed. The former are very proud and inhospitable;
+the latter are, on the contrary, very friendly, and, for any little
+civility, request that you will make their house your home. The women of
+the latter are by far the most preferable: the former are said to be
+very deficient in good-breeding and education; like the Indians, they
+sleep half the day, and are scarcely alive till sun-down, when they
+dress for the almeda or esplanade.</p>
+
+<p>There are very good subscription rooms in the city. Every month they
+give a ball, concert, or amateur performance. Strangers are<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_125" id="Page_125">[125]</a></span> presented
+with tickets for these amusements&mdash;no thanks to the Spaniards&mdash;but from
+the kindness of the English merchants, who are nearly all members. I
+went to one of these balls: there were plenty of women&mdash;more than could
+get partners; the music was good, the women well dressed, and they
+waltzed exquisitely. Adjoining the ball-room was a billiard-room, in
+which those who preferred smoking cigars in a cool room to dancing, with
+the thermometer at 90&deg;, had retreated. Nothing can be done at Manilla
+without the cigar: they smoke for an appetite, they smoke for digestion,
+they smoke when they are too hot, they smoke when it is chilly. As the
+hands of the time-piece approached the hour of eleven, every one who
+lived outside the city was obliged to be off. We, among others, took our
+departure; but when we sought for our carriage, it had disappeared. We
+set off at a hard trot, to reach the gates before eleven, but in our
+haste we missed the road, and came to a cul-de-sac. We retraced our
+steps, but when we reached the gates they were closed. A request to the
+officer of the guard we knew to be useless, so we turned back, and
+prepared to pass the night in the streets, in our uniforms and swords.
+After wandering half an hour up and down without seeing a light or
+meeting a soul, I heard a violent hammering at a door at a little
+distance. I found it was one of our party, who hammered away, and called
+out for "Soda water" between each hammering. "All's right!" said he;
+"look here!" And sure enough there was a board outside, with "Soda
+Water" painted in large letters in English. This repeated hammering and
+demand for soda water at last produced the desired effect. A person in a
+dressing-gown and slippers came out into the balcony, and demanded our
+business. We explained our extreme thirst and benighted condition; and
+as the gentleman hesitated, we again applied to the door, intimating
+that if we had no admission, at all events he should have no repose. At
+last<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_126" id="Page_126">[126]</a></span> he sent down to have the door opened. We found that he was a
+German chemist, who fabricated soda water, among other articles, and,
+knowing the partiality of the English for the beverage, had advertised
+it in our language over the door. We passed the night with him very
+comfortably at his house, breakfasted with him the next morning, and,
+promising to bring the whole of our shipmates to drink soda water for
+his benefit till we were blown out like balloons, we wished him
+good-bye, and returned to the ship.</p>
+
+<p>Gambling is carried to a great extent in Manilla: the game played is
+Mont&eacute;. We visited one of their gambling houses. Winding our way down a
+dark and narrow street, we arrived at a porte-coch&egrave;re. The requisite
+signal was given, the door opened cautiously, and after some scrutiny we
+were ushered up a flight of stairs, and entered a room, in the centre of
+which was a table, round which were a group, composed of every class. An
+Indian squaw was sitting by the side of a military officer, the one
+staking her annas, the other his doubloons. I stood by the side of an
+old Chinaman, who staked his doubloon and lost every time. The strictest
+silence was observed, and nothing was heard but the chinking of the
+dollars, and the occasional <i>&agrave; quien</i> of the banker, who inquired the
+owner of the stakes. Every thing was conducted with the greatest order;
+when one man had lost all his money he would retire, and make room for
+another. The authorities of Manilla have made every effort to put a
+check to this demoralising practice, but without much success. It is
+universal, from the highest to the lowest, from the civilised to the
+most barbarous, over the whole of the Indian Archipelago.</p>
+
+<p>The Indians of the Phillippines are among the best favoured of the
+Asiatic islanders, but they are not reckoned so brave as the Malays.
+They are a quiet inoffensive race, clean and well shaped, and are all
+converted to the Catholic faith. Their principal amusement is<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_127" id="Page_127">[127]</a></span>
+cock-fighting, which, indeed, is carried to a great extent in all the
+islands. Every man in the streets has his fighting cock under his arm,
+and groups may be seen at all hours of the day, pitting their cocks and
+betting on the issue. The country about Manilla is very pretty, well
+cultivated, and studded with thriving villages. The Spanish possessions
+in this part of Luzon are confined to about twenty miles in every
+direction; the interior of the island being peopled with a race of
+savages who occasionally make incursions into the country, carrying away
+cattle or any thing else that they can lay their hands upon. I could
+obtain no particulars of these aborigines, except that they go nearly if
+not altogether naked.</p>
+
+<p>On the 1st of December, our old acquaintance, the Velocipede schooner,
+arrived from Sooloo, having on board six Lascars, who had been ransomed
+from the sultan of Sooloo by Mr. Wyndham. They had formed a portion of
+the crew of the Premier, an English merchant vessel, which had been
+wrecked on a reef off the eastern coast of Borneo. The crew, consisting
+of Europeans and Lascars, had been divided between the sultans of
+Sooloo, Gonong Tabor, and Balungan. One of the Lascars was the bearer of
+a letter from the captain of the Premier, stating that he and his crew
+were still captives, and trusting that a vessel would be sent to rescue
+them, as they were strictly guarded by the natives, and had no hopes of
+escape. The Samarang being the only man-of-war at Manilla, the English
+consul requested our captain to proceed again to Borneo to obtain these
+people, calling at Sooloo in order to obtain information and a pilot.</p>
+
+<p>On the 10th of December we sailed for Sooloo, where we arrived on the
+15th. We found the natives preparing for an attack, which they
+anticipated from the French, and suspicious that our intentions were
+also hostile. Having already described Sooloo, I shall confine myself to
+events. The captain, with his officers, went on shore, and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_128" id="Page_128">[128]</a></span> had an
+audience with the sultan; and having brought an interpreter with us from
+Manilla, the conversation was carried on without difficulty.
+Refreshments, as lemonade, &amp;c. were handed round as before, and, as
+before, the room of audience was crowded to suffocation.</p>
+
+<p>The prime minister, who was a little corpulent man with an aquiline
+nose, wore such an expression of low cunning, and eyed us with such
+ill-concealed hatred, that we christened him Daniel Quilp, and he was
+ever afterwards spoken of by that soubriquet. Our object being made
+known, and the sultan's assistance demanded to obtain the remainder of
+the prisoners, every obstacle that Quilp could throw in our way was
+resorted to; and thus the audience became very tiresome, and I paid
+little or no attention to what was said, amusing myself by using my
+eyes, instead of tormenting my ears. A heavy red curtain was hung up,
+dividing the room into two compartments. Observing that this moved once
+or twice, I endeavoured to find out the cause, when several pairs of
+black eyes, half hidden in the folds and rents, explained the mystery;
+and whilst they were loudly disputing, I was winking and making faces at
+the sultan's wives, who, stimulated by curiosity to behold the white
+men, were thus transgressing the rules of the harem. But old Quilp
+looked very hard at me, and for the ladies' sakes I was obliged to
+desist.</p>
+
+<p>Behind the sultan stood a young man very handsomely dressed in crimson
+silk, who held in his hands an English finger-glass. We were very much
+at a loss to know what his office might be, and also what might be the
+office of the finger-glass; but our curiosity was soon gratified; the
+sultan beckoned the youth to approach, and as the latter presented the
+finger-glass, his highness blew his nose in it.</p>
+
+<p>Indeed, the misappropriation of English utensils in this part of the
+world is very absurd, although it is not surprising that an article
+coming into their hands, the use of which they have no idea of, should<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_129" id="Page_129">[129]</a></span>
+be appropriated to that use which they consider it best adapted to. On
+the occasion of a dinner given to us by the sultan of Bruni, the whole
+party were seized with a fit of very indecorous and immoderate laughter,
+by finding the centre dish, which was a curry, served up in a capacious
+vessel, which in Europe is only to be found under a bed. The curry,
+nevertheless, was excellent; and what matter did it make? "What's in a
+name? A rose by any other name would smell as sweet."&mdash;But to return.</p>
+
+<p>We remained eight days at Sooloo, during which time there was much
+altercation and excitement. At last the sultan of Sooloo agreed to send
+a prahu with us to pilot us up the river, to the town where the crew of
+the Premier were in durance.</p>
+
+<p>During the time that we were at Sooloo, we had evidence sufficient of
+the vindictive feeling held by the rabble against Europeans, and at the
+same time the various ways they resorted to, to give us an idea of their
+superiority. They drew our attention to some old cannon mounted on
+rotten gun-carriages; they pointed out the strength of their fort, the
+sharpness of their krisses and spears; and we could not but smile at the
+false estimate of their and our capabilities. They expressed curiosity
+to see our swords, which are always made of finely tempered steel,
+although not sharp edged, as they are required more for thrusting and
+parrying. Of our mode of self-defence they are ignorant, as they
+invariably cut with their krisses; their first attention was, therefore,
+drawn to the edge of the sword; passing the thumb along it, and finding
+it blunt, they expressed the greatest contempt for the weapon. It was
+useless to show them the thrust and parry movements, or to prove the
+well-tempered steel by bending the blade till the hilt and point were
+almost meeting. A sharp iron hoop in their ideas was preferable to all
+the best English workmanship. The Sooloo knives are larger than they
+usually are in the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_130" id="Page_130">[130]</a></span> Archipelago, and of superior manufacture. By rubbing
+them with limes and exposing them to the sun, they stain them in a
+manner quite peculiar to the place.</p>
+
+<p>Partly to the machinations of our friend Quilp and the irritable and
+proud disposition of the people, who considered that the sultan was
+humiliated by listening to reason and remonstrance, we were more than
+once very near coming to blows. At last every thing was arranged
+amicably; and just before starting, the prime minister, Quilp, and a
+large party of chiefs, condescended to pay a visit to the ship.</p>
+
+<p>To guard against treachery, for Quilp was equal to any thing, the
+marines were kept under arms, and supplied with ball cartridges. The
+ship was soon crowded with chiefs, armed to the teeth, and accompanied
+by men with muskets, spears, and shields. It certainly did not look like
+a very amicable visit on their part, or a very friendly reception on
+ours; but the ship wore a very gay appearance. The guns, nettings, and
+booms were covered with the chiefs and attendants dressed in very gay
+colours. Groups of them sat down on the decks, and made their remarks
+upon what they beheld; while numbers prowled about up and down,
+examining, peeping, and wondering. We amused them with firing congreve
+rockets, guns, &amp;c., which gave them some idea of our value, and we
+therefore combined instruction with amusement. They departed highly
+pleased and astonished, and it was evident that we were some degrees
+higher in the estimation of Quilp himself.</p>
+
+<p>The prahu ordered to pilot us having come alongside, we hoisted her up
+abaft, and took the people on board, and then made sail for the hitherto
+unknown territory of Panti river. We anchored off the main land on the
+25th December, that we might discover the mouth of the river, which was
+unknown to us. Our Christmas-day was not a very happy one; we did
+nothing but drink to the hopes of a better<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_131" id="Page_131">[131]</a></span> one the ensuing year. On the
+following day we weighed, and moved some distance up the river, and then
+anchored, waiting the return of the prahu, which had been despatched up
+to the town the night before. We had, by the means of warping and
+towing, gained about fifteen miles up the river, when we found that it
+divided into two branches, and, not knowing which branch to take, we had
+anchored, waiting the return of the prahu. As she, however, did not make
+her appearance, although she had had quite sufficient time allowed her,
+the boats were therefore manned and armed, and we started in search of
+the town Gonong Tabor. As bad luck would have it, we chose the left
+branch of the river, and, after two days' unsuccessful search, came back
+just as we went, but not quite so fresh as when we started. The prahu
+had not yet returned, so, taking a new departure, we proceeded up the
+right branch. This proved a fine broad river; one portion of it, studded
+with small islands, was very picturesque. We soon hove in sight of what
+appeared to be a town, although there were no signs of life visible. It
+was built on the left side of the river on two small hills, but we heard
+no gongs or tomtoms sounding, the usual alarm of all the Malay
+settlements on the approach of strangers. When we arrived off it, we
+found that the town was deserted. It had evidently but a short time back
+been a populous and flourishing place, but it had been destroyed by the
+enemy, as, although the houses were standing, the cocoa-nut and other
+trees had been all cut down. On the brow of the hill were many graves;
+one, which was stockaded and thatched, and the remnants of several flags
+fluttering in the wind, denoted the resting-place of a rajah. He little
+thought when he was alive that his head would be transported to a head
+house some 20,000 miles distant, but such was his fate: science required
+it, and he was packed up to add to the craniological specimens in the
+College of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_132" id="Page_132">[132]</a></span> Surgeons, the gentlemen presiding over which are as fond of
+heads as the Dyaks themselves.</p>
+
+<p>We moved up the river till nightfall, and then anchored. We were
+satisfied from appearances that we were not far from a town, and,
+loading our arms, we kept a very strict look-out.</p>
+
+<p>At daylight the next morning we weighed anchor, and, having passed two
+reaches of the river, we came in sight of the towns of Gonong Tabor and
+Gonong Satang. We pulled towards them, with a flag of truce, and were
+immediately boarded by a canoe, which contained the prime minister, who
+made every profession of good-will on the part of his master, the sultan
+of Gonong Tabor. We observed with surprise that he hoisted a Dutch flag,
+which he requested that we would salute. The captain replied, that they
+must first salute the English flag, and, if they did so, he promised to
+return the salute. This was complied with; the English flag was saluted
+with twenty-one guns, and an equal number returned. The boats were then
+anchored off the town.</p>
+
+<p>Immediately after we had returned the salute, we heard an attempt at
+music, and this was soon explained by the appearance of a procession
+filing through the gates of the town towards the boats. It was headed by
+a Malay, bearing the standard of Gonong Tabor,&mdash;red, with a white
+border; he was followed by another carrying a large canopy of silk,
+highly ornamented, and fringed with lace. After this personage came the
+prime minister; then two musicians, one playing the drum, and the other
+a flageolet of rude construction. These musicians were dressed in red
+bordered with yellow, with cowls over their heads. The rear was composed
+of a body-guard of Malays, well armed. The whole advanced towards the
+landing-place, having been sent by the sultan to escort the captain to
+the palace. The captain and officers landed, and, escorted by the
+natives, proceeded to the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_133" id="Page_133">[133]</a></span> palace, the red silk canopy being carried
+over the head of the captain as a mark of honour. The sultan, a
+corpulent but fine-looking man, received us very courteously. He
+informed the captain that all the white people belonging to the Premier
+had been ransomed by the Dutch, whose trading vessels were in the habit
+of visiting Gonong Tabor. The captain of the Premier had refused to
+acknowledge the Lascars as British subjects, and, in consequence, the
+poor fellows had been retained as slaves. They were not, however, at
+Gonong Tabor, but at Baloongan, a town of some importance up a
+neighbouring river. He added, that four of the Lascars had fallen
+victims to the climate, and that there were twelve still remaining at
+the above-mentioned town.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_134" id="Page_134">[134]</a></span> It appeared that, from some misunderstanding
+between the sultans of Gonong Tabor and Gonong Satang relative to the
+disposal of the English prisoners, they had come to blows, and were at
+this time at open warfare, the two towns being within gunshot of each
+other. Gonong Satang was built on a hill on the opposite side of the
+river, and was strongly stockaded as well as Gonong Tabor.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="procession" id="procession"></a>
+<img src="images/133.jpg" width="550" height="438" alt="Procession of The Sultan of Gonong Tabor" />
+<p class="caption">PROCESSION OF THE SULTAN OF GONONG TABOR.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>The sultan expressed his desire to enter into an amicable treaty with
+the English, and offered our captain his assistance in procuring the
+release of the Lascars at Baloongan. This offer was accepted, and, when
+we left, a prahu accompanied us to that town.</p>
+
+<p>In the course of the evening the sultan's prime minister and suite
+visited the barge, which was moored within a few yards of the
+landing-place. We surprised them very much with our quick firing, but
+their astonishment was unbounded at the firing of a congreve rocket,
+which they perceived carried destruction to every thing in its flight.
+The grand vizier was in ecstasies, and begged very hard that the captain
+would go up to Gonong Satang, and just fire one or two at their
+adversaries in that town. This, of course, was refused.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="ears" id="ears"></a>
+<img src="images/135.jpg" width="400" height="411" alt="Ears of Dyaks at Gonong Tabor" />
+<p class="caption">EARS OF DYAKS AT GONONG TABOR.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>We here fell in with a most remarkable tribe of Dyaks: they wore immense
+rings in their ears, made of tin or copper, the weight of which
+elongated the ear to a most extraordinary extent. On their heads they
+wore a mass of feathers of the Argus pheasant. They wore on their
+shoulders skins of the leopard and wild cat, and neck-laces of beads and
+teeth. They were armed with the usual parang, blowpipe, and shield. They
+were a much larger race of men than the Dyaks of the north coast, but
+not so well favoured. We remained here five days, and on the 1st of
+January, 1845, went down the river to the ship, accompanied by the prahu
+which was to be our guide to Baloongan. The following day we sailed for
+Baloongan, and on the 3rd we anchored off the bank where the Premier was
+cast away. Her<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_135" id="Page_135">[135]</a></span> ribs and timbers were left, but the natives had carried
+away every thing of value, except a small anchor, which they had not
+ingenuity enough to recover. Leaving the ship at anchor here, we again
+manned the boats, and, accompanied by the pilot prahu, proceeded up the
+Saghai river: the next day we arrived in sight of Baloongan. Heaving to,
+to load our guns, and get our fire-arms in readiness (for we expected a
+hostile reception), we then hoisted a flag of truce and pulled up to the
+town. What first occupied our attention was a green plot in front of the
+town, on which were mounted from fifteen to twenty guns, which were
+continually pointed so as to bear upon us as we pulled up, and which
+were backed by some thousands, I should<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_136" id="Page_136">[136]</a></span> think, of Malays and savages,
+all well armed with spears and knives. This looked like business, but we
+pulled on, with the white flag still flying. A canoe came off,
+containing, as at Gonong Tabor, the prime minister. He waved with his
+hand, ordering us to anchor, and pointing to the guns, which the natives
+still continued to train after us. The captain refused to anchor, and
+pulled on; we were then almost abreast and within thirty yards of the
+battery. As we passed it within ten yards, the natives kept the muzzles
+pointed at our boats, and we expected them every moment to fire. Had
+they done so, we might have received considerable damage; but what would
+their loss have been when we had opened with round, grape, and canister,
+and congreve rockets, upon such an exposed and densely crowded
+multitude? They contented themselves, however, with yelling, which does
+not kill, and, passing the battery, we dropped our anchor close to the
+gate of the stockade by which the town was surrounded.</p>
+
+<p>In passing the battery, and refusing to anchor, the captain adopted the
+most prudent and safe course; for we had long before discovered that
+decision is absolutely necessary with these people. The least hesitation
+on our part would have fortified their courage to attack; but they are
+so much awed by our superior arms, and I may safely add the superior
+courage of our men, that they never will, however much they may
+threaten, be the first to come to blows, provided there is no
+vacillation or unsteadiness on our parts. This the captain knew, and
+acted accordingly.</p>
+
+<p>After returning their salute of twenty-one guns, the captain, with some
+of the officers and a party of small-armed men passed through a line of
+Dyaks to the hall of audience, which, as usual, was crowded to excess
+with armed Malays. The sultan, who was a stout athletic man, received us
+very cordially, but his confused manners and restless eyes showed that
+he was not at his ease. His dress consisted of a<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_137" id="Page_137">[137]</a></span> yellow satin jacket,
+over which he wore another of purple silk, worked and hemmed with lace.
+His trousers and turban were made of similar materials. Shoes and
+stockings he had none, and wearing both jackets open, his chest was
+exposed. The sultan acknowledged that the Lascars were still in his
+territory, but, as two of them were at some distance in the interior, it
+would require a few days to bring them in. He appeared very glad that
+the business was settling so easily, for he no doubt expected an inquiry
+and a demand for all the ship's stores, the major portion of which had
+found their way to Baloongan. The chain cables must have been invaluable
+to the natives, and I detected several links which had been partly
+converted into spear-heads.</p>
+
+<p>There was nothing worthy of remark in the town of Baloongan. We were
+very much interested in the Dyak tribes, who were the same as those
+described at Gonong Tabor, and in greater numbers. They were equally
+tall, and appeared to be the very perfection of savage warriors. They
+invited us several times to pay them a visit on the hills, where they
+resided. These Dyaks appeared very friendly to us, and one of them, an
+intelligent fellow, of the name of Meta, volunteered to take a letter
+overland to Mr. Brooke: his mode of travelling was by pulling up the
+Saghai river to its source in his canoe, till he came close to the
+source of the Coran, and by his account the two rivers nearly meet. He
+took the letter, binding it round his head with a piece of linen; but I
+do not know if ever it was delivered. One observation I made relative to
+these Saghai Dyaks, which was, that much as they must have been
+astonished at our arms and equipments, like the North American Indians,
+they never allowed the least sign of it to be perceived.</p>
+
+<p>At the end of a week the prisoners returned in a very miserable
+condition. They had been at work, pounding paddy and digging<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_138" id="Page_138">[138]</a></span> yams; and
+they stated that they had not sufficient allowed to eat to support
+existence, besides being beat about the legs with bamboos. Two of the
+twelve died evidently from ill treatment and exhaustion. Their gratitude
+at being delivered from their slavery was beyond bounds; and it
+certainly is not very creditable to the master of the Premier to have
+abandoned them in the way he did, when a word from him would have
+procured their liberty.</p>
+
+<p>We returned to the ship, and the next day ran down to the Premier Reef;
+the captain then went again to the Panti river, in the boats, to
+conclude the treaty with the sultan of Gonong Tabor. This was soon
+accomplished; and giving him an union jack to hoist, at which he was
+much pleased, we bade him farewell.</p>
+
+<p>We finished the survey of the Premier Shoal, as it is now named, and
+then steered for the island of Maratua, which the sultan of Gonong Tabor
+had by his treaty made over to the English, representing it as having an
+excellent harbour and good water; but on our arrival we were much
+disappointed to find an island surrounded by reefs, with only one
+intricate passage through them and sufficiently wide only for boats.
+Probably the sultan knew no better. As we were very short of water, we
+now made sail for Sooloo, and fell in with the Sooloo prahu, which had
+been sent to us as a pilot, and which we had never seen since she went
+up the river Panti before us. She had been waiting for us outside, and
+the people were very much pleased at finding us, as they feared being
+taken by the pirates of Tawee-Tawee. After having been nearly wrecked on
+a reef, and having grounded on another, we anchored off the Lugutan
+islands, and despatched the two cutters in search of water. One of them
+attacked and burnt a prahu, because she looked suspicious; the other did
+better, she discovered a stream of water, off which we anchored the same
+evening. Having completed wood and water, we sailed for<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_139" id="Page_139">[139]</a></span> Sooloo, where
+we arrived on the Sunday. We were surprised to find a French squadron
+anchored in the bay. It consisted of the Cleopatra, 50-gun frigate, Rear
+Admiral Cecile, with an ambassador on board,<!--original location of illustration 139.jpg. For html, it has to be moved to the paragraph break below -->
+the Victorieuse, 22, and the Alchimede war steamer. They were treating with the sultan of Sooloo
+for the island of Basilan, the natives of which had beat off their
+boats, with the loss of a lieutenant<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_140" id="Page_140">[140]</a></span> and four men killed and many
+wounded. The island of Basilan is subject to Sooloo, although the
+natives have refused to pay tribute for many years. The French, aware of
+this, and wishing to establish a colony in the East, offered the sultan
+20,000 dollars if he would make over the island to them; but this was
+not acceded to, the chiefs being divided on the question. The people of
+Sooloo have a great dislike to all Europeans, but particularly to the
+French. Treacherous as we and the French knew them to be, we little
+thought to have it proved in so fearful a manner. About a mile to the
+right of the town is a spring, where all the ships watered. One day some
+peculiar looking berries were found in the pool, which, on examination,
+proved to be deadly poison, the natives having thrown them in with the
+intention of poisoning us <i>en masse</i>. The water was of course started
+overboard, and intelligence sent to Admiral Cecile, who was highly
+incensed.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="pullulu" id="pullulu"></a>
+<img src="images/139.jpg" width="372" height="500" alt="Portrait of Mahomed Pullulu, Sultan of Sooloo" />
+<p class="caption">PORTRAIT OF MAHOMED PULLULU, SULTAN OF SOOLOO.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>It was singular by what means this discovery was made. One of the seamen
+of the Samarang complained of a stinging sensation in his feet from
+having wetted them in the pool. Our assistant surgeon happening to be on
+shore at the time, caused the watering to be stopped, and the pool to be
+examined. Buried in the sand, at the bottom of the pool, and secured in
+wicker baskets, were found those poisonous berries, which the natives
+had concealed there. As soon as Admiral Cecile received the information,
+all the water was thrown overboard, and the boats of the whole squadron,
+manned and armed, landed the French admiral, the ambassador, and our
+captain. They repaired to the palace of the sultan, who not only
+expressed his abhorrence of the attempt, but promised to put to death
+the parties if they could be discovered. The attempt did not, however,
+stop here. In addition to fruit, the boats at Sooloo brought off rice
+cakes, which were eagerly bought by the seamen. Some of the chiefs
+issued an<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_141" id="Page_141">[141]</a></span> order for a large number of poisoned cakes, which they
+intended for our consumption; but fortunately the order was so extensive
+that it got wind, and we were warned of what was intended by a native of
+Manilla, who had been captured by pirates and sold at Sooloo. In reward
+for this intelligence, we gave him, and others of the same place, a
+passage to Manilla, taking care, however, that they should be smuggled
+on board. Sailed for Manilla, staid there a few days, and then went to
+Batan, from thence to Hong Kong, where we arrived on the 1st of April,
+and found the Iris and Castor in the harbour.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="tankaboats" id="tankaboats"></a>
+<img src="images/141.jpg" width="600" height="404" alt="Tanka Boats&mdash;hong Kong" />
+<p class="caption">TANKA BOATS&mdash;HONG KONG.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>There never was, perhaps, so rapid a rise in any settlement made by the
+English as that of Hong Kong, considering the very short time that it
+has been in our possession. Where, two years back, there existed but a
+few huts, you now behold a well-built and improving<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_142" id="Page_142">[142]</a></span> town, with
+churches, hotels, stores, wharves, and godowns. The capacious harbour
+which, but a short time ago, was only visited by some Chinese junks or
+English opium clippers, is now swarming with men-of-war and merchant
+ships. The town extends along the base of the mountain. Every day some
+improvement takes place in this fast-growing colony, but, from the
+scarcity of building ground, house rent is very dear, and every thing
+has risen in proportion. The town which, from the irregularity of the
+ground, has but one street of importance, lies under the highest part of
+a rock, which is called Possession Peak. It is built on a kind of ledge,
+but this is so steep that the basements of the back houses can be seen
+over the roofs of those in the front, although the houses are no further
+apart than is necessary for the streets. Above the town the rock rises
+almost perpendicularly; but every spot which can be built upon is
+appropriated, and scattered buildings may be seen half way up the rock,
+only accessible by tortuous and narrow paths. The houses are built of
+white freestone; many of them are handsome erections, and on a fine day
+the town of Victoria has an imposing appearance.</p>
+
+<p>The island is now intersected by roads, in some parts necessarily
+precipitous, but equestrians can make the circuit of Hong Kong without
+any other risk but from the marauding Chinese, who, in spite of the
+police, still find means of exercising their vocation. To the left of
+the town of Victoria is a very pretty valley, but in the middle of it is
+a swamp, which renders the place so unhealthy that no one can reside
+there: some who did, died there; and there are one or two neat little
+villas on it, now untenanted and falling into ruins. Strange to say, it
+still bears the name of Happy Valley.</p>
+
+<p>The harbour is completely land locked, and has two entrances. One side
+of it is formed by Hong Kong, the other by Kow-loon, which is part of
+the mainland.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="westpoint" id="westpoint"></a>
+<img src="images/142.jpg" width="600" height="395" alt="West Point" />
+<div class="cap-horiz">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">WEST POINT.<br />
+<small>HONG KONG.</small></p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>But all this has its reverse. The unhealthiness of the climate is very
+great, and this is impressed upon the stranger while at anchor in the
+roads; for the first object that meets his eye is the Minden hospital
+ship, with her flag continually half mast high, announcing that another
+poor sailor had gone to his long home. When you land you will certainly
+meet a funeral; and watching the countenances of the passers by, their
+sallow complexions, and their debilitated frames, with the total
+unconcern with which they view the mournful processions, you may assure
+yourself that they must be of daily and hourly occurrence. And such is
+the fact.</p>
+
+<p>I was sorry to find that murders and robberies were most frequent at
+Hong Kong, although the police force has been augmented from London, and
+is under the charge of an experienced officer. While on shore, I
+observed the body of a Chinaman rise to the surface, disfigured in a
+horrible manner, and although notice was sent immediately to the
+authorities, it was allowed to remain beating against the wharf till
+late in the afternoon, when it was towed out and sunk in the middle of
+the harbour.</p>
+
+<p>I once witnessed the punishment of a Chinese robber at the market gate;
+he had been apprehended on the preceding night. His tail, which was
+false, and filled with blades of knives, needles, &amp;c., came off in the
+officer's hands. However, he was secured, and received a daily allowance
+of fifty lashes, which was continued as long as he was capable of
+bearing the punishment, and then he was sent to work on the roads.</p>
+
+<p>I left H. M. S. Samarang at this port, and joined the Iris, commanded by
+Captain Mundy, whose high character as an officer and a gentleman I well
+knew; unfortunately I was only lent to the Iris, and the consequence
+was, as will be seen, I had ultimately to return to the Samarang. I
+found that the Iris was to sail for the north<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_144" id="Page_144">[144]</a></span> coast of China, and I was
+delighted at the idea of visiting those parts, which there was little
+chance of if I had remained in the Samarang.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="fishermen" id="fishermen"></a>
+<img src="images/145.jpg" width="600" height="413" alt="Chinese Fishermen" />
+<p class="caption">CHINESE FISHERMEN.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>One object of the Iris proceeding to the coast of China was to carry
+General D'Aguilar and suite on a visit to the most interesting of the
+hostage ports. We sailed on the 6th of April, and after a week's beating
+arrived at Chapel Island, at the mouth of Amoy bay. This bay is very
+spacious, being nearly thirty miles deep. To the left of the entrance is
+a high peak, on the summit of which is built a splendid pagoda, serving
+as a landmark to vessels coming from seaward. The town of Amoy is built
+at the bottom of the bay. Close to it, and forming an inner harbour, is
+the island of Ku-lang-so, near to which we dropped our anchor.
+Ku-lang-so is a pretty island, about a mile in diameter. Up to the
+evacuation of Amoy it had been occupied by our troops; and the remains
+of a race course and a theatre prove that the gallant 18th had contrived
+to amuse themselves. At the present time it is all but deserted, the
+only European residents being Mr. Sullivan, the Vice Consul; the
+Chinese, who had been driven from it at the capture of the city, not
+having as yet returned. The houses on it are prettily disposed, and some
+rich foliage and green pasture give an English character to the scenery,
+and are very refreshing, after continually looking at the everlasting
+paddy fields, which constitute the principal features of the sea coast
+of China. It is to this circumstance that I ascribe the exaggerated
+accounts we have of the beauty of the island of Ku-lang-so. It forms,
+however, a very pleasant promenade, and may be enjoyed without
+interruption from the inhabitants. The city of Amoy is built on a low
+neck of land. The houses are of a dusky tint, and from the anchorage are
+indistinguishable through forests of junks' masts, which surround the
+town. To the right of the town, and extending to some distance, is a
+fortified wall, which gave some trouble at the capture. I landed<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_145" id="Page_145">[145]</a></span> with a
+party to walk through the city. The streets are narrow and dirty, the
+open shops on either side reminding you very much of Constantinople. The
+population is immense, the streets are always crowded. We soon found
+that we were objects of attention, and were followed by a mob. It was
+with difficulty that we could force our way; and, moreover, the town
+having been lately evacuated by our troops, the Chinese thought
+themselves secure in venting their animosity, by pushing, jostling, and
+throwing stones at us. In this, however, they were mistaken, for being a
+tolerably strong party, and knowing that they had a very wholesome fear
+of us, we were not slow in resorting to blows when intreaties proved in
+vain; and, before we were in the middle of the town, more than one
+celestial head had come in contact with the pavement. One had the
+impudence to bellow in my face; for which impertinence he received a
+facer, which gave him<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_146" id="Page_146">[146]</a></span> something to bellow for. Those, however, who
+"were at a distance had the means of annoying with impunity, and we were
+glad to take refuge in a pastry cook's shop, which happened most
+opportunely to present itself.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="cook" id="cook"></a>
+<img src="images/146.jpg" width="381" height="600" alt="Cook's Shop" />
+<p class="caption">COOK'S SHOP.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_147" id="Page_147">[147]</a></span>On our entering, we were each presented with a pair of chop sticks, and
+a large tray was placed before us, filled with sweetmeats of every
+description. There were nutmegs and other spices, ginger, sugar cane,
+bamboo, and the knee-bone palm, preserved in the most exquisite manner.
+Every thing was so novel, chop sticks not excepted, that it was quite
+fearful the extent to which we indulged in the sweetmeats; however, as
+we had no maiden aunts ready with their doses, as in our infancy, we ate
+and spared not. Cakes of the most recherche description, and pastry, the
+lightness of which would have shamed Gunter, were each and all in their
+turn discussed; and what was our astonishment to find that, on calling
+for the bill, the charge amounted to about sixpence.</p>
+
+<p>We visited as much of the town as the mob would permit, but I shall
+reserve my description of a genuine Chinese town until our arrival to
+the northward. The joss-houses at Amoy are not remarkable, and one
+description of these buildings will suffice for all.</p>
+
+<p>We lay at Amoy for about a week, during which the Mandarins paid us a
+full dress visit. They were extremely cautious, and remained on board
+for a couple of hours. At their departure we gave them the economical
+Chinese salute of three guns. During our stay here I amused myself
+principally on the island of Ku-lang-so, and I was not sorry when we
+weighed anchor, and, with a fair wind, made sail for Chusan.</p>
+
+<p>Chusan is the largest of a closely packed group of islands, near to the
+main land of China, and about 500 miles to the northward of Amoy. These
+islands, many of them very diminutive, are so close to each other, that
+on threading them to approach the town of Chusan, the channel wears the
+appearance of a small river branching out into every direction. If the
+leading marks were removed it would be a complete marine labyrinth, and
+a boat might pull and pull in and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_148" id="Page_148">[148]</a></span> out for the whole day, without
+arriving at its destination. Narrow, however, as is the passage, with a
+due precaution, and the necessary amount of backing and filling, there
+is sufficient water for ships of the largest size. At sunset we anchored
+off the town of Chusan. Here the islands form a beautiful little
+harbour, sufficiently capacious. The island being covered with tea
+plants, the panorama is pretty and refreshing. From the anchorage little
+can be seen of the town, as it is built on a flat, and hidden by a
+parapet and bank of mud, which runs along the bottom of the harbour.
+This temporary fortification is called a bund, and was erected by the
+Chinese previous to the capture of the place. Behind this bund is an
+esplanade, parallel with which are houses, which serve as barracks for
+the troops, and the residences of the civil and military functionaries.
+The country is hilly, and several commanding forts are visible from the
+anchorage.</p>
+
+<p>On landing, we directed our steps to the town by a causeway which leads
+from the landing-place to the gates between the fields of paddy, which
+are, as usual, swamped with water. The sides of this causeway are lined
+with shops; and the island being occupied by the English, soon stared
+you in the face, in the shape of boards in front of each shop, bearing
+such inscriptions as "Snip, from Pekin," "Stultz, from Ningpo," and
+others equally ludicrous, in good English letters. There were
+"Buckmasters" and "Hobys" innumerable; Licensed Victuallers and "Dealers
+in Grocery." Passing a tolerably well constructed gate, guarded by an
+English sentry, we entered the town. The streets are cleaner than those
+of Amoy, and not so narrow; but what gave us most satisfaction was, that
+our appearance excited no attention; and we enjoyed our walk, and made
+our observations uninterruptedly.</p>
+
+<p>Our first visit was to a toy-shop: a great many articles were exposed
+for sale, and many very beautiful carvings; they were, however, far too
+delicate for a midshipman's chest, and the price did not<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_149" id="Page_149">[149]</a></span> exactly suit a
+midshipman's pocket. A silk warehouse next occupied our attention: here
+we were shown some beautiful embroidery, some of which was purchased.
+After walking over the whole town, we proceeded to the principal
+joss-house: this was very handsome; but I was sorry that it had been
+selected as a barrack, and was occupied by a company of sepoys. The
+altar was converted into a stand for arms, and the god Fo was accoutred
+with a sheath and cross belt. To complete the absurdity, a green demon
+before the altar was grinning maliciously from under the weight of a
+frieze coat. At the entrance of the joss-house is a covered porch, under
+which are two figures sitting, and in this posture nearly twenty feet
+high. The interior of the house is handsomely ornamented and gilt; and
+behind the altar there is a row of some fifteen figures, in a sitting
+posture, all gilt from head to foot, and forming a very goodly assembly:
+they represented old men wrapped in togas, with faces expressive of
+instruction, revelation, and wisdom. There was nothing Chinese in their
+features; the heads were shaved, and it is to be presumed that they
+represented the prophets and holy writers who flourished antecedent to
+the great Fo. The expression on their countenances was admirable; and
+surprised us the more, from a knowledge how fond the Chinese are of
+filling their temples with unnatural and unmeaning devils.</p>
+
+<p>We then visited a smaller god-house: this the 8th regiment had converted
+into a theatre. Very little traces of a holy temple were discernible;
+and the great Fo occupied a corner of the green-room. The scenes were
+painted in fresco, and the whole affair was very tolerably arranged.
+Most part of the scenery had been painted by my brother during his stay
+at this port in the Cambrian. The Chinamen consider this no sacrilege,
+as they always use the temples as theatres themselves.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_150" id="Page_150">[150]</a></span>During the winter months Chusan is very cold, and the snow lies on the
+ground. The country there abounds with game&mdash;deer, swans, partridges,
+pheasants, and wild fowl of every description: the prices are very
+moderate; a fine buck may be purchased for a dollar, and a brace of
+pheasants for a rupee. It was now the month of May, and the swans and
+geese had departed, and game was becoming scarce as the weather became
+fine; still, however, there was a duck or so to be picked up, so I
+joined a party bent on trying their luck, and we prepared for a hard
+day's work.</p>
+
+<p>No one who has not tried it can have an idea of the fatigue of a day's
+shooting at Chusan. Having a Chinese covered boat, we loaded her with
+quite sufficient to support nature for twenty-four hours; and pulling
+about four miles through the channels intersecting the islands, we
+landed about daylight. Before us was a vast paddy field, into which we
+plunged up to our knees in mud and water. As we approached one of the
+dykes which convey the water for the irrigation, caution was observed,
+not a word was uttered by one of the party, and our good behaviour was
+rewarded by a brace of fine birds, which were deposited in the bag,
+carried by a celestial under-keeper. Crossing the dyke, we continued to
+wade through the paddy fields, shooting some plover and a red-legged
+partridge, until we arrived at a Chinese village. We passed through it,
+and fell in with a herd of water buffaloes, as they term them. One of
+them charged furiously, but the contents of one of our barrels in his
+eyes made him start in mid career; and having had quite enough into his
+head, he turned to us his tail. These animals show a great antipathy to
+Europeans, probably from not having been accustomed to their dress. Red,
+of course, makes them furious, and, thanks to his jacket, a drummer of
+one of the regiments was killed by these animals. Towards evening we
+felt it quite impossible to wade any further; and although nightfall is
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_151" id="Page_151">[151]</a></span>considered the best time for shooting ducks, we thought it was the best
+time to return to the boat, which we did not regain, fatigued, hungry,
+and covered with mud, till ten o'clock at night.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="pootoo" id="pootoo"></a>
+<img src="images/151.jpg" width="600" height="392" alt="View on the Island of Poo-toO" />
+<div class="cap-horiz">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">VIEW ON THE ISLAND OF POO-TOO.<br />
+<small>(NEAR CHUSAN.)</small>
+</p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>One day, strolling in the country about four miles from Chusan, we fell
+in with a very pretty little house surrounded with trees. The courtesy
+usually shown to the English at Chusan induced us to enter it, that we
+might inspect the premises. Its owner, a mandarin, was absent, but his
+major-domo took us over the whole house. The round doors and
+oyster-shell windows amused us greatly. The garden was ornamented with
+artificial rocks, studded with flowering shrubs, with great taste. There
+were two or three grottoes, in one of which was a joss; and an arbour of
+lilacs and laburnums, in full bloom, gave a charming appearance to the
+whole. Thanking the Chinaman for his civility, we went away, much
+pleased with the mandarin's country retreat.</p>
+
+<p>During our stay at Chusan we had made a party to go to the island of
+Poo-too, but we were hurried away sooner than we expected, and our
+design was frustrated. I will, however, give a description of the island
+of Poo-too, as described to me. This island is about forty miles from
+Chusan, and is inhabited solely by priests. These being condemned to a
+life of celibacy, no woman resides on the island, which is covered with
+temples of all descriptions, many of them very handsome, but one in
+particular, which was built by the emperor. The island is not large, and
+is laid out like a vast garden, with squares and walks, bridges, &amp;c.</p>
+
+<p>We left Chusan, and soon afterwards anchored off the mouth of the Ningpo
+River, which is only thirty miles to northward and westward of the
+Chusan isles. The first object of interest before us was the famous
+joss-house fort, which gave us so much trouble at the capture. General
+D'Aguilar and Captain Mundy being about to visit<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_152" id="Page_152">[152]</a></span> the city of Ningpo, a
+party of us obtained a week's leave of absence for the same purpose. We
+landed in a ship's boat at Chinghae, a small but tolerably fortified
+town, which, however, needs no description. There we obtained a covered
+Chinese boat, in which we put our beds and blankets, intending to live
+on board her during our stay at Ningpo. Starting with a fair wind and
+tide, by noon we were within five miles of the city, which is built
+about forty miles up the river. The banks of the river appeared to be
+highly cultivated, and the river was crowded with boats of all
+descriptions, some going up with the tide, others at anchor, waiting for
+the tide to change, to go in an opposite direction. The first that we
+saw of Ningpo was a low wall, from the middle of which rose a tall
+pagoda. This, with innumerable masts of the vessels lying off the town,
+was all that was visible: nor could we discern much more on a nearer
+approach. Threading the crowd of vessels which filled the river, on our
+left we could only see the wall and battlements of the town, the
+before-mentioned pagoda soaring above every thing. To the right, on the
+side of the river opposite to the town, were several detached houses,
+surrounded with low shrubberies; behind these was the Chinese country,
+and then the eye wandered over countless paddy fields, until it at last
+rested upon some faint blue mountains in the distance.</p>
+
+<p>Among the houses on the right was that of the vice-consul, Mr. Thorn.
+Anchoring our boat as near to his landing-place as possible, we made
+arrangements for the night, it being then too late to pay him the
+accustomed visit. We had, however, scarcely spread our mattresses, and
+put some supper on the fire, when we were hailed by a Chinese boy, and
+requested to come on shore. Ignorant from whence the invitation might
+come, but nothing loath, we hauled our boat to the jetty, and, landing,
+followed young pigtail, who ushered us through a court-yard into a house
+of tolerable dimensions, agreeably<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_153" id="Page_153">[153]</a></span> arranged according to English ideas
+of comfort. In five minutes more we were introduced to Mr. Mackenzie, an
+English merchant, who, having been informed of our arrival, had sent for
+us to request that, during our stay at Ningpo, we would make his house
+our home. We would not tax his hospitality so far as to sleep at his
+house, having already made our own arrangements; but we willingly
+accepted his kind offer of being his guests during the day, and proved
+our sincerity by immediately sitting down to an excellent dinner, and in
+the evening we retreated to our boat. The next morning we breakfasted
+with our host, and then crossed the river, to inspect the city. Having
+landed at one of the gates, we hired a sort of sedan chairs, which were
+carried by two athletic Tartars, and proceeded to examine a very
+remarkable building called the Ruined Pagoda. I shall give Dr. Milne's
+description of it, taken out of the Chinese repository, as I think it
+will be better than my own:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"We bent our steps to the Tien-fung, called by foreigners the Ruined
+Pagoda. Foreigners make for it as soon as they enter the east gate.
+After shaping their course in a south-east direction through numberless
+streets, it abruptly bursts upon the view, rising 160 feet above their
+heads, and towering high above the surrounding houses. The pagoda is
+hexagonal, and counts seven stories and twenty-eight windows. Above
+every window is a lantern, and when the pagoda is illuminated, the
+effect is very brilliant. This building is in much need of repair, and
+is daily becoming more dilapidated. It has already deviated many feet
+from the perpendicular, and might not unaptly be described as the
+Leaning Tower of Ningpo."</p>
+
+<p>Dr. Milne thus describes the view from the summit:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"The entire city and suburbs lay beneath us; the valley of Ningpo, with
+its hamlets and villages, hills and rivers, on every side; and away in
+the distance, on the one hand chains of lofty mountains, the
+<!--text from here on was part of pg. 155. Pg. 154 was wholly occupied by 154.jpg -->
+sea, with all its islands, on the other." Dr. Milne asserts that Ningpo is 10,000
+years old, and that the pagoda was raised antecedent to the city being
+built. He concludes by explaining the object of the Chinese in raising
+these monuments.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_154" id="Page_154">[154]</a></span></p>
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="pagoda" id="pagoda"></a>
+<img src="images/154.jpg" width="374" height="550" alt="Pagoda&mdash;Ningpo." />
+<p class="caption">PAGODA&mdash;NINGPO.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_155" id="Page_155">[155]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>The view from the summit is remarkably fine, and the ruinous condition
+of the pagoda almost warrants the supposition of its being nearly as
+ancient as Dr. Milne asserts. I made a drawing of it, and we then
+proceeded to the joss-house, which is considered as the handsomest in
+the Celestial empire. No part of the building was visible from the
+street, and we stopped at an unpretending door where we dismounted from
+our vehicles. A Bhuddist priest, clothed in grey and his head shaved,
+ushered us through a long gallery into the court-yard of the temple. To
+describe this building accurately would be impossible. It was gilt and
+carved from floor to ceiling. The porch was supported by pillars of
+stone beautifully carved with figures of griffins and snakes. In the
+court-yard were two lions carved out of a purple marble, and in the
+middle of the yard was an immense brazen ram highly ornamented with
+hieroglyphics and allegorical designs. As for the temple itself, it was
+so vast, so intricate, and so various in its designs and gildings, that
+I can only say picture to yourself a building composed entirely of
+carving, coloured porcelain, and gilding, and then you may have a faint
+idea of it. I attempted to make a drawing of it, but before I had
+obtained much more than the outline, it was time to recross the river.
+We dined and passed the evening with Mr. Mackenzie as before. The next
+morning I walked to the Chinese cemetery with my gun in my hand, and
+shot a few snipe and wood pigeons, and after breakfast we crossed the
+river to pay a visit to the shops of Ningpo. The streets of the city are
+narrow, but superior to any that we had yet seen. The principal streets
+are ornamented with stone arches, and the huge<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_156" id="Page_156">[156]</a></span> painted boards used by
+the Chinese for advertisements give them a very gay appearance. We first
+entered into a furniture warehouse, some 300 yards in length, and filled
+with Chinese bedsteads carved and gilt in a very splendid manner. These
+bedsteads consist of moveable frames about twelve feet square, and
+within them are disposed couches, chairs, tables, and the requisites for
+the toilet, besides a writing desk, so that a bedstead in China contains
+all the furniture of the room. Some of these were valued at five and six
+hundred dollars, but were very highly ornamented and of exquisite
+workmanship.</p>
+
+<p>A hat shop was the next visited. Its interior would have been considered
+splendid even in Regent Street. A long highly polished counter with a
+top of cane-work, was loaded with the hats and caps of Mandarins of
+every class, and the display was very tempting to those who wanted them.
+We then passed five minutes in a porcelain warehouse; from the warehouse
+we went to a toy-shop, and being by this time pretty well encumbered
+with mandarins' hats and caps, gongs, and a variety of other articles
+which we did not want, at the same time making the discovery that our
+purses were not encumbered with dollars as they were when we set forth,
+we thought it advisable to leave off shopping for the day.</p>
+
+<p>The next day we visited the Hall of Confucius, which was not worth
+seeing, nor could we discover to what use it was dedicated, so we turned
+from it and went off to see a Chinese play. As we proceeded to the
+theatre we were surprised to hear a lad singing "Jim along Josey," we
+turned round and found it was a real pig tail who was singing, and we
+inquired where he learnt the air. We found that he had served on board
+one of our vessels during the Chinese war, so we hired the young traitor
+as a cicerone during our stay at Ningpo, and ordered him to follow us to
+the theatre, which as usual was a temple or joss-house.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="ningpojoss" id="ningpojoss"></a>
+<img src="images/156.jpg" width="600" height="401" alt="Chinese Joss House at Ningpo." />
+<div class="cap-horiz">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">CHINESE JOSS HOUSE AT NINGPO.</p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_157" id="Page_157">[157]</a></span>We found it crowded with Chinese, and the actors were performing on a
+raised platform. Our entrance caused a great sensation, and for a short
+time the performance was unnoticed by the audience. Our beaver hats
+quite puzzled them, for we were in plain clothes; even the actors
+indulged in a stare, and for a short time we were "better than a play."
+The Chinese acting has been often described: all I can say is, that so
+far it was like real life that all the actors were speaking at one time,
+and it was impossible to hear what they said, even if the gongs had not
+kept up a continual hammering, which effectually drowned the voices. At
+all events they were well off in the property line, being all very
+showily dressed. Fireworks were at intervals exploded, and occasionally
+a tumbler would perform some feat, but I felt little interest in the
+performance, and kept my eyes on the gallery containing the ladies,
+among whom I saw one or two very pretty faces.</p>
+
+<p>The wall round Ningpo is built wide enough for a carriage drive. It has
+embrasures, but no guns were mounted. By ascending some steps near to
+the town gate we found ourselves on the top of the wall, and walked half
+round the town on the parapet. It was very extensive, and, as far as the
+eye could reach, the plain was studded with country houses of a slate
+colour.</p>
+
+<p>I forgot to mention that while here we visited a sect of Chinese nuns or
+female devotees. They were assembled in a large room, at one end of
+which was an image of the god Fo. Each nun was seated at a small table
+on which was a reading stand and a book of prayers. They were all
+reading, and at the same time beating a hollow painted piece of wood:
+the latter duty was, we were informed, to keep up the attention of the
+god. What with them all gabbling at once, and the tapping noise made
+with the wood, god Fo appeared more likely to have his attention
+distracted than otherwise. However, it was of no<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_158" id="Page_158">[158]</a></span> consequence, as Fo was
+one of that description of gods mentioned in the Bible, among whose
+attributes we find, "Ears have they, but they hear not."</p>
+
+<p>We remained here a week, and I was much interested with what I saw; but
+so much has already been written about the Chinese, that I wish to
+confine myself to what may be considered unbroken ground. As the time
+fixed for our departure approached, we determined to go to Chinghae
+overland, in chairs. Taking a farewell of our kind and hospitable host,
+Mr. Mackenzie, we each took a chair, and took our departure. The road
+was interesting, being at one time through tea plantations, and at
+another through paddy fields. Our bearers were strong muscular fellows,
+and thought little of carrying us twenty-five miles. We passed crowds of
+Chinamen irrigating the land, and working in the paddy fields. In some
+instances they favoured us with a salute of yells and stones; and as we
+approached Chinghae, the unwashed vented their feelings in some very
+unpleasant ways. In the town we were followed by a mob; and by the time
+we had reached the quay, and procured a boat to take us off to the ship,
+the whole town had turned out. Tapping one or two of the most officious
+with the bamboo oars, we managed to shove the boat off, and pulled on
+board.</p>
+
+<p>We sailed for Chusan the same evening, but this time I unfortunately was
+attacked by one of the prevailing diseases of the country, and was
+confined to my hammock. We revisited Amoy, and then shaped our course
+for Hong Kong. On our arrival, we found no ship there but the Castor,
+the admiral and fleet being employed on the coast of Borneo, subduing
+the pirates in Maludu Bay. The ship being again about to start for the
+northward, I was considered too unwell to remain in her, and was sent on
+board the Minden hospital ship, to live or to die, as it might please
+God.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_159" id="Page_159">[159]</a></span>The Minden hospital ship is a fine 74; and as all the guns, masts, and
+stores, had been landed at the time that she was selected for the duty,
+there was great accommodation on board of her; but great as it was,
+unfortunately there was not sufficient to meet the demands upon it in
+this unhealthy climate. A description of her internal arrangement may
+not be uninteresting. The quarter-deck and poop was set apart for the
+convalescents; but the heat of the sun was so overpowering, that it was
+not until late in the afternoon that they could breathe the purer
+atmosphere. Long confinement below had left them pale and wan, and their
+unsteady gait proved how much they had suffered in their constitution,
+and how narrowly they had escaped the grave. To some this escape had
+been beneficial, as their constant perusal of the Bible established;
+others, if they even had during their illness alarms about their future
+state, had already dismissed them from their thoughts, and were
+impatiently awaiting their return to health to return to past folly and
+vice. The main deck was allotted to the medical and other officers
+belonging to the ship, the seamen who composed the ship's company, and
+also on this deck were located the seamen who had been discharged cured,
+and who then waited for the arrival of their ships, which were absent
+from Hong Kong. On this deck, abaft all, was the inspector's cabin, and
+adjoining it the mess-room of the assistant-surgeons, who, like all
+their class, rendered callous by time and habit to their dangerous and
+painful duty, thought only of driving away the memory of the daily
+mortality to which they were witnesses by jovial living and mirth.
+Indeed nothing could be a more harassing scene than that of the lower
+deck, where the patients were located. Under any circumstances an
+hospital is a depressing and afflicting sight, even with all the
+advantages of clean well-regulated wards, attentive nurses, and pure
+ventilation. Imagine then the feelings of a sick wretch, stretched on a
+canvass cot,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_160" id="Page_160">[160]</a></span> who is first hoisted up the ship's side, and then lowered
+down a dark hatchway (filled with anxiety and forebodings as to his ever
+leaving the vessel alive) to the scene of misery which I am about to
+describe&mdash;the lower deck of the Minden hospital ship.</p>
+
+<p>This lower deck has on each side of it three rows of iron bedsteads, for
+the most part filled with the dead and dying; an intolerable stench,
+arising from putrefaction, which it is impossible by any means to get
+rid of, salutes his descent; and to this is added the groans of
+lingering sufferers. He may chance, God help him, to be lowered down at
+the very hour of the inspecting surgeon's visits. The latter is seated
+by a bed, having probably just performed, or in the act of performing,
+an operation. The goodly array of instruments meets his eye, and he
+wonders, as they are displayed, what these several instruments of
+torture can be applied to; the groans of the patient fall upon his ear,
+and his nerves are so shattered and debilitated by disease, that the
+blood curdles to his heart. The inspector writes the particulars of the
+case on a printed form, while the dressers are passing bandages round
+the fainting patient. As soon as he is out of the cot which lowered him
+down, the new arrival is washed, and clothed in hospital linen, ready to
+be put into a bed. Not unfrequently he has to wait till room can be made
+for him, by removing the corpse of the last occupant, just deceased. He
+is then placed on it, a coarse sheet is thrown over him, and he is left
+to await the inspector's visit, which, as that officer has all his
+former patients first to prescribe for, may perhaps be not for an hour
+or two, or more. At last he is visited, prescribed for, a can of
+rice-water is placed at the head of his bed, and he is left to his own
+thoughts, if the groans of those around him, and the horror that he
+feels at his situation, will permit him to reach them. If he can do so,
+they must be any thing but agreeable; and a clever medical man told me
+that this admission into the hospital, and the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_161" id="Page_161">[161]</a></span> scene which the patient
+was introduced to, was quite sufficient, acting upon a mind unnerved by
+disease, to produce fever. Excepting that the hospital was too crowded,
+which indeed could not be prevented, there was, however, every
+arrangement for the comfort of the patients which could be made under
+such a climate. No one was to blame&mdash;the hospital for the military was
+building, and until it was ready for the reception of the patients, the
+men of both services were received on board of the Minden. But if the
+day is so trying, who can describe the horrors of the night? The
+atmosphere becomes still more foul and pestilential, from the partially
+closed port-holes, and from the indifference of the nurses to the
+necessary cleanliness required. The whole becomes alive with cockroaches
+and other vermin, creeping over the patients; and the mosquitoes prey
+upon the unfortunate sufferer, or drive him mad with their unceasing
+humming preparatory to their attacks. Add these new trials to the groans
+of the dying, which, during my residence on board, never ceased, and at
+night were more awful and painfully distinct. The nurses were all men,
+obtained from the scum of the sea-ports, for no others would volunteer
+for the duty&mdash;a set of brutes indifferent to the sufferings of others.
+As long as they were, during the day, superintended and watched by the
+officers, they did their duty, but at night the neglect was most
+shameful. In fact, these wretches composed themselves to sleep instead
+of watching. Patients may in vain call, in a feeble voice, for
+water&mdash;the only answer is a snore. On one occasion, having listened to
+the call of a poor fellow for more than an hour, and each time in a
+weaker voice, for drink, I was obliged to get up myself to wake the
+nurse, that the man might not die of thirst.<a name="FNanchor_2_2" id="FNanchor_2_2"></a><a href="#Footnote_2_2" class="fnanchor">[2]</a></p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_162" id="Page_162">[162]</a></span>My cabin, for all the officers were separated from the men, commanded
+the whole view of the lower deck, and I was compelled to be witness of
+scenes of the most frightful description. An English sailor had been
+hung for murder, in consequence of his accomplice, who was by far the
+most criminal of the two, having turned queen's evidence. This latter
+soon afterwards was brought on board the Minden, having been attacked
+with the fever, and never was there such an evidence of the racking of a
+bad conscience. In his ravings he shrieked for mercy, and then would
+blaspheme in the most awful manner. At one moment the spectre of his
+dead comrade would be invoked by him, requesting it to depart, or
+desiring those around him to take it away. At others, the murdered man
+was standing at his bed-side, and he would attempt to run, that he might
+flee from the vision. Thus was he haunted, and thus did he disturb all
+around him till his very last hour, when he died in an extreme of agony,
+physical and mental. What a relief it was when this poor wretch was at
+last silent!</p>
+
+<p>Almost every day there was to be seen a Roman Catholic priest
+administering the last unction to some disciple of his faith, some Irish
+soldier or sailor, whose hour was come. On these occasions the
+amputation table was his altar, and a brass flat candlestick the only
+ornament. He never failed to be at his post every day, and was a good
+old man. At the same time that the old priest was officiating by the
+side of one bed, the chaplain of the ship would be attending the last
+moments of some other victim. On these occasions all would be silent on
+the deck, even the groans were stifled and checked for <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_163" id="Page_163">[163]</a></span>the time, and
+nothing would be heard but the muttered prayer of the Catholic priest,
+or the last, and often futile, attempts of the clergyman of our own
+creed to extract some sign of faith and hope from the fast-sinking and
+almost senseless patient.</p>
+
+<div class="poem"><div class="stanza">
+<span class="i0">"He dies, and makes no sign! O God, forgive him!"<br /></span>
+</div></div>
+
+<p>At times the uproar on the deck would be appalling. Some powerful man in
+the strength of delirium would rise from his bed, and, bursting from
+some half-dozen of the nurses, would rush through the tiers of beds
+roaring like a bull, and dealing blows right and left upon the
+unfortunate sick men who fell in his way. Then there would be general
+chase after him, until, overpowered by additional help, he was brought
+back to his bed and confined by force. An hour or two afterwards, the
+nurses who watched him would quit the side of the pallet; a sheet would
+be thrown over it; no other communication was necessary to tell me that
+the storm had been succeeded by a calm, and that life's fitful fever was
+over.</p>
+
+<p>At the forepart of the hospital deck is a bath room; adjoining to that
+is a small dark cabin, with no other furniture than a long white-washed
+board, laid upon two tressels, with hooks fixed to the carlines of the
+deck. Above these the dead bodies are removed: immediately after their
+decease a <i>post mortem</i> examination is made by the assistant surgeon, a
+report of which is sent into the inspector. A port-hole has a wooden
+shoot or slide fixed to it, by which the bodies are ejected into the
+boat waiting to convey them for interment.</p>
+
+<p>The church service is read every morning on the hospital deck, and
+during the performance the strictest attention was paid by the patients.
+When convalescent I enjoyed the privilege of walking on the poop with
+the others who had been spared, and truly grateful was I for my
+recovery. Such scenes as I have described could not but<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_164" id="Page_164">[164]</a></span> have the effect
+upon me: I hope that I left the hospital a wiser and a better man.</p>
+
+<p>At last the time came when I was pronounced by the doctors to be quite
+cured, and at liberty to leave the ship. I hardly need say that I did so
+with alacrity. I had always before this considered Hong Kong as a most
+disgusting place; but now that I had been so long cooped up with disease
+and death, it appeared to me as a paradise. I had made one or two
+acquaintances during my former visits, and now found their kind offers
+too welcome to refuse them. Having nothing to do, and not being even
+obliged to present myself on board of the Mind en, I enjoyed myself
+excessively in journeys and excursions to the other side of the island.
+My acquaintances were the officers of the 42d regiment, who were
+remarkably kind and intelligent men, and during my stay I was a great
+deal in their society. We one day made up a party to visit Pirate's Bay,
+a spot on the Chinese main, about twelve miles from Hong Kong. Starting
+early, we took our guns and the requisites for a pic-nic. When we
+arrived at the spot, we hired the only respectable house in the place,
+left a native to make the necessary arrangements for our dinner, and
+then started on a cruise to view the country. We shot at any thing that
+came in our way, and by noon our game-bag contained a curious medley of
+ducks, paroquets, swallows, and water rats. By this time the sun became
+so overpowering that we returned to the house which had been hired for
+our accommodation. Here we dined, and returned to Hong Kong well pleased
+with our trip. The roads at Hong Kong, though not particularly good,
+have been made at great expence. Large rocks have been cut through to
+afford communication, and the quantity of rivulets running down from the
+mountains, have rendered it necessary to build innumerable bridges.
+There were but few good horses on the island; but I managed to procure a
+tolerable one, and in the evening would ride<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_165" id="Page_165">[165]</a></span> out by "Happy Valley," and
+return by dark, the only exercise which the heat of the climate would
+permit, and which was necessary to restore me to health. Society is in a
+queer state here, as may be imagined when I state, that the shipowner
+won't associate with the small merchant, and the latter will not deign
+to acknowledge a man who keeps a store. Under these circumstances, the
+army and navy keep aloof, and associate with no class. There were very
+few ladies at Hong Kong at this time, and of what class they were
+composed of may be imagined, when I state that a shopkeeper's sister was
+the belle of the place, and received all the homage of the marriageable
+men of Hong Kong. Hospitality to strangers is as yet unknown, and a
+letter of introduction is only good for one tiffin, or more rarely one<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_166" id="Page_166">[166]</a></span>
+dinner. I made several excursions in the country, but did not find any
+thing worth narrating, or describing with the pencil.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="tankawomen" id="tankawomen"></a>
+<img src="images/165.jpg" width="500" height="377" alt="Tanka Boat Women" />
+<p class="caption">TANKA BOAT WOMEN.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>It is here worthy of remark, that there is every prospect of all the
+enormous expense which has been bestowed upon this island being totally
+thrown away, and that those who have speculated will lose all their
+money; in fact, that in a few years Hong Kong will be totally deserted,
+and all the money expended upon it will be lost. To explain this I must
+mention a few facts, not probably known to my readers.</p>
+
+<p>When, many years ago, the trade with foreigners was first permitted by
+the Chinese government, Canton was selected as the port from which it
+should be carried on. The Chinese government had two reasons for making
+this selection: their first was, their dislike and jealousy of
+foreigners induced them to select a port at the very confines of the
+empire where the communication with them should take place, so that by
+no chance the foreigners should obtain any thing like a footing in or
+knowledge of their country; the second reason was, that by so doing they
+obtained, at the expence of the foreigners, a very considerable inland
+revenue from the tea trade. Canton is situated at least 500 miles from
+those provinces in which the tea is grown, and the transit to Canton is
+over a very mountainous range, at the passes of which tolls are levied
+by the government, which are now said to amount annually to seven
+millions. The assertion, therefore, of the Chinese government that they
+do not care about the trade is very false, for they have derived a great
+revenue from it.</p>
+
+<p>The opening of the more northern ports, which was obtained by the war
+with China, has already made a great difference, and every year will
+make a greater. Shang-hai, one of the ports opened, and the farthest to
+the northward, is situated on the confines of the great tea country, and
+vessels going there to take in their cargoes avoid all<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_167" id="Page_167">[167]</a></span> the duties of
+transit, and procure the tea in a much better condition. The merchants
+of Canton, moreover, who traffic in tea, are all of them for the most
+part people of the province of Shang-hai, who resort to Canton to look
+after their interests, but now that the port of Shang-hai is opened,
+their merchants are returning to their own country, the English
+merchants are settling at Shang-hai, and the vessels are going there to
+load with tea direct. Already a large portion of the traffic has left
+Canton and gone to Shang-hai, and it is but natural to suppose, that in
+a few years the tea trade will be carried on altogether from that port,
+as the expence of transit over the mountains and the duties levied will
+be avoided, as well as the advantage gained of having the tea in a much
+better condition when shipped on board. How the Chinese government will
+act when it finds that it loses the great revenue arising from the trade
+being carried on at Canton remains to be seen, but it will, probably,
+succumb to another war, if such is considered necessary. It will be a
+curious subject of interest to watch the fall of Hong Kong, of Macao,
+and also of Canton itself, with its turbulent population, which must,
+when the trade is withdrawn, fall into insignificance.</p>
+
+<p>The great error of the last war was, our selection of such an unhealthy
+and barren island as Hong Kong as our <i>pied-&agrave;-terre</i> in China, when we
+might have had Chusan, or, indeed, any other place which we might have
+insisted upon. We thought that Chusan was unhealthy because we barracked
+our soldiers in the swamps, and consequently lost many of the men, when,
+as it is a most healthy and delightful climate, had the barracks been
+built on the hills, we probably should not have lost a man. Even now it
+is not too late. The Chinese dislike our propinquity to their coast at
+Hong Kong, and the last expedition will have the effect of increasing
+this dislike. I think, with very little difficulty, the Chinese
+government would now exchange<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_168" id="Page_168">[168]</a></span> Chusan for Hong Kong, if it were only to
+keep such unpleasant barbarians, as the English have proved to be, at a
+more respectable distance. If we had possession of Chusan, the trade
+would come to our ports. The Chinese junks would come to us loaded with
+tea, and take our goods in return. The trade would then be really thrown
+open, which at present it is not.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="warjunk" id="warjunk"></a>
+<img src="images/168.jpg" width="500" height="470" alt="Man-of-war Junk" />
+<p class="caption">MAN-OF-WAR JUNK.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>Murders and robberies were of daily, or, rather, nightly occurrence at
+Hong Kong, the offenders being Chinese, who are the most daring robbers
+perhaps in the world.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_169" id="Page_169">[169]</a></span></p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="tradejunk" id="tradejunk"></a>
+<img src="images/169a.jpg" width="400" height="308" alt="First of Two Trading Junks" />
+</div>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<img src="images/169b.jpg" width="400" height="308" alt="Second of Two Trading Junks" />
+<p class="caption">TRADING JUNKS.</p>
+</div>
+
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_170" id="Page_170">[170]</a></span>I must now detail the events of a cruise of the Samarang during the time
+that I was in the Iris, and I avail myself of the private journal of one
+of my friends.</p>
+
+<p>May 9th, sailed from Hong Kong to Batan, to complete the survey of the
+Bashee group. On the 20th we left Batan to run to Ibyat, about twenty
+miles from the former island, and although a high table land, it is low
+when compared with Batan. I never saw an island less inviting in
+appearance than Ibyat. We landed at the foot of a precipice, nearly
+perpendicular, and ascended to the summit by means of rough ladders,
+placed upright against large masses of rock; on either side of which
+were gaping chasms, the very sight of which were sufficient to unnerve
+us. This plan was not only the best for landing on this strange island,
+but, as the natives informed us, was almost the only one where a
+landing could be effected without great danger. It was near sunset when
+we landed; the boats returned to the ship, leaving us to partake of the
+hospitality of the padres from Batan, who had taken a passage in the
+ship, as they had some spiritual business to transact on this island.
+About 8 <small>P. M.</small>, we arrived at the village of San Raphael, where we slept
+in a house set apart for the use of the padres. This village is
+situated in the centre of the island, built in a valley and on
+eminences which surround it. The most commanding position is occupied
+by the church and mission house, both of which are much larger,
+although built of the same materials, and on the same plan, as the
+houses of the natives. There was but one room in the mission house,
+which was scantily furnished with some heavy wooden chairs, and some
+cane settees for bed places; however, thanks to the kindness of the
+padres, we contrived to make ourselves very comfortable. There are four
+villages in the island, San Raphael, Santa Maria, Santa Lucia, and
+Santa Rosa; each consisting of about forty houses, containing about 300
+people; so that the population<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_171" id="Page_171">[171]</a></span> may be taken, at a rough guess, at
+about 1200. The natives profess the Roman Catholic religion, and appear
+to be very sincere in their devotion. Divine service is performed
+morning and evening, at which time the boys and girls of the village
+walk to the church in two lines, chanting a hymn to the Virgin Mary.
+Each line is headed by the youngest of either sex, bearing a cross. The
+boys wore nothing but the middle cloth, and the girls were almost as
+scantily clothed; the only garment being a skirt or petticoat, not
+larger than a moderate sized pocket-handkerchief. During two days our
+friends, the padres, were fully occupied with the important ceremonies
+of marriage and baptism. Many of the parties joined in matrimony were
+mere children. They all had, on this important occasion, some addition
+to their general costume. The bridegroom, for instance, wore a shirt;
+some of them had actually a pair of trousers. The bride had an
+additional and large petticoat, and an embroidered handkerchief. They
+were not at all bashful&mdash;there was no blushing&mdash;no tears, and, on the
+contrary, marriage appeared to be considered as an excellent joke, and
+the laughing and flirtation were carried on to the church door. The
+padres appeared to be almost worshipped by the poor natives, who, on
+their arrival and departure, respectfully saluted their hands. But
+their great affection was shown in a more satisfactory and substantial
+manner, by the continual supply of goats, pigs, fowls, vegetables, and
+fruit, which were liberally supplied during our stay. I forgot to say
+that the marriage certificates were of a very primitive kind; they
+consisted of a laurel leaf, in which were rudely inscribed the names of
+the bride and bridegroom. At length, having finished our survey, we bid
+farewell to our hospitable entertainers, and on the 27th made sail for
+St. Domingo.</p>
+
+<p>We remained two days at St. Domingo, and then weighed and steered to the
+northward. On the 3d of June we landed on the island<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_172" id="Page_172">[172]</a></span> of Samazana, near
+the south point of Formosa. The inhabitants of Samazana are Chinese,
+although they pay no tribute to the emperor. This island was first
+inhabited, about twenty years since, by a party of Chinese sailors, who
+were thrown on shore in a tempest. They afterwards returned to Amoy,
+where, having persuaded several families to join them, they returned to
+Samazana, and colonised it. The fertility of this island has richly
+repaid them for their labour. The village contains about 100 people, who
+are located in about ten or fifteen houses. Paddy, sugar-cane, and yams
+are grown in abundance, and ground nuts cover nearly one third of the
+island. These Chinese settlers keep up a trade with Amoy, from whence
+they obtain what they require, in exchange for the productions of their
+island. We found these people very civil and obliging, but excessively
+dirty in their persons and apparel.</p>
+
+<p>About seven o'clock in the evening, while we were dining on the beach,
+an earthquake shook the island, the glasses jingled together, and all
+our party were in involuntary see-saw motion, like the Chinese figures.
+This lasted about ten seconds. Several of us, who had never before
+experienced the sensation, were much relieved when the shock was over,
+as it created a suffocating sensation. During the evening there were
+several other shocks, but none of them equal to the first in violence.
+We remained all night on the island, to ascertain the latitude by the
+stars.</p>
+
+<p>On the following morning we returned on board, when we were informed
+that the ship had struck on a reef on the preceding evening, at 7 <small>P. M.</small>
+The lead was thrown overboard, but no soundings were obtained, proving,
+beyond doubt, that the concussion had been communicated to the vessel.
+She was about four miles off the land at the time, and many would not
+then be convinced that it was an earthquake; although I believe it has
+been satisfactorily proved that the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_173" id="Page_173">[173]</a></span> shock has been felt by a vessel
+which has been out of sight of any land.</p>
+
+<p>On the 6th of June sighted one of the Madjicosima islands. The master in
+the second cutter left the ship, with a week's provisions, to survey the
+island, while we made sail for our former anchorage at Pa-tchu-san, to
+obtain water.</p>
+
+<p>On the 8th of June we arrived at Pa-tchu-san, where we were received by
+our friends, the chiefs, who appeared delighted to see us again. We
+learnt through our interpreter that a French frigate had left Loo-choo
+for Corea two months before&mdash;twenty-seven of their countrymen, chiefly
+missionaries, having been murdered by the Coreans. It would appear that
+the French missionaries, exceeding their vocation, had wished to make
+some alterations in the Corean form of government, but their attempts
+not meeting the approbation of those in power, they fell a sacrifice to
+their good intentions.</p>
+
+<p>On the 9th we sailed for Sabangyat to pick up the two cutters. We
+arrived there the next day, and were joined by the master. We received
+every attention from the hospitable and inoffensive natives, who
+supplied us with pigs, fowls, and vegetables, refusing to accept any
+thing in return. We returned to Pa-tchu-san to rate our chronometers,
+and sailed on the same day. The next morning we landed on Hoa-pen, an
+island, but the cloudy weather prevented us from obtaining the latitude.
+We landed during the day, and remained on shore the whole night to
+obtain our objects, and, I may add, were most cruelly bitten by the
+mosquitoes as a reward for our zeal.</p>
+
+<p>When we were returning to the ship on the following morning, a large
+albatross alighted on the water close to the boat. As we passed it, it
+made several futile attempts to rise again on the wing. It is well known
+that this bird cannot fly while under the influence of fear, and so it
+appeared in this instance, for, while we were passing it, a<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_174" id="Page_174">[174]</a></span> shark
+thrust its head out of the water and took the unfortunate bird down with
+him.</p>
+
+<p>On the 16th we landed at Tea-qua-san, where we captured great numbers of
+albatrosses, ferns, and boobies. They actually refused to move at our
+approach. This island is very small and uninhabited, but it was evident
+that people had landed on it lately, for in a cave we discovered several
+grass beds, remains of game, and remnants of cooking. The weather
+prevented us from making any observations, but it did not prevent us
+from collecting several hundreds of eggs, which we took on board with
+us. The next day we saw a large rock, marked doubtful on the charts. A
+heavy squall, which forced us to run before it for several hours,
+prevented us from ascertaining its position.</p>
+
+<p>June 19. We found ourselves close to the southern extremity of Loo-choo,
+the land of which is low. About noon we anchored in the harbour of
+Napa-kiang, and were boarded by several mandarins, one of whom the
+captain recognised as the interpreter of the Blossom, whose interesting
+cruise has been published by Captain Beechey. The natives of Loo-choo
+are so similar to those of the Madjicosima group that it would be
+useless describing their manners and customs, the more so as we have
+already the works of Captain Hall and Captain Beechey, in which they are
+described most accurately. A great many junks were anchored in the inner
+harbour, their enormous masts towering far above the highest buildings.</p>
+
+<p>The burial ground is a large tract of land to the left of the town; the
+tombs are large, and in shape resemble the last letter in the Greek
+alphabet (&Omega;). Strange that it should be the last letter.
+Most of them are painted white, and they have from the anchorage a very
+picturesque appearance.</p>
+
+<p>It was the captain's intention to have sailed on the day after our<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_175" id="Page_175">[175]</a></span>
+arrival, but the weather proving unfavourable for astronomical
+observations, our departure was postponed for another day, when, having
+obtained sights, some live stock, and vegetables, we sailed for Guilpat,
+a large island off the southern extremity of Corea. Previous to our
+sailing, a French missionary called on the captain. He had been left at
+Loo-choo by the Alcimene frigate, with a view of introducing
+Christianity into the island, but the chiefs did not appear to relish
+his sojourn there, and were anxious to get rid of him. He offered to
+accompany us to Corea and Japan; at the latter place he would have been
+of great service, as he was acquainted with the Japanese language.</p>
+
+<p>June 24. Sighted the Goth island, a portion of the Japanese empire. The
+next morning the wind had increased to a heavy gale, and we were
+compelled to reduce our canvass to a close-reefed main topsail,
+staysail, and trysail. We rounded Cape Goth within a quarter of a mile,
+and lay to under the lee of the island, where the sea was comparatively
+smooth. Towards the evening the wind subsided, and we again made sail.
+Saw the island of Guilpat, and the next morning anchored off the
+north-east side of it, in a channel between Guilpat and a small island.
+We landed on the small island, where we were received by about sixty
+natives, who did not appear well pleased at our intrusion, but knew that
+resistance to us would be useless.</p>
+
+<p>In the course of the day several thousand natives had assembled on the
+opposite shore. By the aid of good telescopes we could discern forts and
+flags. The natives informed us that Guilpat had a standing army, well
+supplied with matchlocks, swords, and bows and arrows. They added that
+guns are not wanted to defend the island in case of need. This assertion
+we afterwards found, making allowance for a little exaggeration, to be
+quite correct.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_176" id="Page_176">[176]</a></span>The island of Guilpat is subject to the kingdom of Corea, and is the
+largest in that archipelago, being about thirty miles in length and
+fifteen in breadth. It is composed of innumerable hills in every variety
+of form, such as cones, saddles, and tables. Most of these hills have
+forts built on their summits. From these, lights were displayed every
+evening, and it was astonishing the rapidity with which these signals
+were answered. I have seen the whole coast illuminated in less than five
+minutes, each hill appearing like a little volcano, suddenly bursting
+out. As soon as the boats had surveyed this part of the island, we
+shifted the ship to where the survey was being carried on; and this we
+continued to do during the whole time that we were employed in the
+survey, the boats returning on board every night. Good anchorage is to
+be obtained all round the island. Innumerable forts and batteries are
+built along the coast; every rising ground being surmounted with one,
+although the major portion of them were not supplied with guns. We found
+as we coasted along that all the forts were manned, the people being
+armed with matchlocks, spears, and arrows. On several occasions they
+fired their matchlocks, and the salute was returned by the 6-pounders in
+the barges, which never failed of putting them to flight. In the centre
+of the island the land runs to an enormous height, and terminates in a
+sharp peak, which, in consequence of its always having been enveloped
+with clouds, we did not see till several days after our arrival.</p>
+
+<p>At last we arrived at the principal town, which is situated on the
+western side of the island. The town was inclosed with thick walls,
+higher than we had observed before as we coasted along. These walls form
+a square, each side of which is about half a mile in length, and has
+batteries, parapets, and embrasures. In some of the latter there were
+guns, which were occasionally fired. The whole ground before<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_177" id="Page_177">[177]</a></span> the town,
+for the distance of a mile and a half, was crowded with people; but if
+they waited for our landing they were disappointed, as the captain would
+not land. They gave us two bullocks, which were put into the barge, as
+the ship was then ten or twelve miles off. The mandarins used every
+argument to persuade the captain to come on shore and visit the chiefs
+of the island; but, as we had but twenty men in the boats, he refused to
+trust himself among eight or ten thousand whose intentions were any
+thing but satisfactory. However, he promised that he would come on shore
+on the following day, but that at present he was obliged to visit a
+point of the bay to obtain observations before sunset. We now prepared
+to move in the barge, but found ourselves encompassed by twelve or
+fourteen large boats, fastened to each other by strong ropes. We desired
+them to make a passage, but they either did not, or would not,
+understand us. This looked very much like treachery, and decided
+measures were become requisite: the nearest boats were boarded, and the
+crews made to cut their ropes. Some of them appeared inclined to resist,
+but a smart stroke of the cutlass put their courage to flight. This
+affair took place within twenty yards of the beach, and in sight of
+10,000 people on the shore. We now being clear, pulled for the point and
+secured our station. A great crowd collected around us while we were
+observing; the chiefs expressed a wish, in a peremptory sort of way,
+that the officers should partake of some refreshment at a short distance
+from the beach. This the captain, who suspected treachery, refused, and
+as we were going near to our boats, some of the natives laid violent
+hands upon our men, but having received from them a few specimens of our
+method of boxing, they soon quitted their hold. The Chinese interpreter
+was now missing; our men in consequence procured their arms, and
+landing, a strict search was made for him. He was found some little
+distance on land, having been enticed away<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_178" id="Page_178">[178]</a></span> by one of the chiefs, who
+was plying him with sam-schoo. On his way to return they forcibly
+detained him, and were in the act of conveying him away, when the
+appearance of the armed party from the boat surprised them, and they
+hastened to convey their own persons out of reach of our bayonets. It
+was not, however, our intention, or our policy, to commence hostilities,
+only to show them that we would not be trifled with.</p>
+
+<p>We returned from the point to the beach before the town, when the boat's
+guns were loaded with round and grape, and pointed at the crowd
+assembled, in case of any further treachery. The captain then landed
+with the small armed party, all ready for resistance.</p>
+
+<p>Music was now heard in the distance, and soon afterwards one of the
+principal chiefs arrived, walking beneath a silken canopy. He was
+attended by two young lads and a band of spearmen, who prevented the mob
+from approaching too close to his highness's person. The multitude
+shouted, and bowed their heads to the ground as the chief passed them;
+the latter took no notice of their acclamations, but advanced in a very
+stately dignified manner towards the captain, apparently keeping time to
+the music, which was played by a band of men, dressed in a very
+fantastic manner, on cymbals and instruments resembling our clarionets.</p>
+
+<p>The negotiations were now opened: the captain expressed his surprise and
+disgust at the treatment he had experienced at the point, where he had
+been taking observations. The chief inquired of the captain, in reply,
+why he did not shoot the offenders? and assured him that, if the next
+time he was annoyed by the rabble he would shoot a few of them, it would
+have a very salutary effect upon the remainder. In the course of
+conversation, the captain informed the mandarin that England possessed
+ships carrying 120 guns of larger caliber than those on board of the
+vessel he commanded; and that<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_179" id="Page_179">[179]</a></span> altogether, including large and small,
+the Queen of England had 800 vessels. This account was evidently
+discredited, as it always was when such an assertion was made in those
+seas, for looking round him and explaining the nature of the
+communication to his followers, they all laughed. Asang, the
+interpreter, then gave them a history of the Chinese war, on which he
+dwelt upon our immense resources, the size and number of our vessels,
+and the fire ships (steamers) which we had employed; but it was evident
+that the Quelpartians did not believe one word of his assertions. Before
+the conference was over, rice, cakes, and sam-schoo were handed round,
+and the captain promised that he would visit the chief mandarin on the
+following day. By this time, the ship had come to an anchor in the bay,
+and we returned on board.</p>
+
+<p>The next morning we got the ship under weigh, and brought her nearer to
+the town, so that her guns could be brought to bear in case of need; but
+when within 100 yards of the shore, and in the act of going about, the
+ship struck with great violence against a rock. Hawsers were laid out,
+and with our usual good fortune, we again got into deep water, and in
+half an hour anchored off the town in a favourable position for
+cannonading it. We then landed our force, consisting of all the marines,
+with the drummer and fiddler, besides a party of small-arm men from the
+blue jackets, all armed with muskets, bayonets, and cutlasses. The
+officers, in addition to their swords, carried pistols in their belts. A
+feu-de-joie was now fired, for the double purpose of creating an awe
+among the crowd, and ascertaining that all the muskets were in good
+order; for the mandarin resided some miles from the beach, and in case
+of attack we must have fought hard to regain our boats and the
+protection of the ship's guns. All being ready, the drummer and fiddler
+struck up a lively air, and we commenced our march towards the
+mandarin's house, the officers<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_180" id="Page_180">[180]</a></span> being accommodated with horses. After
+passing over a morass, the waters of which ran sluggishly through the
+arches of a bridge, connecting the suburbs with the city, we ascended a
+rocky eminence, from the summit of which we had a bird's eye view of the
+city, and some portion of the interior. We observed that the ramparts of
+the city were lined with people. Our train was nearly a mile in length,
+although the natives were walking ten or twelve abreast. Immediately
+after our party came the band of the natives, dressed in russet-coloured
+cloth, with shawls of the same material; after them the mandarin,
+followed by above 200 soldiers, a dense mob bringing up the rear, with
+flags and banners displayed.</p>
+
+<p>On the inland side of us was an immense plain, bounded in the distance
+by high mountains, whose tops were enveloped in clouds. This plain was
+mostly cultivated; that portion of it which was barren had been
+appropriated to burial grounds, several of which we passed through. At
+the head of the graves were stone figures intending to represent human
+beings, but Chantry had not been employed. At length, having walked
+round two-thirds of the walls, we entered a defile, leading to one of
+the gates of the city, but to our surprise, when we arrived at the gate,
+we found that it was locked, and when the cause was demanded, we were
+informed that the mandarin refused to allow the soldiers to enter, but
+that the officers would be admitted alone. This communication greatly
+irritated the captain, and our position caused us some uneasiness. We
+were inclosed within two high walls in a narrow lane, our advance
+prevented by the locked up gate, and our retreat must be through
+thousands who had formed the cavalcade, and were now in our rear. Our
+only passage was through this multitude, and I hardly need say that we
+were convinced of the treachery of the people. However, there was no
+time to be lost: the word was given, the marines formed a front line,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_181" id="Page_181">[181]</a></span>
+cocked their muskets, and then brought them to the charge bayonets; and
+in this way, the crowd retreating before us, we forced our way back,
+until we were again clear of the high walls which had flanked us; but
+our position even then was not pleasant. We had to pass the fort and
+several encampments before we could arrive at the beach, which was at
+least four miles distant. However, we put a good face on the matter, and
+forcibly detaining one of the mandarins upon the pretence that he must
+show us the way back, with the threat, that upon the slightest
+molestation on the part of his countrymen, we would blow his brains out,
+we commenced our march back to the beach, our two musicians playing with
+great energy, "Go to the devil and shake yourselves," which tune, struck
+up upon their own suggestion, was the occasion of great laughter among
+our party. At last we reached the beach without opposition, and the
+mandarin, who was terribly alarmed, was released.</p>
+
+<p>When we arrived, the chiefs attempted to throw all the blame upon the
+head mandarin, but the captain would no longer stand their humbug. He
+replied to them, that if any of their principal men had visited the ship
+they would have been treated with respect and kindness, and that the
+number of their armed retainers would have made no difference in their
+reception; that he considered them as faithless in all their
+protestations of good-will, and from thenceforth he should place no
+reliance on any thing that they said; that for the future he would act
+as he thought proper without consulting them, and that he would shoot
+any one who attempted to interfere with him. We then got into the boats
+and returned on board, where we heard that the cutter's crew had been
+compelled to kill or wound some of the natives, who had come down in a
+body and attacked one of the men with fire-brands. The cutter was at
+anchor a short distance from the shore; on the natives approaching they
+seized their muskets, but did not fire<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_182" id="Page_182">[182]</a></span> until their shipmate was in
+danger of his life. Two of the natives had fallen and had been carried
+off by their comrades.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="quelpartians" id="quelpartians"></a>
+<img src="images/182.jpg" width="600" height="393" alt="Quelpartians." />
+<div class="cap-horiz">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">QUELPARTIANS.</p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>The Quelpartians cultivate paddy (from which they distil their
+sam-schoo), sweet potatoes, and radishes, which, with shell-fish, form
+the principal articles of food with the lower classes. Pigs, bullocks,
+and fowls appeared to be plentiful, although we obtained but few. All
+their towns are enclosed with a stone wall; the houses are also built of
+stone, and mostly tiled with a species of red slate; but we had few
+opportunities of inspecting them, as the natives kept so strict a watch
+upon us, and so outnumbered us. These Coreans presented a strong
+contrast to the Loo Chooans, who are so polite in their manner and kind
+in their demeanour. These Quelpartians, on the contrary, are very
+unprepossessing in their appearance, rude and boisterous in their
+manner, and of very gross habits. They insisted upon feeling and
+inspecting every article of our clothing, even baring our breasts to
+ascertain their colour, and in many other respects proving themselves
+very annoying. This was submitted to at first, with the hope of securing
+their good-will, but afterwards very decided measures were taken to
+repulse these dirty wretches, whose clothes smelt most offensively. They
+have the high cheek bone and elongated eye of the Tartar, or northern
+Chinese, from whom I am inclined to think they are descended. The crown
+of the head is closely shaved, leaving a circle of long hair, which is
+tied in a knot on the top of the skull (similar to the people of Loo
+Choo), but without any ornament. Round the forehead is fastened a
+bandanna, about four inches in width, resembling fine net-work in
+texture, but it is made with horsehair. This is used to keep the hair in
+its proper position. But the most singular part of their costume is the
+hat, which is made of the same materials as the fillets: the brim is
+about four feet in width, and this gives to the wearer a very grotesque
+appearance. The crown in <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_183" id="Page_183">[183]</a></span>shape resembles a sugar-loaf with the top cut
+off, and is very small in diameter. It admits the top-knot of hair, and
+nothing more.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="mandarin" id="mandarin"></a>
+<img src="images/183.jpg" width="394" height="600" alt="Mandarin of Quelpart." />
+<div class="cap">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">MANDARIN OF QUELPART.<br />
+<small>(COREA.)</small>
+</p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>The lower orders generally wear a felt hat, but of the same dimensions
+and shape. The hats of the mandarins are secured on their heads by
+strings of amber beads and large ivory balls, and then passed under the
+chin. Rank is denoted by the peacock's feather in the hat. The army are
+distinguished by a tuft of red horsehair stuck in the crown. The
+respectable part of the inhabitants have several garments; the outer
+ones are of various colours, but the cut of them extends to all ranks. I
+can liken it to nothing but a long pinbefore, slit up in front, behind,
+and at the two sides. Under this they wear other garments, the texture
+and quality of which, as well as quantity, depend upon the wealth of the
+wearer. The sleeves of their dresses are wide and long. In spite of
+their thick mustachios and long flowing beards, they have the appearance
+of a very effeminate people.</p>
+
+<p>One evening we saw a large turtle asleep as we pulled along the coast. A
+Sandwich Islander, belonging to the gig's crew, went in the water and
+turned him, holding him in this position till a rope was made fast to
+him, and he was secured. At night we landed on a small island, and we
+cooked our prize for our supper. I mention it as a proof of the man's
+dexterity.</p>
+
+<p>Completed our survey of the Quelpart, and stood to the N. E. The next
+morning we found ourselves close to a labyrinth of islands, not laid
+down on any chart. The captain named the group after the ship; and,
+having in three days completed the survey of them, we stood further to
+the northward and eastward. It would be tedious to detail our surveying
+operations. We saw the main land of Corea, but did not go on shore; and
+our provisions getting low, we bore all for the southward. After calling
+again at Quelpart, where we remained a<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_184" id="Page_184">[184]</a></span> few days, we made sail for
+Nangasaki, a seaport town in the empire of Japan.</p>
+
+<p>We were some distance in the offing in sight of the town of Nangasaki,
+when several boats, gaily decorated with flags of various shades and
+colours, came out to meet the ship and accompany us to the anchorage.
+One of them brought a letter, written in mingled Dutch and French,
+inquiring from whence and why we came. The bearer, who was a great man
+in authority, desired the captain to anchor immediately; but this the
+captain refused, telling him that he should anchor his ship when and
+where he pleased. We afterwards discovered that these were all
+government boats, and that they were always placed as a guard upon any
+ship which visited Nangasaki.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="japboat" id="japboat"></a>
+<img src="images/184.jpg" width="500" height="272" alt="Japanese Boat" />
+<p class="caption">JAPANESE BOAT.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>The crews were all dressed alike, in chequered blue and white cotton
+dresses; the boats are propelled with sculls used as oars, the men
+keeping time to a monotonous song. Forts, or rather the ghosts of
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_185" id="Page_185">[185]</a></span>forts, appeared as if raised by magic; they were easily distinguished
+to be formed out of immense screens of coloured cotton, and they were
+surrounded by flags and pennons. Although not effective, their effect
+was good at a distance.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="japanese" id="japanese"></a>
+<img src="images/185.jpg" width="394" height="600" alt="Japanese" />
+<div class="cap">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">JAPANESE.</p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>In the evening, a large assembly of the principal men visited the ship;
+they wore very loose jackets and trowsers. The jackets reached no lower
+than the hips, where they were confined by a silk or silver girdle,
+containing two swords, one somewhat larger than the other. The handles
+and sheaths of their swords were beautifully inlaid with copper, and
+japanned in a very peculiar manner. They were very curious to know the
+name and use of every article which excited their attention, and we were
+much surprised at their display of so much theoretical knowledge. They
+particularly admired the touch-hole of our guns, which are fired with
+the detonating tube. The properties of the elevating screws were
+minutely examined; and we were inclined to believe that many of our
+visitors were artificers, sent on board to examine and make notes of
+every thing new.</p>
+
+<p>The Samarang was the first British man-of-war which had visited Nagasaki
+since the Phaeton, in 1808. The day after our arrival the chiefs sent
+off a present of pigs, fowls, and vegetables, but would receive nothing
+in return.</p>
+
+<p>I accompanied the master to a small island, to make observations.
+Several of the great men desired us to return to the ship, but we
+refused. They appeared greatly annoyed, and drew their hands across
+their throats, intimating that their heads would be forfeited for their
+breach of duty. However, seeing that we were determined to remain, they
+made a virtue of necessity, and consoled themselves by examining our
+instruments. A laughable occurrence took place while we were on shore.
+The cutter was at anchor about ten yards from the beach. Two of the crew
+having an argument, one of them drew his bayonet,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_186" id="Page_186">[186]</a></span> and made a lunge at
+the other in jest. Observing the natives looking on with amazement, and
+fancying that the men were engaged in deadly fray, it drew our attention
+to the scene. They no doubt came to the conclusion that we must be a
+desperate set of fellows, and killed one another upon the slightest
+provocation. At all events, this little incident appeared to have a very
+good effect, as the natives, who had continually been interfering with
+our observations, now left us, not wishing to be so near to people who
+were so prone to mischief.</p>
+
+<p>During the whole night we were surrounded by a squadron of boats, which,
+with lanterns lighted, and drums beating, continually moved round the
+ship, to intercept any boat leaving it. The captain, finding that the
+suspicious character of the Japanese would prevent any thing like
+correct surveying, which was the principal object of his visit to
+Nagasaki, determined upon leaving this inhospitable shore of Japan as
+soon as possible.</p>
+
+<p>On Sunday the 6th, we weighed, and although the weather was
+unfavourable, contrived to work out of soundings until 3 <small>P. M.</small>, when we
+made sail for Loo-Choo. At daylight we found ourselves abreast of a
+burning volcano. Dense clouds of smoke were issuing from a peaked
+island, about three miles distant. We soon afterwards landed upon an
+adjacent island, which, to our surprise, also began to smoke.</p>
+
+<p>The day was sultry, and without a breath of air, so that in a short
+time, the atmosphere we were in became overpowering; at last a fresh
+breeze sprang up, and the disagreeable sensation wore off. The whole of
+the islands between Loo-Choo and Japan appear to be volcanic, and at
+certain seasons of the year they break out in a similar manner to those
+which we saw. At noon the smoke from the large volcano became lurid; but
+whether this was the breaking out into flame, or from the rays of the
+sun pouring down upon the smoke, it was impossible<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_187" id="Page_187">[187]</a></span> to say, as we were
+then several miles off. During the whole of the following night we were
+becalmed, and during that time impelled, by a strong current, towards
+the volcanic island. Strange noises were heard, and large columns of
+smoke ascended from the crater, which, from there not being a breath of
+air, soon enveloped it from our sight. On the following day we again
+landed upon an island, some little distance to the southward of the
+volcano, which now vomited flames, ashes, and smoke, during the whole
+day. The master landed on another of these volcanic islands, but the
+showers of ashes and suffocating atmosphere soon drove him away.</p>
+
+<p>The captain had finished his observations on the first island where we
+landed, and we prepared to return on board. Since the morning the swell
+had got up considerably, causing the surf to break heavily on the rocks.
+However, the instruments were safely embarked in the boat; but while the
+captain was waiting for an opportunity to get in, a surf drove the boat
+on a shelving rock, and suddenly receding, her stern was dropped so low,
+while her bow remained fast, that she capsized. Although the officer and
+men in the boat had to swim for their lives, and were much bruised by
+being dashed against the rocks by the succeeding surf, fortunately no
+lives were lost; but all the instruments, to the value of about 150l.,
+went to the bottom, and, no doubt, have since the accident very much
+puzzled the sharks as to their use, as they often had done the natives
+of those seas. A signal was hoisted on the summit of the island for the
+ship to send boats to assist, and, on their arrival, the gig was baled
+out, and by sunset we were again on board.</p>
+
+<p>August 18th.&mdash;Exchanged numbers with her Majesty's ship Royalist, which
+was anchored in Napa Kiang harbour (Loo-Choo). At 3 <small>P. M.</small>, we anchored
+alongside of her, impatiently expecting letters by her, and we were not
+a little depressed at being disappointed. Still<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_188" id="Page_188">[188]</a></span> we had one comfort,
+which was that, instead of having brought us, as we expected, three
+months' provisions, to enable us to continue our survey, she had only
+fourteen days' provisions for us, which was not more than sufficient to
+carry us back to Hong Kong. Many and various were the surmises that this
+recall and alteration of our planned employment gave us; the most
+prevailing one was that our orders from England were at Hong Kong.
+Others supposed that the ship would be hove down, and subsequently
+condemned; but the rejoicing was universal at the idea that there would
+be some speedy end to our hardships and vexations.</p>
+
+<p>A day or two after our arrival the captain and senior officers landed,
+to partake of a dinner given by one of the principal mandarins. They
+were well plied with soup, fish, fowls, and sam-schoo, being attended on
+by minor mandarins. After dinner they were escorted through the town,
+accompanied by a large concourse of natives, who were kept by the police
+at a respectful distance. One of the multitude forced his way to join
+the captain's party, but was forcibly ejected, and preparations made to
+bamboo him, when, to the captain's surprise, he discovered that the
+unfortunate culprit was our greatest friend and ally during our visit to
+the Madjicosima islands. He had been christened Beaufort by our
+officers, in consequence of his accurate knowledge of all the shoals,
+bays, deeps, &amp;c. A word from the captain released him, and to the
+astonishment of the mob, the captain and officers shook him cordially by
+the hand, and made him walk in their company during the remainder of the
+day. We did not find out why Beaufort left Pa-tchsu-san, where he
+appeared to be one of the principal chiefs; while at Loo-Choo he
+appeared to have no rank whatever. August 21st.&mdash;Sailed for Loo-Choo,
+the Royalist in Company. After looking in at Pa-tschu-san, we made all
+sail for Hong Kong; but arriving off the island of Botel Tobago, we were
+annoyed with light<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_189" id="Page_189">[189]</a></span> airs and calms, varied with squalls and heavy rain.
+For several days we were at the mercy of the current, until, at length,
+we sighted Batan, and steered towards it. The wind still continuing
+light, the captain went in the gig, which was my boat, on board of the
+Royalist; and we soon left the Samarang far behind. We landed about
+three o'clock, and were received by the padre, the governor and his lady
+being at San Carlos. The commander of the Royalist and two of his
+officers landed with us, and were much pleased with the hospitality of
+the old priest. In the course of the evening the governor and his lady
+returned from San Carlos; we adjourned to his house, where we passed
+the evening. Several dances were performed by the native women; but we
+did not admire them&mdash;they shuffled with their feet, and threw their
+bodies into anything but graceful postures. At midnight we sat down to
+an excellent supper, and then returned on board of the Royalist. The
+following morning the ship was about three miles from the anchorage.
+Bidding adieu to our hosts, we pulled on board, and made sail for Hong
+Kong.</p>
+
+<p>September 8th.&mdash;It being calm, the ship's company were permitted to
+bathe. In a minute all those who could swim were in the water, playing
+about in every direction round the ship, and enjoying the luxury. While
+this continued, the man at the mast-head reported a shark close at hand.
+The word to come in quickly was given by the first lieutenant and all
+the officers. It required no second call&mdash;every one knew why, and swam
+to the ropes, which were thrown out in every direction. It was touch and
+go, as the saying is&mdash;one of the marines, who was last, was actually
+touched by the shark, who made at him; but before he could turn to bite,
+the fellow had jerked himself up out of his reach. It was very fortunate
+that the man at the mast-head kept so good a look-out, for generally
+they are more occupied with the gambols of the bathers than looking out
+for sharks.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_190" id="Page_190">[190]</a></span>
+As it was, many of the swimmers were so unnerved that it was with
+difficulty they could get out of the danger. After the men were on board
+again, the great object was to have revenge upon the animal who had thus
+put an end to the enjoyment. The shark-hook was baited with a piece of
+bull's hide, and the animal, who was still working up and down alongside
+the ship, hoping that he would still pick up a marine I presume, took
+the bait greedily, and was hauled on board. The axe was immediately at
+work at his tail, which was dismembered, and a score of knives plunged
+into his body, ripping him up in all directions. His eyes were picked
+out with fish-hooks and knives, and every indignity offered to him. He
+was then cut to pieces, and the quivering flesh thrown into the
+frying-pans, and eaten with a savage pleasure which we can imagine only
+to be felt by cannibals when devouring the flesh of their enemies.
+Certainly, if the cannibal nations have the same feeling towards their
+enemies which sailors have against sharks, I do not wonder at their
+adhering to this custom, for there was a savage delight in the eyes of
+every seaman in the ship as they assisted to cut to pieces and then
+devour the brute who would have devoured them. It was the madness of
+retaliation&mdash;an eye for an eye, and a tooth for a tooth.</p>
+
+<p>September 14th.&mdash;Arrived at Hong Kong, where we found the Castor, Vixen,
+and Espi&egrave;gle. The next day the Agincourt, D&aelig;dalus, Vestal, and
+Wolverine, arrived from Borneo, having been engaged with the pirates of
+Maludu Bay. The squadron had suffered a loss of one officer and eighteen
+men killed, and about double the number wounded. This heavy loss was
+occasioned by their having to cut through a large boom which the pirates
+had thrown across the creek within half pistol shot of their forts. But
+the official reports of Admiral Sir Thomas Cochrane have already been
+published, and I need not, therefore, enter into further particulars.
+One incident is,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_191" id="Page_191">[191]</a></span> perhaps, worthy of notice, as it shows the respect
+invariably paid by the British officers and seamen to a brave enemy,
+although a pirate. The colours from the pirates' fort had been twice
+shot away, when, to the surprise of the boat squadron, a native was seen
+to ascend, without regard to our fire, and nail the colours to the
+flagstaff. Instead of taking aim at him, he was enthusiastically cheered
+by the seamen; and, as if with one consent, the muskets were all
+dropped, and the firing discontinued until he had again got down under
+cover, and was safe. The boom being at length severed, the fort in a few
+minutes was in our possession. Our late first lieutenant, Mr. Heard, who
+had left our ship, in consequence of the treatment he received from the
+captain, was wounded in this attack. Mr. Wade was the first lieutenant
+who sailed from England in the Samarang, and who also left us, not being
+able to put up with the treatment he received. It is singular that poor
+Mr. Wade should be killed so soon after he left the ship, and that his
+successor, Mr. Heard, as soon as he also left us, should have been
+wounded. But these were not the only officers who had quitted the ship:
+Lieutenant Inglefield, who joined the ship as assistant-surveyor, was,
+like most of the other officers, soon under an arrest; and after having
+had a report spread against him that he was mad, he determined to leave
+the ship, and obtained his Admiralty discharge. The second master,
+appointed by the Admiralty as one of the assistant-surveyors, also left
+the ship, but was compelled to join again.</p>
+
+<p>A court-martial was now held on board of the Castor, to inquire into the
+conduct of Lieutenant Heard (our late first lieutenant), during the time
+that he served under Sir Edward Belcher. The court-martial had been
+demanded by Lieutenant Heard, in consequence of Sir Edward Belcher
+having written a private letter to Admiral Sir Thomas Cochrane, accusing
+Mr. Heard of conduct unbecoming an officer and a gentleman. The whole of
+the officers of the Samarang<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_192" id="Page_192">[192]</a></span> were subpoenaed, and there is no doubt
+what the result of the court-martial would have been; but the court was
+broken up on the plea that the charges were not <i>sufficiently specific</i>,
+as neither date nor circumstances were specified. Before the court broke
+up, however, they did so far justice to Lieutenant Heard, as to return
+his sword, and state that there was not the slightest stain upon his
+character, and that he was honourably acquitted. The reader may perhaps
+ask, why the court was dissolved? It was to save the honour of the
+cloth, that the court, composed of captains, came to that decision. Had
+the court-martial proceeded, what would it have proved?&mdash;that a superior
+officer had been guilty of slander, and had attempted by this means to
+ruin a most excellent officer. The court declared that the charges were
+not sufficiently specific. Surely, they were plain enough. Lieutenant
+Heard was charged with conduct unbecoming an officer and a gentleman&mdash;a
+charge sufficient to dismiss him the service, if it could have been
+proved. But let us reverse this case: suppose that Lieutenant Heard had
+thus slandered Sir Edward Belcher. Would the court of captains then have
+discovered that the charges were not sufficiently specific? Most
+certainly not. The trial would have proceeded, and the lieutenant, for
+making such false charges in a private letter, would have been dismissed
+with ignominy from the service.</p>
+
+<p>November 1st.&mdash;Sailed from Hong Kong, after a detention of some days, in
+consequence of a row between Admiral Sir Thomas Cochrane and our gallant
+captain; the admiral, as we understood, refusing to allow the Samarang
+to leave the port until Sir Edward Belcher had apologised for his
+insubordination towards him. After a detention of a few days, the
+apology was forced from Sir Edward Belcher, and we were permitted to get
+under weigh. Of course, I cannot exactly vouch for the correctness of
+this statement, but such was the <i>on dit</i> of the
+<!--text after here originally on Pg. 194. Pg 193 was wholly occupied by
+illustrations 169a and 169b.jpg which in the html had to be moved to the paragra[h
+break below -->day. On the second we
+experienced a heavy gale, and the Royalist, who was with us as a tender,
+parted company. After a weary beat of nineteen days, we arrived at
+Batan, the capital of the Bashee islands; but I have already described
+this place. We remained here eight days, anxiously expecting the
+Royalist, but she did not make her appearance, and we concluded that she
+must have received some injury in the gale, and had borne up for
+Manilla. We sailed for that place, and arrived there on the 2d of
+December. Our conjectures relative to the Royalist were correct: she was
+here at anchor, having crippled her foremast in the gale, so as to
+render it necessary for her to bear up for this port.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_193" id="Page_193">[193]</a></span></p>
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="salt" id="salt"></a>
+<img src="images/193a.jpg" width="400" height="308" alt="First of Two Salt Smugglers" />
+</div>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<img src="images/193b.jpg" width="400" height="308" alt="Second of Two Salt Smugglers" />
+<p class="caption">SALT SMUGGLERS.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_194" id="Page_194">[194]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>We had always enjoyed ourselves at this place. During our repeated
+visits we had made many acquaintances and friends, and it was with no
+small pleasure that we found that we were to remain here till the first
+day of the new year.</p>
+
+<p>It is the custom at Manilla for the inhabitants to throw most of their
+houses open on that day: any one may enter, and be sure of a hearty
+welcome from the hospitable Spaniards. We anticipated great
+pleasure,-and we did nothing but talk about it, as our last Christmas
+Day had been a most dreary one, and we were delighted at the idea of
+passing this one among hospitable and civilised people. The reader may
+therefore imagine our disgust and vexation when, on the 23d, without our
+having the least notice of his intention, the captain gave orders for
+the anchor to be weighed, and ran the ship down to Caviti, a town about
+seven miles distant. Caviti was deserted; all the inhabitants had gone
+to Manilla to enjoy the holidays; not a soul remained to welcome us; but
+if they had, it would have been of no good to us, as, on Christmas
+morning, about two o'clock, we were almost all of us sent on shore to
+take a set of magnetic observations, which were not completed until the
+same hour on the following day. At the same<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_195" id="Page_195">[195]</a></span> time, to make "assurance
+doubly sure" that we should have no pleasure on that day, leave was
+stopped to all those remaining on board of the ship. I will not enter
+further into this affair. All I shall say is, that Christmas Day, the
+day of rejoicing, the day of good-will, was turned into one in which the
+worst passions were roused, and in which "curses not loud but deep" were
+levelled at the head of the man who, "dressed in a little brief
+authority," took this opportunity of exercising the power entrusted to
+him. After completing the observations, we moved further down the Bay,
+and surveyed the shoals of St. Nicholas; after which we returned to
+Manilla, where all gaiety had ceased.</p>
+
+<p>Caviti was once a place of great importance, having been the capital of
+Luzon, from whence the galleons conveyed the treasure to Spain. The
+arsenal still remains, but in a very dilapidated state: we found the
+artificers busily employed completing some gun-boats and small
+schooners, which were intended to accompany the Esperanza, Spanish
+frigate, in an expedition to an island off Borneo, where the Esperanza
+had latterly sustained a defeat from the pirates who inhabited the
+island.</p>
+
+<p>At Caviti lie the remains of an old Spanish galleon, one of the few
+which had the good fortune to escape Commodore Anson. The whole of one
+side of the vessel is gone, and she is now fast falling to pieces, but
+the Spaniards look upon her with great reverence. She is a relic of
+their former grandeur; and I was informed by a Spanish gentleman that
+she never would be broken up. I looked upon her, if not with reverence,
+at least with sympathy; and as I made a sketch of her my thoughts
+naturally turned to the rise and fall of empires, and I communed with
+myself as to what would be the date in which England would be in the
+same position as modern Spain, and fall back upon her former glories by
+way of consolation for her actual decay.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="galleon" id="galleon"></a>
+<img src="images/196.jpg" width="500" height="470" alt="Spanish Galleon" />
+<p class="caption">SPANISH GALLEON.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_196" id="Page_196">[196]</a></span>On our arrival at Manilla, whether it was that the captain thought that
+we might too readily console ourselves for our Christmas disappointment,
+or that he had heard (which I doubt not was the case) the expressions of
+disgust which had been so universal, we found that all leave was
+stopped. A few of us, not relishing this confinement without just cause,
+made our appearance on shore in plain clothes; for we had become
+reckless. We could but be turned out of the ship and out of the service:
+we longed for the first most especially, and were<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_197" id="Page_197">[197]</a></span> not alarmed at the
+prospect of the second. But although the captain was very willing to
+oblige us with the latter as soon as he had done with us, upon the
+paying off of the ship, he was not at all inclined to enter into our
+views as to the former; for he knew that he never would get another
+officer to join him. He therefore took all the work he could out of us
+for the present, bottling up his indignation for a future opportunity.</p>
+
+<p>We visited the cigar manufactory. About three thousand women are daily
+employed in making and packing up the cigars. One party selects, cleans,
+and moistens the leaf; a second cuts; a third rolls; another packs them;
+and thus they are passed through a variety of hands before they are
+completed. The best cheroots made here are sent to the royal family, and
+are called Finas. No. 3. are the next best: of these there are two
+kinds&mdash;one for consumption, another for exportation. The cheroots sold
+in England under the name of Government Manillas are of inferior
+quality. In consequence of the failure in the preceding tobacco crop,
+cheroots were very scarce during the time we were at Manilla.</p>
+
+<p>There is a fine lace sold at Manilla, called Pina-work. It is made by
+the women of an island bearing that name, which is close to Luzon.
+Although not so fine as some of the European manufactures, it fetches
+very high prices in this country. There is not sufficient made for
+exportation.</p>
+
+<p>The night on which we went on shore contrary to orders proved to be a
+festival, and the city was illuminated. There is a variety in
+illuminations all over the world, as those who have been to various
+countries well know. The lower classes of Manilla construct animals of
+all sorts, ships, &amp;c. out of coloured paper&mdash;very good imitations of the
+reality&mdash;and these they illuminate by putting candles within them. We
+had amused ourselves with looking at the variety of objects<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_198" id="Page_198">[198]</a></span> exhibited
+by the various whims of the illuminating parties, when, on passing
+through a street, we observed a large illuminated pig&mdash;such a beauty! He
+was standing at the door of a shop, and the owner was quite proud of our
+unqualified admiration. We examined him very carefully, and at last we
+unfortunately discovered that he was fixed on a board with four wheels.
+Wheels naturally reminded us that they were vehicles of locomotion; the
+pig could move&mdash;that was certain&mdash;and we decided that, if possible, pig
+must go on board of the Samarang. This was agreed to, <i>nem. con.</i>, by
+all parties, with the exception of the owner, who was not summoned to
+the consultation, which, I grant, was an omission. A ball of twine, some
+fifty fathoms long, was purchased, and stretched along the street, so as
+to give us a good start in case of a rescue. We manned it with all hands
+except one, who was appointed to make it fast to the pig, which he
+effected with great dexterity, and without being perceived. As soon as
+he rejoined us, off we set, followed by pig, who galloped and capered
+down the streets in capital style, preserving his equilibrium in a most
+astonishing manner.</p>
+
+<p>But the owner of the pig soon discovered his loss, and gave the signal
+for the chase. As we passed the gates, the soldiers joined in the
+pursuit, and a large mob followed; but pig beat them all, and arrived
+safely at the hotel where we resided. Of course, the owner soon came in
+to claim his property; but he was so nobly remunerated for his animal,
+which became ours by purchase, that he went away jingling the money, and
+agreeing with us that it was an excellent joke. We placed our pig in the
+centre of the table, and passed our last night at Manilla in a most
+agreeable manner.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="luzon" id="luzon"></a>
+<img src="images/199a.jpg" width="600" height="399" alt="Natives of Luzon" />
+<div class="cap-horiz">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">NATIVES OF LUZON.</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>We then sailed again for Caviti, which was now again inhabited. The
+society is confined to the families of the civil and military officers
+who are stationed there. Some of the villages in the vicinity of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_199" id="Page_199">[199]</a></span> Caviti
+are very picturesque: the bamboos planted on each side of the road meet
+over head, and form shady lanes. The women at these villages were
+handsomer than any I had seen at Luzon, and were dressed very
+tastefully. A petticoat, reaching from the hips to between the knees and
+ankles, a not too jealous boddice of light muslin, their long hair
+flowing down their backs, and a neat straw hat, composed as graceful a
+costume as I have ever witnessed. See two of these girls, both riding
+one pony, taking eggs to Caviti, as they pass through the shady lanes,
+and you cannot desire a more agreeable picture.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="water" id="water"></a>
+<img src="images/199b.jpg" width="550" height="448" alt="Water Carriers&mdash;Manilla" />
+<p class="caption">WATER CARRIERS&mdash;MANILLA.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>January 3rd.&mdash;From this day till the 20th of February we were surveying
+various portions of the Phillippine group; but as there is nothing<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_200" id="Page_200">[200]</a></span> to
+interest the reader, I shall pass over a dry catalogue of mostly
+uninhabited islands. One of the islands was covered with cocoa-nut
+trees. We found on it some Malays, who had come there on an annual
+visit, and were loading their boats with the nuts. They were the rudest
+of the Malay tribe we had yet seen. Every article in our possession
+excited their cupidity, and they expressed their wonder and admiration
+by clacking their tongues against the roofs of their mouths, and
+emitting a very strange sound. A needle was valued by them at ten
+cocoa-nuts, a button at five. For the value of a few shillings we filled
+the ship with those highly esteemed fruit. On the 21st of February we
+proceeded to Samboangan, a Spanish penal settlement at the south
+extremity of Mindanao. The town, which is insignificant, is built on a
+plain. Most of the houses are constructed of leaves and bamboo,
+supported by stakes. The governor, however, and some of the most
+respectable of the inhabitants, occupy neat little white-washed
+cottages. There is a fine fort, in good condition, and mounting several
+guns, which is garrisoned by about 400 Manilla troops.</p>
+
+<p>The town is surrounded nearly by groves of cocoa-nut trees and bananas,
+and the roads cut through them form pleasant shady walks. The plain on
+which the town is built is well cultivated, and watered by a fine river.
+It is bounded by a range of mountains, which separate the Spanish
+possessions from the country inhabited by the warlike natives of the
+interior. The people appear well-conditioned and industrious, and are
+remarkably neat in their dress and persons. There are several gun boats
+stationed here, which are employed to scour the coast of the pirates,
+who are very numerous and formidable.</p>
+
+<p>Horses can be obtained here in any quantity, but saddles and bridles are
+scarce. Unfortunately, there is nothing so civilised here as an hotel,
+so few vessels visiting the port. The little commerce that<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_201" id="Page_201">[201]</a></span> exists is
+carried on by small schooners which run between this island and Manilla.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="samboangan" id="samboangan"></a>
+<img src="images/201.jpg" width="600" height="394" alt="View in Samboangan" />
+<div class="cap-horiz">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">VIEW IN SAMBOANGAN.<br />
+<small>(MINDANAO.)</small></p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>I have mentioned that this is the penal settlement of the Spanish
+colonies. The prisoners are confined within the fort, and there is none
+of that awe of restraint and doubtful position which you find in a place
+where half the population consists of liberated convicts. It is a
+flourishing and happy little colony. Many officers of an inferior grade
+reside here, holding appointments either in the fort, gaol, or the gun
+boats. These people and their wives are Mestichas (or half-breed), and
+it is among them and their families that some of the prettiest women in
+the Asiatic archipelago may be found.</p>
+
+<p>Our first object after we were on shore was to procure horses, that we
+might have a view of the country, as far as prudence would admit. We
+were surprised at starting to find such fine roads, lined with gardens
+and cottages, embowered in groves of cocoa-nut, bananas, and bamboos.
+Where the road was not shaded, arches of wood were raised to protect
+passengers from the heat of the sun. The whole country was alive with
+natives, dressed in every variety of colour, and sledges drawn by water
+buffaloes, carrying fruit, vegetables, and Indian corn. We put our
+horses to a swift canter, and passed through many villages, all in
+appearance as populous, as thriving, and as happy as Samboangan. At last
+we arrived at an open plain, covered with cattle, and bounded by the
+mountains in the distance. We remained some time admiring and sketching;
+the inhabitants showed us every kindness, and were more courteous in
+their demeanour than might be expected from their isolation from the
+rest of the world.</p>
+
+<p>On our return, we stopped at a little shop by the road side, close to
+the town. It contained fruit, grain, and tobacco; but ascertaining that
+coffee and chocolate could be had here, we ordered some of the latter,
+which proved to be excellent, and moderate in price. This<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_202" id="Page_202">[202]</a></span> little shop,
+for want of an hotel, became our principal rendezvous during our stay
+here.</p>
+
+<p>About nightfall, as we were strolling through the town, we were
+attracted by the sounds of music in an adjoining street. We altered our
+course accordingly, and on arrival at a large thatched house, perceived
+through the open windows that it was filled with musicians and dancers.
+We were immediately observed, and the owner of the house, in the most
+courteous manner, and in tolerable English, requested us to enter, which
+request we immediately complied with. We imagined that it was a ball,
+perhaps a wedding; but what was our surprise on entering to see a table
+in the middle of the room, on which was placed a dead child! It was
+neatly dressed, and ornamented with flowers, looking more like a wax
+doll than a corpse. The ball, we were informed, was given in honour of
+its funeral. The dancing had not yet commenced, so we were in excellent
+time. The master of the house was extremely polite, and requested that
+we would consider ourselves at home. We took his advice, and immediately
+separated, and paid our addresses to the ladies which most interested us
+by their appearance. A great many of them were exceedingly pretty, and
+they were dressed enchantingly. Their hair was drawn back, and collected
+in a knot behind, their bosoms covered by a light muslin jacket with
+short sleeves. A petticoat of many colours was sufficiently short to
+disclose their naked feet, on which was a slipper of velvet, embroidered
+with gold or silver lace. Two or three great gold ornaments completed
+their costume. Add to this their sparkling black eyes, regular features,
+and an air of naivet&eacute;&mdash;inseparable from Spanish girls, and you have some
+idea of the witchery of the belles of Samboangan.</p>
+
+<p>We were very soon on excellent terms, and the table with the dead child
+being removed to a corner, the father and mother of the deceased opened
+the ball with a slow waltz. This being concluded, we selected<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_203" id="Page_203">[203]</a></span> our
+partners, and a livelier air being struck up, off we all went at a
+splendid pace. The women waltzed well. The music was excellent. In the
+first round all the ladies lost their slippers, which were without
+heels; and in the second the pace became fearful, and the old house
+shook under the active bounds and springs of some twenty or thirty
+couples.</p>
+
+<p>Spanish quadrilles succeeded the waltz, and then we had the country
+dance. This latter is complicated, but very pretty, and, with the
+assistance of our partners, in a short time we were quite <i>au fait</i> to
+its mysteries.</p>
+
+<p>The music, which consisted of violins and guitars, bore up
+indefatigably. About twelve o'clock we ceased dancing, and preparations
+were made for supper. This was laid on the floor, clean grass mats
+serving as table cloths. The contents of the dishes were of the most
+novel description, and rice was the only article which I could recognise
+as unmixed. The repast spread, the host requested us to place ourselves.
+I followed my pretty partner's example, and came to an anchor on the
+floor alongside of her. I was most assiduous in helping her to whatever
+she pointed out; and, as nearly as I can recollect, the plate contained
+a curious medley of rice, prawns, fowls' legs, apples, besides other
+articles unknown, at least to me. I had observed a total want of knives,
+forks, and spoons, but this was explained when I saw that all ate with
+their fingers. Seeing no objection to this primitive plan, I was about
+getting a plate for myself, when I was informed by my partner, in the
+most insinuating way, that I was to consider her plate as my own. I
+fully appreciated the compliment, and at once commenced, assisting her
+to demolish the pile that I had collected, as I thought, for her use
+alone. On looking round I found that we were not singular, and that
+every couple were, like us, dipping into one dish. Never was there a
+more merry and delightful<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_204" id="Page_204">[204]</a></span> supper. As soon as it was over, which was not
+very soon, for I could have gone on eating a long while for the very
+pleasure of meeting the pretty little fingers in the plate, we rose, the
+mats and dishes were cleared away, and we resumed the dancing, and it
+was at a late hour that we made our <i>buenas nochas</i> to the fair girls of
+Samboangan.</p>
+
+<p>We remained in this delightful little place for two days. Many of us
+were inclined to remain there for life, if we could have escaped. We
+made several excursions into the interior, and the more we saw the more
+we were convinced that no place was so pretty as Samboangan.</p>
+
+<p>March 3d.&mdash;Anchored in a port at Baselan, where the Spaniards had very
+lately founded a colony. We found them very busy felling trees, clearing
+backwood, and completing the stockade or fort. The natives of Baselan
+are a courageous race, and were continually attacking the Spaniards,
+occasionally with success. Two gun boats were lying off the town, but
+the Spanish force is not sufficient to meet the attacks of the natives,
+who continually surprise their outposts and decapitate their prisoners.
+On our arrival a discharge of guns and fire-arms was kept up during the
+whole night, fully proving the trouble which the Spaniards would have in
+establishing and retaining their settlement here. It was a few miles
+from this that the French were beaten off by the Malays or pirates, for
+the terms are at Baselan synonymous.</p>
+
+<p>March 5th.&mdash;Having completed the survey of this port, we made sail for
+Balam-bangan. On our route we stopped at Cagayan Sooloo, where we fell
+in with two piratical prahus. For reasons, not explained, these vessels
+were not interfered with, although there was not the least doubt of
+their occupation.</p>
+
+<p>March 9.&mdash;The ship struck several times while threading her way<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_205" id="Page_205">[205]</a></span> through
+a line of dangerous shoals to the eastward of Bangay; and on the same
+evening we arrived at Balam-bangan.</p>
+
+<p>The Royalist had been despatched about a month before to Sincapore, to
+obtain provisions to enable us to survey the coast of Borneo.
+Balam-bangan was the rendezvous appointed, and we expected to have found
+her anchored there; but in this we were disappointed. The survey of
+Balam-bangan was now commenced, and during our survey we discovered the
+remains of the old English settlement. It may be as well here to
+concisely narrate the history of its rise and fall. About the year 1766,
+four ships, filled with troops and every thing requisite for the
+formation of a colony, arrived at Balam-bangan, which was formally taken
+possession of in the name of his Britannic Majesty. But unexpected
+difficulties arose one after the other. The natives of Bangay, about
+three miles distant, were hostile, and made repeated attacks upon them.
+The soil was discovered not to be of that fertile nature which had been
+represented; and unfortunately two of the ships were thrown on shore in
+a gale, and every soul on board perished. These several disasters damped
+their energies, and created a feeling of distrust among the settlers,
+but still the original intention was not abandoned. The forts were
+completed, a few houses rose, and as their comfort and security
+increased, so did their hopes arise, and they worked with renewed
+vigour. But their prosperous state excited the jealousy of the people of
+Sooloo, which island is the emporium of the commerce between Borneo and
+the other islands. The ruling powers of Sooloo considered that this
+commerce must fall off if the English established themselves on an
+island so well adapted for it in every respect as Balam-bangan, and they
+resolved to attack the colony in its infant state. Perhaps they had
+another reason, which was that they anticipated a rich booty, if
+successful, and no doubt they were not disappointed. The attack was made
+with an overwhelming<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_206" id="Page_206">[206]</a></span> force, and the English, although they bore
+themselves bravely, could not resist it. Most of the colonists were
+butchered, some few gained the ships in the harbour and sailed away to
+the port from which the expedition was fitted out. Since that time no
+further attempt to colonise this island has been made, nor, indeed, is
+it likely that there will be, as Labuan is much more advantageously
+situated in every respect.</p>
+
+<p>The Royalist at last arrived: she had but few letters, but, valuable and
+dear to us as letters always were, she brought intelligence that made
+every heart, except one, beat with delight. Was it possible? Yes, it was
+true&mdash;true! We were <i>ordered home</i>. Oh, the delight, the frantic joy,
+which was diffused through the whole ship. To have witnessed the scene
+we should have been considered as mad. Every one embracing one another,
+shaking hands, animosities reconciled at once, all heart-burnings
+forgotten: we could have hugged every thing we met&mdash;dogs, monkeys,
+pigs&mdash;except the captain. All our sufferings and privations were
+forgotten in the general ecstasy, and, although thousands of leagues
+were still to be run before we could arrive at the desired goal, and
+months must pass away, time and space were for the time annihilated,
+and, in our rapture, we fancied and we spoke as if we were within reach
+of our kindred and our homes. Could it be the Samarang that we were on
+board of?&mdash;the same ship that we were in not one hour ago?&mdash;the silent,
+melancholy vessel, now all hands laughing, screaming, huzzaing, dancing,
+and polkaing up and down the deck like maniacs? And then when the
+excitement was a little over, and we became more rational, Why were we
+ordered home? was the first surmise. We had been sent out on a seven
+years' expedition, and we had not yet been out four. The surveys were
+not half finished. Was it the row that the captain had had with the
+admiral, and the reports of many officers who had quitted <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_207" id="Page_207">[207]</a></span>the ship? We
+made up our minds at last that it must have been upon the
+representations of the admiral to the Admiralty that we had been ordered
+home. There could be no other reason. We drank his health in nine times
+nine.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="pirate" id="pirate"></a>
+<img src="images/207.jpg" width="394" height="600" alt="Illanoan Pirate" />
+<div class="cap">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">ILLANOAN PIRATE.<br />
+<small>(TAMPASSOOK, BORNEO.)</small></p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>On the 24th of March we sailed from Balam-bangan, with the intention of
+making a flying survey of the coast of Borneo, as far as the island of
+Labuan and the country at Sarawak, to make the best of our way to
+Sincapore, at which place we hoped to arrive about the 1st of May, there
+to receive our final orders and start for England. It would be tedious,
+and it is not necessary, to give a description of the survey which we
+afterwards made. We went over the same ground as before, and we surveyed
+with a musket in one hand and a sextant in the other, for the natives
+were not to be trusted. Our warlike friends at Tampassook did not much
+relish our re-appearance on their coast. A Spanish slave made his escape
+from them and came on board, begging a passage to any where. He had been
+taken prisoner, with six or seven others, in an engagement between the
+Manilla gun boats and the Illanoan pirates, and had been very cruelly
+treated. We learnt from this man that the pirates of Tampassook are very
+rich, and possessed a large number of fine prahus. They had also plenty
+of fire-arms, but were afraid of them, preferring their own weapons.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_208" id="Page_208">[208]</a></span></p>
+<a name="pirateboat" id="pirateboat"></a>
+<img src="images/208.jpg" width="600" height="238" alt="Illanoan Pirates" />
+<p class="caption">ILLANOAN PIRATES.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>It was here that we heard the news of the murder of our old friends
+Rajah Muda and Bud-ruddeen. It appeared that they had been accused of
+being privy to the attack of the English on Maludu, and supporting our
+claims to the island of Labuan. Bud-ruddeen died as he had lived, a
+brave man, and worthy of a better fate. On the approach of his enemies
+he retired to his house with his sister and favourite wife, both of whom
+insisted upon sharing his destiny. For some time he fought like a lion
+against a superior force, until his<!--text to here was part of page 207. Page 208
+was wholly occupied by the illustration 208.jpg -->
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_209" id="Page_209">[209]</a></span> servants one by one fell dead. He
+then retired dangerously wounded to an inner chamber, with his wife and
+sister, and, allowing his enemies to follow him till the house was
+filled with them, he fired his pistol into a barrel of gunpowder, which
+had been placed in readiness, and at once destroyed himself, his
+friends, and his enemies. But this barbarous murder on the part of the
+sultan of Borneo and his advisers was not left unpunished. Sir Thomas
+Cochrane went to Bruni with his squadron, and reduced the sultan to
+submission and a proper respect for the English, and those who were
+friendly with them.</p>
+
+<p>As we approached Labuan we found it necessary to be on the <i>qui vive</i>,
+as all the natives were hostile to us, and would have cut off our
+surveying parties if they had had a chance. In the bay of Gaya, we met a
+brother of Bud-ruddeen. He was the Rajah of the small province of
+Kalabutan. Both he and his followers burned to revenge the death of a
+man so universally beloved as Rajah Muda, and offered to accompany us
+with their whole force to attack the city of Bruni. They came on board
+of us with fowls, eggs, and fruits. They placed little value on dollars,
+preferring white linen, handkerchiefs, and bottles, to any other article
+in the way of traffic. We, therefore, as we were so soon going to
+England, made no ceremony of parting with our old clothes in exchange
+for stock; and the next vessel that visits the river will be surprised
+at the quantity of midshipmen's jackets, sailors' hats, and marines'
+boots, which will be worn by the inhabitants, in addition to their own
+costume. Mr. Adams, the assistant surgeon, had obtained permission to
+accept the Rajah's invitation to visit the town, which was some five or
+six miles up the river. He saw nothing worthy of remark except some of a
+tribe of aborigines (Dusums). Their only covering consisted of large
+metal rings worn round the neck and hips.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="nativesne" id="nativesne"></a>
+<img src="images/210a.jpg" width="500" height="496" alt="Natives Of N. E. Coast of Borneo" />
+<p class="caption">NATIVES OF N. E. COAST OF BORNEO.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_210" id="Page_210">[210]</a></span>While a party were observing on shore, a short distance to the northward
+of Kalabutan, they were fired at by a party of natives concealed in the
+jungle. The only person who was wounded was the Spaniard, whom we had
+rescued at Tampassook, who was standing by the captain. The ball passed
+through his arm, and grazed his body. The arms were handed out of the
+gig, which was close at hand, and the enemy retreated into the wood. The
+cutter then joined, and having a three-pounder on her bows, opened fire
+upon the natives, who had re-assembled.. The first two or three shots
+passed over their heads, and encouraged by no injury being done to them,
+they came forward dancing, yelling, drawing their knives and spears in
+defiance. But a shot passing through the body of the chief set them all
+off. <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_211" id="Page_211">[211]</a></span>They bore him away on their shoulders, and did not afterwards make
+their appearance. After cannonading the village for an hour, and doing
+them all the mischief that we could, by destroying their fortifications,
+burning one and carrying off another prahu, we returned on board, and
+then made sail for the island of Labuan, where we arrived on the 25th of
+April, 1846. Here our surveying was completed, and we made the best of
+our way to Sarawak, where we arrived on the 30th of April. We learnt all
+the news of the little colony from Dr. Treecher, who came to visit us.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="dusum" id="dusum"></a>
+<img src="images/210.jpg" width="394" height="600" alt="Dusum" />
+<div class="cap">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">DUSUM.<br />
+<small>(N. COAST OF BORNEO.)</small></p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>We found that Mr. Brooke had been recognised by Government, and that
+Captain Bethune had been testing the capability of making Labuan a coal
+d&eacute;pot. Poor Williamson, the interpreter, and a great friend of ours, had
+been drowned some months previous, while crossing the river at night in
+a small canoe, and no doubt fell a prey to the alligators. He was not
+only a very amiable, but a very clever fellow, and his loss was deeply
+felt by every body.</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Brooke was absent from Kuchin on an expedition to the Sakarran
+river, in the Phlegethon steamer, to inquire into the particulars, and
+punish, if necessary, an attack upon his Dyak allies by the natives of
+Sakarran. Two Sakarran chiefs, accompanied by a great many war prahus,
+had paid a visit to Mr. Brooke, and had been entertained by him in his
+usual hospitable manner. At their departure he loaded the chiefs with
+presents, for which they appeared to be extremely grateful. As a return
+for this kindness, and to prove their sincerity as allies, the principal
+chief left his son, a boy of twelve years of age, with Mr. Brooke. But
+notwithstanding that this boy was as a hostage, they could not resist an
+opportunity of plunder, and that very evening they ascended one of the
+tributary streams of the Sarawak, attacked a village, and brought off
+with them twenty-seven heads of the unfortunate Dyaks. When the news<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_212" id="Page_212">[212]</a></span>
+arrived, Mr. Brooke was so much enraged at their treachery, that he
+almost determined upon sacrificing the boy chief, as the natives
+expected; but not wishing to visit the sins of the father upon the lad,
+who was innocent, and fearful that his own people would not be so
+forbearing, he returned the boy to his parents. We all felt annoyed that
+we had not an opportunity of bidding farewell to Mr. Brooke, and
+thanking him for his kindness to us whenever he had an opportunity of
+showing it. He was, indeed, beloved by every body who had the pleasure
+of his acquaintance.</p>
+
+<p>Sailed for Sincapore. The next night we communicated with the Julia (Mr.
+Brooke's vessel). She had on board Captain Elliott, and twenty-five
+sepoys<a name="FNanchor_3_3" id="FNanchor_3_3"></a><a href="#Footnote_3_3" class="fnanchor">[3]</a>, who were to be stationed as a garrison at Kuchin. We were
+much pleased to find that Government had taken up this cause so warmly,
+and that Mr. Brooke was likely to be recognised by it, after all his
+individual exertions. Our passage to Sincapore proved very tedious, all
+hands upon short allowance, and no grog. We touched at Barren Island,
+and obtained a large quantity of sea birds' eggs, but they were mostly
+rotten; but this did not prevent our making omelets of them, for we were
+now with only three days' provisions on board at half allowance, and the
+calm still continued. Three days we were in sight of the island, the
+sails flapped idly against the masts, and not a breath disturbed the
+surface of the ocean wave. We thought of the tale of the Ancient
+Mariner, and there were not wanting those on board who declared that
+this continued calm was a judgment upon us, not for shooting an
+albatross, but for robbing the nests of the eggs.</p>
+
+<p>Our barges were sent to Sincapore for provisions, for famine was staring
+us in the face, but that same night a breeze sprang up, and <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_213" id="Page_213">[213]</a></span>on the 20th
+of May we dropped our anchor in the roads. At Sincapore we found the
+Hazard, 18, whose crew suffered so much at New Zealand; and here also we
+found, to our inexpressible delight, our orders for England, of which we
+had begun to have some doubts. On the 14th of June arrived the Admiral,
+in H. M. S. Agincourt, towed by the Spitfire steamer. As soon as he was
+joined by the rest of the squadron, it was the intention of Sir T.
+Cochrane to make sail for Bruni, and punish the six-fingered sultan and
+his piratical advisers.</p>
+
+<p>Sincapore, like all new settlements, is composed of so mixed a
+community, that there is but little hospitality, and less gaiety. Every
+one is waiting to ascertain what is to be his position in society, and
+till then is afraid of committing himself by friendly intercourse;
+moreover, every body is too busy making money. The consequence is, but
+few parties are given, and a ball is so rare that it becomes the subject
+of conversation for months. There are some good-looking girls at
+Sincapore, but it is only at church or on parade that a stranger obtains
+a glimpse of them. Prudery is at present the order of the day, and this
+is carried to such an extent from non-intercourse, that at a farewell
+ball given to the Cambrians, the women would only polka and waltz with
+each other.</p>
+
+<p>The country immediately outside the town of Sincapore is spotted with
+little bungaloes, the retreat of the merchants from the monotonous
+business-life which they are compelled to lead. The plantations of
+nutmegs and beetle-nut which surround these country residences are very
+luxuriant; and at this time the fruit was on the trees, and the odour
+quite delightful. One male tree is planted for every ten females. Very
+little cloves or cinnamon are grown at this settlement, but I saw some
+specimens. A nutmeg tree is valued, when it once arrives to full
+bearing, at a guinea a year. The Areca-palm is a very<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_214" id="Page_214">[214]</a></span> beautiful tree,
+and requires but little attention: these and cocoa-nut are valued at a
+dollar per year. Large quantities of sugar-cane are now grown here, and
+some fine sugar-mills are built in the vicinity of the town. The roads
+are kept in good repair by the convicts, and are now really very
+respectable.</p>
+
+<p>The Chinese joss-house here is considered very fine, and I made a
+drawing of it. It has some good stone carving and figures, but is very
+inferior to that of Ningpo. During the time that I was drawing it was
+filled with Chinese, who were very inquisitive and troublesome: the only
+method I could devise for keeping them off was by filling a bowl full of
+vermilion, and when their curiosity overcame their prudence, and they
+came rubbing up against me, daubing their faces with the colour&mdash;this
+plan, accompanied with a kick, proved effectual.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="convict" id="convict"></a>
+<img src="images/215.jpg" width="426" height="500" alt="Convict" />
+<p class="caption">CONVICT.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>Sincapore being the penal settlement of India, there are a large number
+of convicts here, who are chained, and work at the roads and bridges.
+One night I visited the gaol, and was taken over it by an overseer. We
+first visited the Chinese department. Two long benches ran along the
+room, on which were stretched some thirty men. As the overseer passed he
+struck each man with his rattan, and in a moment they were all sitting
+up, rubbing their eyes, and looking as innocent as possible. They were
+all confined for murder, and were a most rascally-looking set. From this
+room we proceeded to another, fitted in the same manner, and filled with
+Indians. Many of them were branded on the forehead with "Doomga," which
+signifies murder; and in some cases the brand was both in Hindostanee
+and English. Leaving them, we entered a small room close to the gates of
+the gaol, and guarded by a sentry. In this room were confined the most
+reckless characters. They were but eight in number. Parallel to the
+bench ran a long iron rod, and to this they were shackled, both<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_215" id="Page_215">[215]</a></span> hands
+and feet. The first man among them pointed out to me by the overseer was
+a fine-looking grey-bearded Indian, of great stature, and with the eyes
+of a tiger. He had been formerly a rich shipowner at Bombay; but having
+been convicted of insuring his vessels to a large amount, and then
+setting fire to them, his property was confiscated by the government,
+and he was sentenced to work for life in chains. It is said that he has
+offered a million rupees to any man who will knock off his irons. His
+son carries on the business at Bombay, and it was reported that a vessel
+was always lying at Sincapore ready to receive him in case he should
+effect his escape; but of this there does not appear to be the slightest
+chance, as he is particularly watched and guarded.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="kling" id="kling"></a>
+<img src="images/216.jpg" width="462" height="500" alt="Kling Woman" />
+<p class="caption">KLING WOMAN.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>The next culprits pointed out to us were two of the heads of the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_216" id="Page_216">[216]</a></span> secret
+society of India. So much has already been said of this extraordinary
+association, that I need not discuss it here. There is, however, a
+society in Sincapore of a similar nature, composed of all the lower
+orders of the Chinese. It is said to amount to 15,000; and the police is
+much too weak to prevent the robberies, although some check is put to
+them by the presence of the military. It must not be supposed that
+because there are 15,000 in the society, that there are that quantity of
+robbers: such is not the case. Of course it is difficult to arrive at
+the regulations of any secret society, but as far as can be collected,
+they are as follows. A certain portion of the society are regular
+thieves, and these in a body compel those who are inoffensive to join
+the society, by threats of destruction of property, &amp;c. If the party
+joins the society, all that is expected of him is, that he will aid and
+assist to prevent the capture, and give an asylum to any one of the
+society who may be in danger. The richest Chinese merchants<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_217" id="Page_217">[217]</a></span> have been
+compelled to join, and lend their countenance to this society, upon pain
+of destruction of their property, and even assassination, if they
+refuse; and as they have more than once put their threats into
+execution, the merchants have not the courage to resist. Shortly after
+our arrival at Sincapore, the burial of one of the chiefs of the society
+took place; and such was the concourse assembled to witness the funeral,
+that it was thought advisable to call out the troops, as a skirmish was
+expected to take place. However, every thing passed off quietly.</p>
+
+<p>The richest Chinaman at Sincapore is Whampoa: he supplies the navy with
+stores, and has a thriving business. His country house is a favourite
+resort of the naval officers, and he gives excellent dinners, and very
+agreeable parties. His champagne is particularly approved of.</p>
+
+<p>There is little or no amusement at Sincapore. During the afternoon every
+body is asleep. In the cool of the evening half a dozen palanquins, and
+perhaps a few gigs, may be seen driving on the parade: these proceed at
+a steady pace round the grass-plot for about an hour; and this is the
+only exercise taken. Fashion is very drowsy here, and only wakes up
+occasionally, that she may sleep the longer afterwards. From the want of
+hospitality, the evenings are passed by strangers at the hotels, playing
+billiards, smoking, and drinking. The hotels are very good, in
+consequence of the steamers from Bombay to Hong Kong touching here; they
+are fitted up with an unusual degree of comfort; and the charges are, of
+course, not very moderate. The markets are well supplied with fruit,
+vegetables, and stock of all kinds. Among the fruits must be mentioned
+the mangostein, which is brought from Malacca; and the pine-apples from
+the island of St. John's. The opposite side of the island upon which
+Sincapore is built is well wooded. A great many tigers swim over from
+the main, and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_218" id="Page_218">[218]</a></span> pits are dug for their destruction, 100 dollars being
+given by government for every tiger killed.</p>
+
+<p>On the 18th we received our final orders, and took our farewell of
+Eastern India; but it must not be supposed that we made the best of our
+passage to England. On the contrary, the captain was as anxious to
+remain out as we were to get home; and we were six months and twelve
+days from the time that we left Sincapore till our arrival at
+Portsmouth. The fact was, that the pay and emoluments of a surveying
+captain are such, that our captain felt no inclination to be paid off;
+and as he never spent any money, he was laying up a nice provision for
+his retirement; besides which he hoped that, upon his representations to
+the Admiralty, the order for his recall would be cancelled, and that he
+would find a letter to that effect at the Cape of Good Hope. His object,
+therefore, was to spin out the time as much as possible, so as to allow
+the answer of the Admiralty to arrive at the Cape before we did. We were
+ordered to survey some shoals, the Cagardos Carahos, on our passage
+home; but I believe nothing more.</p>
+
+<p>On Sunday, the 22d, we anchored off a small island near to the isle of
+Billaton. At two <small>A. M.</small> we weighed, and ten minutes afterwards the ship
+struck on a shoal. All our exertions to get her off proved abortive, and
+in this uncomfortable position we remained till the following Thursday,
+when she again floated, after throwing overboard the guns, and landing
+such stores as we could on the island. This accident and light winds
+lengthened our passage to Anger (the Dutch settlement in Java) to
+twenty-one days; and there we remained five days, to ascertain the rate
+of our chronometers. This Dutch settlement at Anger, although slightly
+fortified, might be made a place of great consequence: both outward and
+homeward bound vessels touch here for water and stock; and were it
+properly supported and improved by the Dutch, as it should be, it would
+command a great deal of trade,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_219" id="Page_219">[219]</a></span> and during war be of great consequence.
+It is governed by a Dutch military officer, and is garrisoned with about
+fifty soldiers. The country is remarkably fine here, the plains richly
+cultivated and covered with cattle. The farmers complain bitterly of the
+taxes imposed upon them by the Dutch, taxes so onerous that no native
+has a chance of realising any profits of consequence; but this is Dutch
+policy, and very unwise policy it is. We now thought that we were about
+to proceed to the isle of France direct, but we were mistaken: we
+weighed anchor, and proceeded to the Cocoa islands. This is a low group
+of islands literally covered with cocoa-nut trees. These islands are
+possessed by a Mr. Ross, formerly mate of a merchant vessel. His family
+consisted of two sons and two daughters, and are the only Europeans who
+reside there. We could not help thinking that the Misses Ross had very
+little chance of getting husbands. The remainder of the population,
+amounting to about 120 souls, are all black. They extract the oil from
+the cocoa-nut, and trade with it to Java, from whence they procure the
+necessary supplies. Whalers occasionally call here to obtain fresh
+provisions; but the visit of a man-of-war was quite an event.</p>
+
+<p>From the Cocoas we steered for the Cagardos Carahos shoals, where we
+remained for more than a fortnight, surveying. There are several islands
+close to these shoals, which are in the shape of a crescent. They are
+very dangerous, being in the direct track of ships from China and the
+Indies.</p>
+
+<p>Indeed, we had ocular proof of their dangerous position, for there were
+seven or eight wrecks upon them, and the small islands of sand were
+crowded with masts, spars, chests, interspersed with human bones
+bleaching in the powerful sun. On one of the islands we discovered the
+remains of the British ship Letitia, which was wrecked in September,
+1845. At a short distance from the beach was the grave<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_220" id="Page_220">[220]</a></span> of the captain,
+who was drowned in attempting to reach the shore with a bag of dollars.
+Had he not held on so tight to the bag, he would in all probability have
+been saved, as were all the rest on board of her. It certainly would be
+very advisable to build a lighthouse upon these shoals; the expense
+would be nothing compared to the loss of property and life which they
+occasion every year. From the Cagardos Carahos we proceeded to the
+Mauritius. Here we found the President, bearing the flag of Admiral
+Dacres, and the Snake brig just arrived from England.</p>
+
+<p>Port Louis has been too often described to be mentioned here. Behind it
+rose a range of mountains, the highest of which are about 1400 feet
+above the level of the sea, and completely shelter the town from the
+S. E. gales, which at this period of the year blow with great violence.
+Among these mountains is the famous Peter-Botte, and we looked upon it
+with great interest, in consequence of the daring and successful attempt
+made a few years since by some Englishmen to attain the summit of it.
+Even now, although we know that it has been done, it appears to be
+impossible. One of the leaders of this expedition was Lieutenant Thomas
+Keppel, the brother of our favourite Captain Henry Keppel, and this
+circumstance gave it more interest to us; but T. Keppel has since left
+the service, and is now a Reverend, moored in a snug <i>Creek</i>, and has
+quite given over climbing up Peter-Bottes. During the short time that we
+remained at this delightful island, we received every kindness and
+attention from the governor and his lady, and the officers of the two
+regiments stationed there.</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<a name="louis" id="louis"></a>
+<img src="images/220.jpg" width="600" height="391" alt="Port Louis" />
+<div class="cap-horiz">
+<p class="capleft">F. M. DEL<span class="sup">T</span>.</p>
+<p class="capright">M. N. HANHART LITH. PRINTERS</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p class="caption">PORT LOUIS.<br />
+<small>(MAURITIUS.)</small></p>
+<p class="publisher">LONDON; LONGMAN &amp; C<span class="sup">O</span>. 1848</p>
+</div>
+</div>
+
+<p>From the Mauritius we proceeded to the Cape of Good Hope. On the morning
+of the 24th of September we hove in sight of the Table Mountain, but it
+was not until the 26th that we cast anchor in Simon's Bay. Here we
+remained for a month, waiting for the arrival<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_221" id="Page_221">[221]</a></span> of the mail from England.
+At last it arrived, but not bringing us, as our captain hoped, the order
+for his return to India, on the 24th of October we made sail for
+England, and, calling at St. Helena and Ascension <i>en route</i>, on the
+last day of the year we dropped our anchor at Spithead. We were not,
+however, emancipated till the 18th day of January, on which day the ship
+was paid off, for which, and all other mercies, may the Lord be
+praised!</p>
+
+
+
+<hr />
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_222" id="Page_222">[222]</a></span></p>
+<h2><a name="OBSERVATIONS" id="OBSERVATIONS"></a>OBSERVATIONS</h2>
+
+<p>UPON</p>
+
+<p>THE EASTERN ARCHIPELAGO.</p>
+
+
+<p>It is with diffidence that I take up my pen to offer a few remarks upon
+the prospects afforded to our commerce and manufactures by the opening
+of the Eastern Archipelago. Hitherto I have done little more than
+narrate what I have seen, and have seldom made any attempt to express
+what I have thought. However, as my thoughts have been generated from
+what I have observed, whether I am correct or not in my opinions, I
+shall venture to lay them before my readers.</p>
+
+<p>How it is that until lately we have never taken any notice of this
+immense archipelago it is difficult to say, unless we are to suppose
+that, up to the present, the other portions of the inhabited globe have
+been found sufficient to consume our manufactures as fast as they could
+be produced. It does appear strange that an assemblage of islands,
+which, large and small, amounting to about 12,000 in number, equal in
+territory to any continent, and so populous, for the inhabitants,
+including the more northern islands, are estimated at fifty millions,
+should have hitherto been unnoticed, and, at all events, have not
+attracted the attention of our government. Moreover, there are such
+facilities of communication, not being compelled, as with the Chinese,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_223" id="Page_223">[223]</a></span>
+to confine ourselves to five or six ports, at which the whole trade is
+centred in the hands of a monopoly, taxed with the expences of
+land-carriage, port duties, and other exactions. Here, on the contrary,
+from the division of the territory into so many portions, we possess all
+the advantages of inland navigation, if I may use such a term, for the
+straits and channels between them serve as large rivers do on the
+continents to render the communication with the interior easy and
+accessible. And yet, although we have had possession of the East Indies
+for so many years, this archipelago has been wholly neglected. At all
+events, the discovery of it, for it is really such, has come in good
+time, and will give a stimulus to our manufactures, most opportune, now
+that we have so much increased them, that we are in want of customers.
+Still we have, almost unknown to ourselves, been advancing towards it
+step by step. The taking possession of the island of Sincapore was the
+first and greatest stride towards it. Had it not been that we had
+founded that settlement, we probably should not have been nearer to
+Borneo now, than we were fifty years ago. Sir T. Raffles conferred a
+great boon upon this country, and is entitled to its gratitude for
+pointing out the advantages which would accrue from this possession.
+Till we had made a settlement there, we knew no more of the eastern
+archipelago, than what had been obtained by our circumnavigators, or of
+the produce of it, further than that Borneo was the country from which
+could be obtained the orang-outang.</p>
+
+<p>Latterly we have been at some trouble and expence in forcing our trade
+with China, little aware that almost in the route to China we had an
+opening for commerce, which, in a few years, judiciously managed, will
+become by far the most lucrative of the two, and what perhaps is still
+more important, may be the means of a most extended trade with China, as
+we can drive the Chinese from the archipelago, and supply China from
+them ourselves; but of that hereafter.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_224" id="Page_224">[224]</a></span>One cause, perhaps, which has prevented us from turning our attention in
+this direction has been, an unwillingness to interfere with the Dutch,
+who have been supposed to have been in possession of all the valuable
+islands in the archipelago, and from long-standing to have a prior right
+to this portion of the East; but, although the Dutch have not been idle,
+and are gradually adding to their possessions, there is little chance of
+our interfering with them, as there is room, and more, for the Dutch,
+ourselves, and every other nation which may feel inclined to compete
+with us. The possessions of the Dutch are but a mere strip in this
+immense field; and, although it is true that they have settlements on
+the Spice Islands, so named, yet we now know that every one of these
+islands may be made spice islands, if the inhabitants are stimulated by
+commerce to produce these articles of trade.</p>
+
+<p>It was the settlement at Sincapore which first gave us a notion of the
+trade which might be carried on with this archipelago. Every year large
+fleets of prahus have come up to Sincapore laden with commodities for
+barter, and have taken in exchange European goods to a certain extent;
+but their chief object has been to obtain gunpowder and shot, to carry
+on their piratical expeditions. In fact, they are traders when they can
+only obtain what they want by exchange; but when they can obtain it by
+force, they then change their character, and become pirates. But our
+possession of Labuan has brought us about eight hundred miles nearer to
+these people, and enables us to take more effectual steps towards the
+suppression of piracy than we have hitherto done; for this we may lay
+down as an axiom, that we never shall reap the advantages promised to us
+by commerce in this archipelago till we have most effectually put an end
+to the piracy which has existed in these quarters for centuries. Before
+I go on, I cannot help here observing how much this country is indebted<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_225" id="Page_225">[225]</a></span>
+to Mr. Brooke for his unwearied exertions in the cause of humanity, and
+his skilful arrangements. It is to be hoped, that our gratitude to him
+will be in proportion, and that Her Majesty's ministers will, in their
+distribution of honour and emoluments among those who have served them,
+not forget to bestow some upon one who has so well served his country.</p>
+
+<p>The largest, and perhaps the most important of the islands in this
+archipelago, although at present the most barbarous, and the most
+hostile to us, is that of Papua, or New Guinea. The inhabitants are as
+well inclined to commerce as the other natives of the archipelago, and
+do at present carry on a considerable trade with the Chinese, who repair
+there every year in their junks, which they fill with valuable cargoes
+adapted for the Chinese market. The Chinese have found the trade with
+New Guinea so lucrative, that they are doing all that they can to secure
+the monopoly of it, and with this view take every occasion, and do all
+that they possibly can, to blacken the character of the Europeans in the
+minds of the inhabitants. It is to this cause that the Papuan's
+hostility to Europeans, and especially to the English, is to be
+ascribed; and before we have any chance of commerce with this people, it
+is necessary that the Chinese should be driven away from the island,
+that they may no longer injure us by their malicious fabrications. This
+will be but a just retribution for the falsehoods and lies which they
+have circulated to our disadvantage. And there is another reason why we
+should be little scrupulous in taking this measure, which is, that one
+of their principal articles of commerce with the Papuans consists in
+slaves, which are taken on board by the Chinese, and sold at Borneo, and
+the adjacent islands of the archipelago, at a great profit. To obtain
+these slaves, the Chinese stimulate the Papuan tribes to war with each
+other, as is done for the same purpose in Africa. As this traffic is
+very considerable, and we are as<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_226" id="Page_226">[226]</a></span> much bound to put down the slave trade
+in the east as in the west, we have full warrant for driving their junks
+away, and, by so doing, there is little doubt but that in a few years we
+shall secure all the valuable trade of this island to ourselves.</p>
+
+<p>Borneo is, however, the island (or continent) to which our first
+attention will be particularly devoted. Up to the present we know little
+of it except its coasts and a portion of its rivers; but it is here that
+our principal attention must be given, as in its rivers and the island
+of Sooloo the chief piratical hordes exist. We have already had some
+sharp conflicts with them, and have given them some severe lessons; but
+although we have given them a momentary check, and some idea of our
+immense superiority, we must not imagine that two or three successful
+conflicts are sufficient to put an end to a system which has been
+carried on for centuries, and which is so universal, that the whole of
+the present generation may be said to have been "born pirates." In fact,
+we shall be compelled to subdue them wholly, to destroy them in all
+their fastnesses, to leave them without a prahu in their possession, to
+depose or confine their chiefs, to destroy their forts, and to carry on
+a war of extermination for some years, before we shall put down the
+piratical system which at present exists. It is not quite so easy a task
+as may be imagined to reform so many millions of people: for it must be
+remembered that it is not only at Borneo that we shall have to act, but
+that we must destroy the power of the sultan of Sooloo, and other tribes
+who frequent other islands, and who follow the same profession. It must
+not be forgotten that one of the principal objects of these piratical
+excursions is to procure slaves for sale at other ports; and perhaps
+this is by far the most profitable part of the speculation. As long as
+there is no security for the person, commerce must languish, and be
+proportionably checked. In putting down these marauders, we are,
+therefore, putting down the slave trade<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_227" id="Page_227">[227]</a></span> as with the Chinese at New
+Guinea. The sooner that this is effected the better; and to do it
+effectually we should have a large force at Labuan, ready to act with
+decision. Let it be remembered that, with people so crafty and so cruel
+as the Malays and descendants of the Arabs, lenity is misplaced, and is
+ascribed to cowardice. No half measures will succeed with them. Indeed,
+I have my doubts whether it will not be necessary to destroy almost
+every prahu in the archipelago, and compel the natives to remain on
+their territory, to cultivate or collect articles for barter, before we
+shall effect our purpose; for the prahu that sails as a trader is
+changed into a pirate as soon as temptation rises on her way. Indeed, if
+Labuan becomes, as it will probably be, an emporium and d&eacute;p&ocirc;t for
+European commerce, without such stringent measures a great stimulus
+would be given to piracy. The peaceable trading parties, on their
+return, would be laid in wait for by the piratical prahus, and the
+English manufactures on board would be so tempting, and such a source of
+wealth, that they would be irresistible. Neither should we be able to
+afford any protection to the traders, as they would be laid in wait for
+at the mouths or up the rivers, and would be captured without our
+knowledge; with this difference, perhaps, that the fear of detection
+would induce them to murder all the prisoners, instead of selling them
+as slaves, as they do at present. Unless, therefore, the most stringent
+measures are resorted to on our parts, an increase of commerce with this
+archipelago would only occasion in a reciprocal ratio an increase of
+piracy.</p>
+
+<p>The occupation of Labuan and Sarawak will, I should imagine, prove
+hardly sufficient to effect the important change to be desired, <i>i. e.</i>
+that of the total suppression of piracy. Stations, with forts, must be
+established at the mouths of the principal rivers, that we may have a
+constant watch upon the movements of the occupants. In so doing<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_228" id="Page_228">[228]</a></span> we
+should be only encroaching upon those who have encroached upon others:
+these rivers have been taken forcible possession of by the Malays and
+Arabs, who have driven away the proprietors of the soil, which are the
+Dyaks, the aborigines of the island; and they have no more right to the
+possessions which they hold, than their chiefs have to the high-sounding
+titles which they have assumed. That in taking this step we shall
+interfere with no vested rights is certain: we shall merely be
+dispossessing these piratical marauders of their strongholds; and the
+cause of humanity will sufficiently warrant such interference on our
+parts.</p>
+
+<p>In our first attempts to establish, a peaceful and secure commerce with
+this archipelago, it appears to me that it would be advisable for the
+Government to take some share in the venture. Ten or twelve schooners,
+well manned, confided to intelligent officers, and armed with one heavy
+gun, and swivels in the gunwales, should sail for Labuan, with assorted
+cargoes, with the view of both trading and checking piracy. Much depends
+upon the way in which the barter is first commenced, and it would be as
+well that it should not be left in the hands of adventurers, whose
+mercenary feelings might induce them to excite doubt or irritation in
+the minds of the natives, and, by such means, do great mischief, and
+impede the trade. The constant appearance of these vessels in the
+archipelago, the knowledge that they were sent, not only to barter, but
+also to protect the well-disposed against violence and rapine, would
+soon produce most beneficial effects, and would impose confidence.
+Merchant vessels which entered the trade should be empowered, by letters
+of marque, to put down piracy, and should be armed in a similar way.
+Although there is little doubt but that in a short time vessels would
+sail from Labuan with full cargoes for Europe, still it is more than
+probable that the most important part of the trade, and which would
+employ most vessels, would<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_229" id="Page_229">[229]</a></span> be the colonial trade, or rather, country
+trade, to the several marts in the Indus and China. There are many
+productions of the archipelago which are only valued in the East, such
+as b&ecirc;che-de-mer, or trepang; edible birds' nests, &amp;c. This trade we
+might very soon monopolise to ourselves, and a most lucrative one it
+would prove. The following are the articles to be found in more or less
+quantities over the whole of the Indian archipelago:&mdash;Antimony, tin,
+gold, diamonds, pearls, sapphires, ivory, gums, camphor, sago, pepper,
+tortoise-shell, mother-of-pearl, skins, wax, honey, cocoa-nut oil,
+coffee, rice, and coal, edible birds' nests and trepang; all the
+varieties of spices, as cinnamon, cloves, nutmegs, can be grown as soon
+as there is a market for them; the cotton tree nourishes; and, although
+not yet worked, it is proved that there is abundance of copper and lead.
+An archipelago containing such rich productions, and which we may, with
+some little trouble, receive in exchange for our manufactures, becomes a
+national concern, and it is the paramount duty of the Government to take
+every measure to facilitate the communication with it.</p>
+
+<p>The expedition of Mr. Murray to the river Coti, on the south side of
+Borneo, although, from imprudence, it ended not only unsuccessfully but
+tragically, fully establishes that an opening for commerce is to be
+established. In this expedition Mr. Murray, by his imprudence and
+unguarded conduct, brought upon himself the attack of the natives, in
+which he lost his own life, and the vessels with great difficulty
+escaped. Since that failure, no English vessels have attempted to trade
+to the south of Borneo; but we discovered that the Macassar boats paid
+the coast an occasional visit, under Dutch colours, exchanging beads and
+other trumpery for rich cargoes of ivory and skins. We also discovered
+that commercial negotiations with this country would not be attended
+with any risk, provided that the vessels employed were well armed, and
+the arrangements<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_230" id="Page_230">[230]</a></span> were so made as not to excite the jealousy and
+suspicion of the natives.</p>
+
+<p>European manufactures would be eagerly purchased by the natives, and
+would be paid for in ivory, rough ores, or dollars. Mr. Wyndham, who has
+settled at Sooloo, has already sent a vessel to trade on the south-east
+side of the island, near Gonong Tabor.</p>
+
+<p>So much for the southern portion of this immense archipelago. We have
+still to examine the more northern. Indeed, when we look upon the map,
+and see the quantity of territory with which we may eventually find the
+means of trading,&mdash;the millions who, but for the jealousy of the
+governments, would be glad to receive our manufactures,&mdash;we are lost in
+conjecture as to what extent it might eventually be driven. In the north
+we should certainly have more difficulties to contend with; and it will
+require that the whole of the naval force in India should be, for a
+time, devoted to this object. I believe it is as much from their utter
+ignorance of our power, as from any other cause, that we have hitherto
+been so unsuccessful at Japan; but the object we have in view may be
+effected, provided that a certain degree of the <i>fortiter in re</i> be
+combined with the <i>suaviter in modo</i>. The Japanese now carry on a large
+trade with China, and also a confined trade with the Dutch, to whom they
+have allowed a factory upon a small island; but they treat the Dutch
+with the greatest indignity, and the Dutch submit to it, and, in so
+doing, have rendered the Europeans vile in the estimation of the
+Japanese. This is the error which must be destroyed by some means or
+other, even if it should be necessary to pick a quarrel with them, as we
+have already done with the Chinese. At the same time that I admit the
+expediency of so doing, I by no means assert that we shall be altogether
+justified.</p>
+
+<p>There is another point worthy of consideration, which is, that a whale
+fishery d&eacute;p&ocirc;t might be made with great success in this archipelago,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_231" id="Page_231">[231]</a></span> any
+where to the southward and eastward; and we might recover a large
+portion of that lucrative employment, which, by the means of British
+seamen employed in American vessels, has been wrested from us; for
+although, at the commencement, the whale fishery from the States was
+carried on by Americans only, since it has so enormously increased, at
+least two-thirds of the people employed in the vessels are English
+seamen, who have become expert in the profession. It is much to be
+lamented that the laudable exertions of Mr. Enderby and others to revive
+this lucrative employment for our vessels and seamen has hitherto
+failed, and that some part of our surplus capital has not been devoted
+to an object so important to us as a maritime country.</p>
+
+<p>I shall conclude with a reflection which I made while I was on the
+coast, leaving the reader to agree with me or not, as he may be
+disposed. How is it, as I have already observed, that all the colonies
+founded by other nations, either languish or have been swept away,&mdash;not
+all, perhaps, as yet, but the major portion of them; while every colony
+founded by our little island appears to flourish, till it becomes so
+powerful as not only no longer to require the nursing of the mother
+country, but to throw off its dependence, and become a nation of itself?
+How is it that it can so truly be said that the sun never sets upon the
+English flag? It cannot be from any want of energy, or activity, or
+intelligence, or judgment in other nations; for surely in these
+qualifications we are not superior to the French or to the Dutch,
+although we may be to the present race of Spaniards and Portuguese. Our
+colonies have not been more carefully fostered than theirs: on the
+contrary, they have been neglected, and, if not neglected, they have
+been but too often oppressed. Why, then, should this be? Can religion
+have any thing to do with this? Can it be that Providence has
+imperceptibly interfered, and has decided that England<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_232" id="Page_232">[232]</a></span> shall perform
+the high mission; that she has been selected, as a chosen country, to
+fill the whole world with the true faith, with the pure worship of the
+Almighty? Has it been for this object that we have been supported in our
+maritime superiority? Has it been with this view that we have been
+permitted to discomfit the navies of the whole world? May it not be that
+when our naval commanders, with a due regard to propriety, have
+commenced their despatches with "It has pleased the Almighty to grant us
+a splendid victory," at the same time that they were trusting to the
+arms of flesh and blood which have so well supported their endeavours,
+and in their hearts ascribed their successes to the prowess of man,&mdash;may
+it not be, I say, that the Almighty has, for his own good reasons,
+fought on our side, and has given us victory upon victory, until we have
+swept the seas, and made the name of England known to the uttermost
+corners of the globe? Has this been granted us, and have we really been
+selected as a favoured nation to spread the pure light of the gospel
+over the universe? Who can say? "His ways are not our ways;" but if so,
+it is a high destiny, which we must act up to at every sacrifice and at
+every expence.</p>
+
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+<div class="footnotes">
+<p class="center"><b>FOOTNOTES:</b></p>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p><a name="Footnote_1_1" id="Footnote_1_1"></a><a href="#FNanchor_1_1"><span class="label">[1]</span></a> The account of this transaction is taken from the private
+log of one of the officers who was present in the barge during the whole
+time. I was not there myself. In his narrative it will be observed that
+he makes no mention of the natives who came down upon them having
+<i>thrown spears</i> at them, although in the extract from the "Times" it is
+so stated. It would appear also that there was some mistake as to the
+number of men on board of the prahus and the number killed. A war prahu
+generally contains from fifty to eighty men. Some are smaller, and
+occasionally they are larger, but not often. Capt. Keppell states fifty
+men to be the usual number in his work; and, in his conflict with the
+pirates, estimates the force accordingly. Now the first day there was
+one war prahu, which ran up a creek; and, on being fired at, the crew
+deserted her. On the second day there were five prahus, all captured. On
+the third day the five prahus engaged were not captured, the boat
+returning to the ship after the captain was wounded; so that in all it
+appears that there were nine prahus; and, allowing eighty men to each,
+the force would only amount to 720 men, or about one half of the number
+stated, viz. 1330. How the killed, amounting to 350, or about half the
+number, were arrived at and estimated, it is impossible to say; but in
+the narrative of the officer, which I have given, the major portion of
+the crews deserted the prahus and got on shore.</p></div>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p><a name="Footnote_2_2" id="Footnote_2_2"></a><a href="#FNanchor_2_2"><span class="label">[2]</span></a> These rascally nurses have all been discharged. When
+enlisted as nurses in England, they signed for three years' service.
+When their time was expired, they applied to Admiral Cochrane for
+their discharge. After some demur their request was complied with; but
+their conduct had been so disgraceful, that, as it was not in the
+agreement, they were refused a passage home in a man-of-war. I met some
+of them ashore at Hong Kong, looking in vain for employment, and at a
+distance of 20,000 miles from their own country. The retribution was
+just.</p></div>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p><a name="Footnote_3_3" id="Footnote_3_3"></a><a href="#FNanchor_3_3"><span class="label">[3]</span></a> These sepoys were raised and <i>paid</i> by Mr. Brooke.</p></div>
+</div>
+
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+<p class="center">THE END.</p>
+
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+<p class="center"><small>
+London:<br />
+Spottiswoode and Shaw,<br />
+New-street-Square.</small>
+</p>
+
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+<div class="tnote">
+<p class="center"><b>TRANSCRIBER'S NOTES:</b></p>
+
+<p>The author's original (and inconsistent) spelling of place and person
+names has been preserved, although in some cases, the modern equivalents
+are substantially different.</p>
+
+<p>In the original text, most illustration captions had terminating
+punctuation but a few did not. In this transcription, terminating
+punctuation has been added to those captions which did not have them in
+order to remain consistent with the style most commonly seen in the
+text.</p>
+
+<p>Lithographs facing pages 85, 142, 199 and 201 were missing a line
+specifying the publisher "Longman &amp; Co" which is present in the other
+lithographs. It is possible that the pages used for this transcription
+had been physically truncated. The original appearance of the physical
+page has been preserved and the publisher line, if missing, has not been
+added.</p>
+
+<p>Inconsistencies in hyphenation of words preserved. (orang outang,
+orang-outang; blowpipe, blow-pipe; bow-man, bowman; daylight, day-light;
+flagstaff, flag-staff; goodwill, good-will; gunshot, gun-shot;
+lighthouse, light-house; parang, pa-rang; pineapples, pine-apples;
+tomtoms, tom-toms; whitewashed, white-washed; pic nic, pic-nic; Nepa
+palm, nepa-palms)</p>
+
+<p>In the original text, the characters in abbreviations were separated by
+either a half-space or a full-space. This has been standardized to a
+full-space in all cases for this transcription.</p>
+
+<p>Pg. 19, unusual or archaic spelling of "musquitos" retained. (musquitos,
+scorpions, lizards, and centipedes)</p>
+
+<p>Pg. 20, there is a reference to date 27th May. Context suggests it
+should probably be 27th July. The original text has been preserved. (On
+the 27th May every thing had been prepared)</p>
+
+<p>Pg. 21, "wth" changed to "with". (delightful bay studded with small)</p>
+
+<p>Pg. 35, unusual or archaic spelling of "phrensy" retained. (The lovers
+were in a state of phrensy)</p>
+
+<p>Pg. 90, unusual or archaic spelling of "segars" retained. (We had plenty
+of wine and segars)</p>
+
+<p>Pg. 206, word after comma begins with uppercase, most probably it
+represents the start of an unspoken thought in the author's mind.
+Original text retained. (and we became more rational, Why were we
+ordered home?)</p>
+
+<p>Pg. 211, "dépot". On Pgs. 227 and 230, it is spelled "dépôt". Original
+spelling preserved in all cases.</p>
+
+</div>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+<pre>
+
+
+
+
+
+End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of Borneo and the Indian Archipelago, by
+Frank S. Marryat
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK BORNEO AND THE INDIAN ARCHIPELAGO ***
+
+***** This file should be named 26844-h.htm or 26844-h.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ https://www.gutenberg.org/2/6/8/4/26844/
+
+Produced by Ronald Lee
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+https://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, is critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at https://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+https://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at https://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit https://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including including checks, online payments and credit card
+donations. To donate, please visit: https://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ https://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
+
+</pre>
+
+</body>
+</html>
diff --git a/26844-h/images/005.jpg b/26844-h/images/005.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5aec79a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/005.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/006.jpg b/26844-h/images/006.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..180f32b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/006.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/007.jpg b/26844-h/images/007.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cbbff9e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/007.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/013.jpg b/26844-h/images/013.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0721c2e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/013.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/023.jpg b/26844-h/images/023.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f30a63d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/023.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/027.jpg b/26844-h/images/027.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..45eaa1a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/027.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/031.jpg b/26844-h/images/031.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..93a6d56
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/031.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/042.jpg b/26844-h/images/042.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..048527e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/042.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/059.jpg b/26844-h/images/059.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d8cc0a6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/059.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/063.jpg b/26844-h/images/063.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ade133e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/063.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/064.jpg b/26844-h/images/064.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9b7a0fe
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/064.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/074.jpg b/26844-h/images/074.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..904f78d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/074.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/079a.jpg b/26844-h/images/079a.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2fd9c6c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/079a.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/079b.jpg b/26844-h/images/079b.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..602fd25
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/079b.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/080a.jpg b/26844-h/images/080a.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..34ca9e7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/080a.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/080b.jpg b/26844-h/images/080b.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ce566e8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/080b.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/080c.jpg b/26844-h/images/080c.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f3446a7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/080c.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/082.jpg b/26844-h/images/082.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c96a6cd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/082.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/085.jpg b/26844-h/images/085.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0cc0ce7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/085.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/089.jpg b/26844-h/images/089.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ecc2fcb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/089.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/093.jpg b/26844-h/images/093.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..baec6ae
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/093.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/100.jpg b/26844-h/images/100.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6bb31c8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/100.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/101.jpg b/26844-h/images/101.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5981e60
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/101.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/103.jpg b/26844-h/images/103.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..611a02c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/103.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/106.jpg b/26844-h/images/106.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c809c0b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/106.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/108.jpg b/26844-h/images/108.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..bc2d4b5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/108.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/109.jpg b/26844-h/images/109.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7dc23bd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/109.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/121.jpg b/26844-h/images/121.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f1b370a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/121.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/133.jpg b/26844-h/images/133.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..035a3f9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/133.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/135.jpg b/26844-h/images/135.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d3d8442
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/135.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/139.jpg b/26844-h/images/139.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..823f0a3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/139.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/141.jpg b/26844-h/images/141.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d25f59e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/141.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/142.jpg b/26844-h/images/142.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..dfc3b3c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/142.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/145.jpg b/26844-h/images/145.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8801c5d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/145.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/146.jpg b/26844-h/images/146.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..103e671
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/146.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/151.jpg b/26844-h/images/151.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c490b79
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/151.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/154.jpg b/26844-h/images/154.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8b2556b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/154.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/156.jpg b/26844-h/images/156.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..699f3e5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/156.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/165.jpg b/26844-h/images/165.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..dbd839e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/165.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/168.jpg b/26844-h/images/168.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..833e691
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/168.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/169a.jpg b/26844-h/images/169a.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e45156f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/169a.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/169b.jpg b/26844-h/images/169b.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cb44fdf
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/169b.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/182.jpg b/26844-h/images/182.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..15697c8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/182.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/183.jpg b/26844-h/images/183.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..695b97a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/183.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/184.jpg b/26844-h/images/184.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a7c201b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/184.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/185.jpg b/26844-h/images/185.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..641d788
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/185.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/193a.jpg b/26844-h/images/193a.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ed8308e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/193a.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/193b.jpg b/26844-h/images/193b.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e968f60
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/193b.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/196.jpg b/26844-h/images/196.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2244c9c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/196.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/199a.jpg b/26844-h/images/199a.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3e25d21
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/199a.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/199b.jpg b/26844-h/images/199b.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..78902b4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/199b.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/201.jpg b/26844-h/images/201.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..32f1ac8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/201.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/207.jpg b/26844-h/images/207.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..dcf428a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/207.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/208.jpg b/26844-h/images/208.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a9e4e3a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/208.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/210.jpg b/26844-h/images/210.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d8698c9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/210.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/210a.jpg b/26844-h/images/210a.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c555315
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/210a.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/215.jpg b/26844-h/images/215.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..27994d5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/215.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/216.jpg b/26844-h/images/216.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1122630
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/216.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/220.jpg b/26844-h/images/220.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1ae56f9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/220.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/frontis.jpg b/26844-h/images/frontis.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8a73934
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/frontis.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/26844-h/images/title.jpg b/26844-h/images/title.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a5e5d9f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/26844-h/images/title.jpg
Binary files differ